LoongArch: Fix R_LARCH_IRELATIVE insertion after elf_link_sort_relocs
[binutils-gdb.git] / ld / ld.texi
1 \input texinfo
2 @setfilename ld.info
3 @c Copyright (C) 1991-2022 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
4 @syncodeindex ky cp
5 @c man begin INCLUDE
6 @include configdoc.texi
7 @c (configdoc.texi is generated by the Makefile)
8 @include bfdver.texi
9 @c man end
10
11 @c @smallbook
12
13 @macro gcctabopt{body}
14 @code{\body\}
15 @end macro
16
17 @c man begin NAME
18 @ifset man
19 @c Configure for the generation of man pages
20 @set UsesEnvVars
21 @set GENERIC
22 @set ARM
23 @set C6X
24 @set CSKY
25 @set H8300
26 @set HPPA
27 @set M68HC11
28 @set M68K
29 @set MIPS
30 @set MMIX
31 @set MSP430
32 @set NDS32
33 @set NIOSII
34 @set PDP11
35 @set POWERPC
36 @set POWERPC64
37 @set Renesas
38 @set S/390
39 @set SPU
40 @set TICOFF
41 @set WIN32
42 @set XTENSA
43 @end ifset
44 @c man end
45
46 @ifnottex
47 @dircategory Software development
48 @direntry
49 * Ld: (ld). The GNU linker.
50 @end direntry
51 @end ifnottex
52
53 @copying
54 This file documents the @sc{gnu} linker LD
55 @ifset VERSION_PACKAGE
56 @value{VERSION_PACKAGE}
57 @end ifset
58 version @value{VERSION}.
59
60 Copyright @copyright{} 1991-2022 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
61
62 Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
63 under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.3
64 or any later version published by the Free Software Foundation;
65 with no Invariant Sections, with no Front-Cover Texts, and with no
66 Back-Cover Texts. A copy of the license is included in the
67 section entitled ``GNU Free Documentation License''.
68 @end copying
69 @iftex
70 @finalout
71 @setchapternewpage odd
72 @settitle The GNU linker
73 @titlepage
74 @title The GNU linker
75 @sp 1
76 @subtitle @code{ld}
77 @ifset VERSION_PACKAGE
78 @subtitle @value{VERSION_PACKAGE}
79 @end ifset
80 @subtitle Version @value{VERSION}
81 @author Steve Chamberlain
82 @author Ian Lance Taylor
83 @page
84
85 @tex
86 {\parskip=0pt
87 \hfill Red Hat Inc\par
88 \hfill nickc\@credhat.com, doc\@redhat.com\par
89 \hfill {\it The GNU linker}\par
90 \hfill Edited by Jeffrey Osier (jeffrey\@cygnus.com)\par
91 }
92 \global\parindent=0pt % Steve likes it this way.
93 @end tex
94
95 @vskip 0pt plus 1filll
96 @c man begin COPYRIGHT
97 Copyright @copyright{} 1991-2022 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
98
99 Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
100 under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.3
101 or any later version published by the Free Software Foundation;
102 with no Invariant Sections, with no Front-Cover Texts, and with no
103 Back-Cover Texts. A copy of the license is included in the
104 section entitled ``GNU Free Documentation License''.
105 @c man end
106
107 @end titlepage
108 @end iftex
109 @contents
110 @c FIXME: Talk about importance of *order* of args, cmds to linker!
111
112 @ifnottex
113 @node Top
114 @top LD
115 This file documents the @sc{gnu} linker ld
116 @ifset VERSION_PACKAGE
117 @value{VERSION_PACKAGE}
118 @end ifset
119 version @value{VERSION}.
120
121 This document is distributed under the terms of the GNU Free
122 Documentation License version 1.3. A copy of the license is included
123 in the section entitled ``GNU Free Documentation License''.
124
125 @menu
126 * Overview:: Overview
127 * Invocation:: Invocation
128 * Scripts:: Linker Scripts
129 * Plugins:: Linker Plugins
130 @ifset GENERIC
131 * Machine Dependent:: Machine Dependent Features
132 @end ifset
133 @ifclear GENERIC
134 @ifset H8300
135 * H8/300:: ld and the H8/300
136 @end ifset
137 @ifset Renesas
138 * Renesas:: ld and other Renesas micros
139 @end ifset
140 @ifset ARM
141 * ARM:: ld and the ARM family
142 @end ifset
143 @ifset M68HC11
144 * M68HC11/68HC12:: ld and the Motorola 68HC11 and 68HC12 families
145 @end ifset
146 @ifset HPPA
147 * HPPA ELF32:: ld and HPPA 32-bit ELF
148 @end ifset
149 @ifset M68K
150 * M68K:: ld and Motorola 68K family
151 @end ifset
152 @ifset MIPS
153 * MIPS:: ld and MIPS family
154 @end ifset
155 @ifset POWERPC
156 * PowerPC ELF32:: ld and PowerPC 32-bit ELF Support
157 @end ifset
158 @ifset POWERPC64
159 * PowerPC64 ELF64:: ld and PowerPC64 64-bit ELF Support
160 @end ifset
161 @ifset S/390
162 * S/390 ELF:: ld and S/390 ELF Support
163 @end ifset
164 @ifset SPU
165 * SPU ELF:: ld and SPU ELF Support
166 @end ifset
167 @ifset TICOFF
168 * TI COFF:: ld and the TI COFF
169 @end ifset
170 @ifset WIN32
171 * Win32:: ld and WIN32 (cygwin/mingw)
172 @end ifset
173 @ifset XTENSA
174 * Xtensa:: ld and Xtensa Processors
175 @end ifset
176 @end ifclear
177 @ifclear SingleFormat
178 * BFD:: BFD
179 @end ifclear
180 @c Following blank line required for remaining bug in makeinfo conds/menus
181
182 * Reporting Bugs:: Reporting Bugs
183 * MRI:: MRI Compatible Script Files
184 * GNU Free Documentation License:: GNU Free Documentation License
185 * LD Index:: LD Index
186 @end menu
187 @end ifnottex
188
189 @node Overview
190 @chapter Overview
191
192 @cindex @sc{gnu} linker
193 @cindex what is this?
194
195 @ifset man
196 @c man begin SYNOPSIS
197 ld [@b{options}] @var{objfile} @dots{}
198 @c man end
199
200 @c man begin SEEALSO
201 ar(1), nm(1), objcopy(1), objdump(1), readelf(1) and
202 the Info entries for @file{binutils} and
203 @file{ld}.
204 @c man end
205 @end ifset
206
207 @c man begin DESCRIPTION
208
209 @command{ld} combines a number of object and archive files, relocates
210 their data and ties up symbol references. Usually the last step in
211 compiling a program is to run @command{ld}.
212
213 @command{ld} accepts Linker Command Language files written in
214 a superset of AT&T's Link Editor Command Language syntax,
215 to provide explicit and total control over the linking process.
216
217 @ifset man
218 @c For the man only
219 This man page does not describe the command language; see the
220 @command{ld} entry in @code{info} for full details on the command
221 language and on other aspects of the GNU linker.
222 @end ifset
223
224 @ifclear SingleFormat
225 This version of @command{ld} uses the general purpose BFD libraries
226 to operate on object files. This allows @command{ld} to read, combine, and
227 write object files in many different formats---for example, COFF or
228 @code{a.out}. Different formats may be linked together to produce any
229 available kind of object file. @xref{BFD}, for more information.
230 @end ifclear
231
232 Aside from its flexibility, the @sc{gnu} linker is more helpful than other
233 linkers in providing diagnostic information. Many linkers abandon
234 execution immediately upon encountering an error; whenever possible,
235 @command{ld} continues executing, allowing you to identify other errors
236 (or, in some cases, to get an output file in spite of the error).
237
238 @c man end
239
240 @node Invocation
241 @chapter Invocation
242
243 @c man begin DESCRIPTION
244
245 The @sc{gnu} linker @command{ld} is meant to cover a broad range of situations,
246 and to be as compatible as possible with other linkers. As a result,
247 you have many choices to control its behavior.
248
249 @c man end
250
251 @ifset UsesEnvVars
252 @menu
253 * Options:: Command-line Options
254 * Environment:: Environment Variables
255 @end menu
256
257 @node Options
258 @section Command-line Options
259 @end ifset
260
261 @cindex command line
262 @cindex options
263
264 @c man begin OPTIONS
265
266 The linker supports a plethora of command-line options, but in actual
267 practice few of them are used in any particular context.
268 @cindex standard Unix system
269 For instance, a frequent use of @command{ld} is to link standard Unix
270 object files on a standard, supported Unix system. On such a system, to
271 link a file @code{hello.o}:
272
273 @smallexample
274 ld -o @var{output} /lib/crt0.o hello.o -lc
275 @end smallexample
276
277 This tells @command{ld} to produce a file called @var{output} as the
278 result of linking the file @code{/lib/crt0.o} with @code{hello.o} and
279 the library @code{libc.a}, which will come from the standard search
280 directories. (See the discussion of the @samp{-l} option below.)
281
282 Some of the command-line options to @command{ld} may be specified at any
283 point in the command line. However, options which refer to files, such
284 as @samp{-l} or @samp{-T}, cause the file to be read at the point at
285 which the option appears in the command line, relative to the object
286 files and other file options. Repeating non-file options with a
287 different argument will either have no further effect, or override prior
288 occurrences (those further to the left on the command line) of that
289 option. Options which may be meaningfully specified more than once are
290 noted in the descriptions below.
291
292 @cindex object files
293 Non-option arguments are object files or archives which are to be linked
294 together. They may follow, precede, or be mixed in with command-line
295 options, except that an object file argument may not be placed between
296 an option and its argument.
297
298 Usually the linker is invoked with at least one object file, but you can
299 specify other forms of binary input files using @samp{-l}, @samp{-R},
300 and the script command language. If @emph{no} binary input files at all
301 are specified, the linker does not produce any output, and issues the
302 message @samp{No input files}.
303
304 If the linker cannot recognize the format of an object file, it will
305 assume that it is a linker script. A script specified in this way
306 augments the main linker script used for the link (either the default
307 linker script or the one specified by using @samp{-T}). This feature
308 permits the linker to link against a file which appears to be an object
309 or an archive, but actually merely defines some symbol values, or uses
310 @code{INPUT} or @code{GROUP} to load other objects. Specifying a
311 script in this way merely augments the main linker script, with the
312 extra commands placed after the main script; use the @samp{-T} option
313 to replace the default linker script entirely, but note the effect of
314 the @code{INSERT} command. @xref{Scripts}.
315
316 For options whose names are a single letter,
317 option arguments must either follow the option letter without intervening
318 whitespace, or be given as separate arguments immediately following the
319 option that requires them.
320
321 For options whose names are multiple letters, either one dash or two can
322 precede the option name; for example, @samp{-trace-symbol} and
323 @samp{--trace-symbol} are equivalent. Note---there is one exception to
324 this rule. Multiple letter options that start with a lower case 'o' can
325 only be preceded by two dashes. This is to reduce confusion with the
326 @samp{-o} option. So for example @samp{-omagic} sets the output file
327 name to @samp{magic} whereas @samp{--omagic} sets the NMAGIC flag on the
328 output.
329
330 Arguments to multiple-letter options must either be separated from the
331 option name by an equals sign, or be given as separate arguments
332 immediately following the option that requires them. For example,
333 @samp{--trace-symbol foo} and @samp{--trace-symbol=foo} are equivalent.
334 Unique abbreviations of the names of multiple-letter options are
335 accepted.
336
337 Note---if the linker is being invoked indirectly, via a compiler driver
338 (e.g. @samp{gcc}) then all the linker command-line options should be
339 prefixed by @samp{-Wl,} (or whatever is appropriate for the particular
340 compiler driver) like this:
341
342 @smallexample
343 gcc -Wl,--start-group foo.o bar.o -Wl,--end-group
344 @end smallexample
345
346 This is important, because otherwise the compiler driver program may
347 silently drop the linker options, resulting in a bad link. Confusion
348 may also arise when passing options that require values through a
349 driver, as the use of a space between option and argument acts as
350 a separator, and causes the driver to pass only the option to the linker
351 and the argument to the compiler. In this case, it is simplest to use
352 the joined forms of both single- and multiple-letter options, such as:
353
354 @smallexample
355 gcc foo.o bar.o -Wl,-eENTRY -Wl,-Map=a.map
356 @end smallexample
357
358 Here is a table of the generic command-line switches accepted by the GNU
359 linker:
360
361 @table @gcctabopt
362 @include at-file.texi
363
364 @kindex -a @var{keyword}
365 @item -a @var{keyword}
366 This option is supported for HP/UX compatibility. The @var{keyword}
367 argument must be one of the strings @samp{archive}, @samp{shared}, or
368 @samp{default}. @samp{-aarchive} is functionally equivalent to
369 @samp{-Bstatic}, and the other two keywords are functionally equivalent
370 to @samp{-Bdynamic}. This option may be used any number of times.
371
372 @kindex --audit @var{AUDITLIB}
373 @item --audit @var{AUDITLIB}
374 Adds @var{AUDITLIB} to the @code{DT_AUDIT} entry of the dynamic section.
375 @var{AUDITLIB} is not checked for existence, nor will it use the DT_SONAME
376 specified in the library. If specified multiple times @code{DT_AUDIT}
377 will contain a colon separated list of audit interfaces to use. If the linker
378 finds an object with an audit entry while searching for shared libraries,
379 it will add a corresponding @code{DT_DEPAUDIT} entry in the output file.
380 This option is only meaningful on ELF platforms supporting the rtld-audit
381 interface.
382
383 @ifclear SingleFormat
384 @cindex binary input format
385 @kindex -b @var{format}
386 @kindex --format=@var{format}
387 @cindex input format
388 @cindex input format
389 @item -b @var{input-format}
390 @itemx --format=@var{input-format}
391 @command{ld} may be configured to support more than one kind of object
392 file. If your @command{ld} is configured this way, you can use the
393 @samp{-b} option to specify the binary format for input object files
394 that follow this option on the command line. Even when @command{ld} is
395 configured to support alternative object formats, you don't usually need
396 to specify this, as @command{ld} should be configured to expect as a
397 default input format the most usual format on each machine.
398 @var{input-format} is a text string, the name of a particular format
399 supported by the BFD libraries. (You can list the available binary
400 formats with @samp{objdump -i}.)
401 @xref{BFD}.
402
403 You may want to use this option if you are linking files with an unusual
404 binary format. You can also use @samp{-b} to switch formats explicitly (when
405 linking object files of different formats), by including
406 @samp{-b @var{input-format}} before each group of object files in a
407 particular format.
408
409 The default format is taken from the environment variable
410 @code{GNUTARGET}.
411 @ifset UsesEnvVars
412 @xref{Environment}.
413 @end ifset
414 You can also define the input format from a script, using the command
415 @code{TARGET};
416 @ifclear man
417 see @ref{Format Commands}.
418 @end ifclear
419 @end ifclear
420
421 @kindex -c @var{MRI-cmdfile}
422 @kindex --mri-script=@var{MRI-cmdfile}
423 @cindex compatibility, MRI
424 @item -c @var{MRI-commandfile}
425 @itemx --mri-script=@var{MRI-commandfile}
426 For compatibility with linkers produced by MRI, @command{ld} accepts script
427 files written in an alternate, restricted command language, described in
428 @ifclear man
429 @ref{MRI,,MRI Compatible Script Files}.
430 @end ifclear
431 @ifset man
432 the MRI Compatible Script Files section of GNU ld documentation.
433 @end ifset
434 Introduce MRI script files with
435 the option @samp{-c}; use the @samp{-T} option to run linker
436 scripts written in the general-purpose @command{ld} scripting language.
437 If @var{MRI-cmdfile} does not exist, @command{ld} looks for it in the directories
438 specified by any @samp{-L} options.
439
440 @cindex common allocation
441 @kindex -d
442 @kindex -dc
443 @kindex -dp
444 @item -d
445 @itemx -dc
446 @itemx -dp
447 These three options are equivalent; multiple forms are supported for
448 compatibility with other linkers. They assign space to common symbols
449 even if a relocatable output file is specified (with @samp{-r}). The
450 script command @code{FORCE_COMMON_ALLOCATION} has the same effect.
451 @xref{Miscellaneous Commands}.
452
453 @kindex --depaudit @var{AUDITLIB}
454 @kindex -P @var{AUDITLIB}
455 @item --depaudit @var{AUDITLIB}
456 @itemx -P @var{AUDITLIB}
457 Adds @var{AUDITLIB} to the @code{DT_DEPAUDIT} entry of the dynamic section.
458 @var{AUDITLIB} is not checked for existence, nor will it use the DT_SONAME
459 specified in the library. If specified multiple times @code{DT_DEPAUDIT}
460 will contain a colon separated list of audit interfaces to use. This
461 option is only meaningful on ELF platforms supporting the rtld-audit interface.
462 The -P option is provided for Solaris compatibility.
463
464 @kindex --enable-non-contiguous-regions
465 @item --enable-non-contiguous-regions
466 This option avoids generating an error if an input section does not
467 fit a matching output section. The linker tries to allocate the input
468 section to subseque nt matching output sections, and generates an
469 error only if no output section is large enough. This is useful when
470 several non-contiguous memory regions are available and the input
471 section does not require a particular one. The order in which input
472 sections are evaluated does not change, for instance:
473
474 @smallexample
475 MEMORY @{
476 MEM1 (rwx) : ORIGIN : 0x1000, LENGTH = 0x14
477 MEM2 (rwx) : ORIGIN : 0x1000, LENGTH = 0x40
478 MEM3 (rwx) : ORIGIN : 0x2000, LENGTH = 0x40
479 @}
480 SECTIONS @{
481 mem1 : @{ *(.data.*); @} > MEM1
482 mem2 : @{ *(.data.*); @} > MEM2
483 mem3 : @{ *(.data.*); @} > MEM2
484 @}
485
486 with input sections:
487 .data.1: size 8
488 .data.2: size 0x10
489 .data.3: size 4
490
491 results in .data.1 affected to mem1, and .data.2 and .data.3
492 affected to mem2, even though .data.3 would fit in mem3.
493 @end smallexample
494
495 This option is incompatible with INSERT statements because it changes
496 the way input sections are mapped to output sections.
497
498 @kindex --enable-non-contiguous-regions-warnings
499 @item --enable-non-contiguous-regions-warnings
500 This option enables warnings when
501 @code{--enable-non-contiguous-regions} allows possibly unexpected
502 matches in sections mapping, potentially leading to silently
503 discarding a section instead of failing because it does not fit any
504 output region.
505
506 @cindex entry point, from command line
507 @kindex -e @var{entry}
508 @kindex --entry=@var{entry}
509 @item -e @var{entry}
510 @itemx --entry=@var{entry}
511 Use @var{entry} as the explicit symbol for beginning execution of your
512 program, rather than the default entry point. If there is no symbol
513 named @var{entry}, the linker will try to parse @var{entry} as a number,
514 and use that as the entry address (the number will be interpreted in
515 base 10; you may use a leading @samp{0x} for base 16, or a leading
516 @samp{0} for base 8). @xref{Entry Point}, for a discussion of defaults
517 and other ways of specifying the entry point.
518
519 @kindex --exclude-libs
520 @item --exclude-libs @var{lib},@var{lib},...
521 Specifies a list of archive libraries from which symbols should not be automatically
522 exported. The library names may be delimited by commas or colons. Specifying
523 @code{--exclude-libs ALL} excludes symbols in all archive libraries from
524 automatic export. This option is available only for the i386 PE targeted
525 port of the linker and for ELF targeted ports. For i386 PE, symbols
526 explicitly listed in a .def file are still exported, regardless of this
527 option. For ELF targeted ports, symbols affected by this option will
528 be treated as hidden.
529
530 @kindex --exclude-modules-for-implib
531 @item --exclude-modules-for-implib @var{module},@var{module},...
532 Specifies a list of object files or archive members, from which symbols
533 should not be automatically exported, but which should be copied wholesale
534 into the import library being generated during the link. The module names
535 may be delimited by commas or colons, and must match exactly the filenames
536 used by @command{ld} to open the files; for archive members, this is simply
537 the member name, but for object files the name listed must include and
538 match precisely any path used to specify the input file on the linker's
539 command-line. This option is available only for the i386 PE targeted port
540 of the linker. Symbols explicitly listed in a .def file are still exported,
541 regardless of this option.
542
543 @cindex dynamic symbol table
544 @kindex -E
545 @kindex --export-dynamic
546 @kindex --no-export-dynamic
547 @item -E
548 @itemx --export-dynamic
549 @itemx --no-export-dynamic
550 When creating a dynamically linked executable, using the @option{-E}
551 option or the @option{--export-dynamic} option causes the linker to add
552 all symbols to the dynamic symbol table. The dynamic symbol table is the
553 set of symbols which are visible from dynamic objects at run time.
554
555 If you do not use either of these options (or use the
556 @option{--no-export-dynamic} option to restore the default behavior), the
557 dynamic symbol table will normally contain only those symbols which are
558 referenced by some dynamic object mentioned in the link.
559
560 If you use @code{dlopen} to load a dynamic object which needs to refer
561 back to the symbols defined by the program, rather than some other
562 dynamic object, then you will probably need to use this option when
563 linking the program itself.
564
565 You can also use the dynamic list to control what symbols should
566 be added to the dynamic symbol table if the output format supports it.
567 See the description of @samp{--dynamic-list}.
568
569 Note that this option is specific to ELF targeted ports. PE targets
570 support a similar function to export all symbols from a DLL or EXE; see
571 the description of @samp{--export-all-symbols} below.
572
573 @kindex --export-dynamic-symbol=@var{glob}
574 @cindex export dynamic symbol
575 @item --export-dynamic-symbol=@var{glob}
576 When creating a dynamically linked executable, symbols matching
577 @var{glob} will be added to the dynamic symbol table. When creating a
578 shared library, references to symbols matching @var{glob} will not be
579 bound to the definitions within the shared library. This option is a
580 no-op when creating a shared library and @samp{-Bsymbolic} or
581 @samp{--dynamic-list} are not specified. This option is only meaningful
582 on ELF platforms which support shared libraries.
583
584 @kindex --export-dynamic-symbol-list=@var{file}
585 @cindex export dynamic symbol list
586 @item --export-dynamic-symbol-list=@var{file}
587 Specify a @samp{--export-dynamic-symbol} for each pattern in the file.
588 The format of the file is the same as the version node without
589 scope and node name. See @ref{VERSION} for more information.
590
591 @ifclear SingleFormat
592 @cindex big-endian objects
593 @cindex endianness
594 @kindex -EB
595 @item -EB
596 Link big-endian objects. This affects the default output format.
597
598 @cindex little-endian objects
599 @kindex -EL
600 @item -EL
601 Link little-endian objects. This affects the default output format.
602 @end ifclear
603
604 @kindex -f @var{name}
605 @kindex --auxiliary=@var{name}
606 @item -f @var{name}
607 @itemx --auxiliary=@var{name}
608 When creating an ELF shared object, set the internal DT_AUXILIARY field
609 to the specified name. This tells the dynamic linker that the symbol
610 table of the shared object should be used as an auxiliary filter on the
611 symbol table of the shared object @var{name}.
612
613 If you later link a program against this filter object, then, when you
614 run the program, the dynamic linker will see the DT_AUXILIARY field. If
615 the dynamic linker resolves any symbols from the filter object, it will
616 first check whether there is a definition in the shared object
617 @var{name}. If there is one, it will be used instead of the definition
618 in the filter object. The shared object @var{name} need not exist.
619 Thus the shared object @var{name} may be used to provide an alternative
620 implementation of certain functions, perhaps for debugging or for
621 machine-specific performance.
622
623 This option may be specified more than once. The DT_AUXILIARY entries
624 will be created in the order in which they appear on the command line.
625
626 @kindex -F @var{name}
627 @kindex --filter=@var{name}
628 @item -F @var{name}
629 @itemx --filter=@var{name}
630 When creating an ELF shared object, set the internal DT_FILTER field to
631 the specified name. This tells the dynamic linker that the symbol table
632 of the shared object which is being created should be used as a filter
633 on the symbol table of the shared object @var{name}.
634
635 If you later link a program against this filter object, then, when you
636 run the program, the dynamic linker will see the DT_FILTER field. The
637 dynamic linker will resolve symbols according to the symbol table of the
638 filter object as usual, but it will actually link to the definitions
639 found in the shared object @var{name}. Thus the filter object can be
640 used to select a subset of the symbols provided by the object
641 @var{name}.
642
643 Some older linkers used the @option{-F} option throughout a compilation
644 toolchain for specifying object-file format for both input and output
645 object files.
646 @ifclear SingleFormat
647 The @sc{gnu} linker uses other mechanisms for this purpose: the
648 @option{-b}, @option{--format}, @option{--oformat} options, the
649 @code{TARGET} command in linker scripts, and the @code{GNUTARGET}
650 environment variable.
651 @end ifclear
652 The @sc{gnu} linker will ignore the @option{-F} option when not
653 creating an ELF shared object.
654
655 @cindex finalization function
656 @kindex -fini=@var{name}
657 @item -fini=@var{name}
658 When creating an ELF executable or shared object, call NAME when the
659 executable or shared object is unloaded, by setting DT_FINI to the
660 address of the function. By default, the linker uses @code{_fini} as
661 the function to call.
662
663 @kindex -g
664 @item -g
665 Ignored. Provided for compatibility with other tools.
666
667 @kindex -G @var{value}
668 @kindex --gpsize=@var{value}
669 @cindex object size
670 @item -G @var{value}
671 @itemx --gpsize=@var{value}
672 Set the maximum size of objects to be optimized using the GP register to
673 @var{size}. This is only meaningful for object file formats such as
674 MIPS ELF that support putting large and small objects into different
675 sections. This is ignored for other object file formats.
676
677 @cindex runtime library name
678 @kindex -h @var{name}
679 @kindex -soname=@var{name}
680 @item -h @var{name}
681 @itemx -soname=@var{name}
682 When creating an ELF shared object, set the internal DT_SONAME field to
683 the specified name. When an executable is linked with a shared object
684 which has a DT_SONAME field, then when the executable is run the dynamic
685 linker will attempt to load the shared object specified by the DT_SONAME
686 field rather than using the file name given to the linker.
687
688 @kindex -i
689 @cindex incremental link
690 @item -i
691 Perform an incremental link (same as option @samp{-r}).
692
693 @cindex initialization function
694 @kindex -init=@var{name}
695 @item -init=@var{name}
696 When creating an ELF executable or shared object, call NAME when the
697 executable or shared object is loaded, by setting DT_INIT to the address
698 of the function. By default, the linker uses @code{_init} as the
699 function to call.
700
701 @cindex archive files, from cmd line
702 @kindex -l @var{namespec}
703 @kindex --library=@var{namespec}
704 @item -l @var{namespec}
705 @itemx --library=@var{namespec}
706 Add the archive or object file specified by @var{namespec} to the
707 list of files to link. This option may be used any number of times.
708 If @var{namespec} is of the form @file{:@var{filename}}, @command{ld}
709 will search the library path for a file called @var{filename}, otherwise it
710 will search the library path for a file called @file{lib@var{namespec}.a}.
711
712 On systems which support shared libraries, @command{ld} may also search for
713 files other than @file{lib@var{namespec}.a}. Specifically, on ELF
714 and SunOS systems, @command{ld} will search a directory for a library
715 called @file{lib@var{namespec}.so} before searching for one called
716 @file{lib@var{namespec}.a}. (By convention, a @code{.so} extension
717 indicates a shared library.) Note that this behavior does not apply
718 to @file{:@var{filename}}, which always specifies a file called
719 @var{filename}.
720
721 The linker will search an archive only once, at the location where it is
722 specified on the command line. If the archive defines a symbol which
723 was undefined in some object which appeared before the archive on the
724 command line, the linker will include the appropriate file(s) from the
725 archive. However, an undefined symbol in an object appearing later on
726 the command line will not cause the linker to search the archive again.
727
728 See the @option{-(} option for a way to force the linker to search
729 archives multiple times.
730
731 You may list the same archive multiple times on the command line.
732
733 @ifset GENERIC
734 This type of archive searching is standard for Unix linkers. However,
735 if you are using @command{ld} on AIX, note that it is different from the
736 behaviour of the AIX linker.
737 @end ifset
738
739 @cindex search directory, from cmd line
740 @kindex -L @var{dir}
741 @kindex --library-path=@var{dir}
742 @item -L @var{searchdir}
743 @itemx --library-path=@var{searchdir}
744 Add path @var{searchdir} to the list of paths that @command{ld} will search
745 for archive libraries and @command{ld} control scripts. You may use this
746 option any number of times. The directories are searched in the order
747 in which they are specified on the command line. Directories specified
748 on the command line are searched before the default directories. All
749 @option{-L} options apply to all @option{-l} options, regardless of the
750 order in which the options appear. @option{-L} options do not affect
751 how @command{ld} searches for a linker script unless @option{-T}
752 option is specified.
753
754 If @var{searchdir} begins with @code{=} or @code{$SYSROOT}, then this
755 prefix will be replaced by the @dfn{sysroot prefix}, controlled by the
756 @samp{--sysroot} option, or specified when the linker is configured.
757
758 @ifset UsesEnvVars
759 The default set of paths searched (without being specified with
760 @samp{-L}) depends on which emulation mode @command{ld} is using, and in
761 some cases also on how it was configured. @xref{Environment}.
762 @end ifset
763
764 The paths can also be specified in a link script with the
765 @code{SEARCH_DIR} command. Directories specified this way are searched
766 at the point in which the linker script appears in the command line.
767
768 @cindex emulation
769 @kindex -m @var{emulation}
770 @item -m @var{emulation}
771 Emulate the @var{emulation} linker. You can list the available
772 emulations with the @samp{--verbose} or @samp{-V} options.
773
774 If the @samp{-m} option is not used, the emulation is taken from the
775 @code{LDEMULATION} environment variable, if that is defined.
776
777 Otherwise, the default emulation depends upon how the linker was
778 configured.
779
780 @cindex link map
781 @kindex -M
782 @kindex --print-map
783 @item -M
784 @itemx --print-map
785 Print a link map to the standard output. A link map provides
786 information about the link, including the following:
787
788 @itemize @bullet
789 @item
790 Where object files are mapped into memory.
791 @item
792 How common symbols are allocated.
793 @item
794 All archive members included in the link, with a mention of the symbol
795 which caused the archive member to be brought in.
796 @item
797 The values assigned to symbols.
798
799 Note - symbols whose values are computed by an expression which
800 involves a reference to a previous value of the same symbol may not
801 have correct result displayed in the link map. This is because the
802 linker discards intermediate results and only retains the final value
803 of an expression. Under such circumstances the linker will display
804 the final value enclosed by square brackets. Thus for example a
805 linker script containing:
806
807 @smallexample
808 foo = 1
809 foo = foo * 4
810 foo = foo + 8
811 @end smallexample
812
813 will produce the following output in the link map if the @option{-M}
814 option is used:
815
816 @smallexample
817 0x00000001 foo = 0x1
818 [0x0000000c] foo = (foo * 0x4)
819 [0x0000000c] foo = (foo + 0x8)
820 @end smallexample
821
822 See @ref{Expressions} for more information about expressions in linker
823 scripts.
824
825 @item
826 How GNU properties are merged.
827
828 When the linker merges input .note.gnu.property sections into one output
829 .note.gnu.property section, some properties are removed or updated.
830 These actions are reported in the link map. For example:
831
832 @smallexample
833 Removed property 0xc0000002 to merge foo.o (0x1) and bar.o (not found)
834 @end smallexample
835
836 This indicates that property 0xc0000002 is removed from output when
837 merging properties in @file{foo.o}, whose property 0xc0000002 value
838 is 0x1, and @file{bar.o}, which doesn't have property 0xc0000002.
839
840 @smallexample
841 Updated property 0xc0010001 (0x1) to merge foo.o (0x1) and bar.o (0x1)
842 @end smallexample
843
844 This indicates that property 0xc0010001 value is updated to 0x1 in output
845 when merging properties in @file{foo.o}, whose 0xc0010001 property value
846 is 0x1, and @file{bar.o}, whose 0xc0010001 property value is 0x1.
847 @end itemize
848
849 @cindex link map discarded
850 @kindex --print-map-discarded
851 @kindex --no-print-map-discarded
852 @item --print-map-discarded
853 @itemx --no-print-map-discarded
854 Print (or do not print) the list of discarded and garbage collected sections
855 in the link map. Enabled by default.
856
857 @kindex -n
858 @cindex read-only text
859 @cindex NMAGIC
860 @kindex --nmagic
861 @item -n
862 @itemx --nmagic
863 Turn off page alignment of sections, and disable linking against shared
864 libraries. If the output format supports Unix style magic numbers,
865 mark the output as @code{NMAGIC}.
866
867 @kindex -N
868 @kindex --omagic
869 @cindex read/write from cmd line
870 @cindex OMAGIC
871 @item -N
872 @itemx --omagic
873 Set the text and data sections to be readable and writable. Also, do
874 not page-align the data segment, and disable linking against shared
875 libraries. If the output format supports Unix style magic numbers,
876 mark the output as @code{OMAGIC}. Note: Although a writable text section
877 is allowed for PE-COFF targets, it does not conform to the format
878 specification published by Microsoft.
879
880 @kindex --no-omagic
881 @cindex OMAGIC
882 @item --no-omagic
883 This option negates most of the effects of the @option{-N} option. It
884 sets the text section to be read-only, and forces the data segment to
885 be page-aligned. Note - this option does not enable linking against
886 shared libraries. Use @option{-Bdynamic} for this.
887
888 @kindex -o @var{output}
889 @kindex --output=@var{output}
890 @cindex naming the output file
891 @item -o @var{output}
892 @itemx --output=@var{output}
893 Use @var{output} as the name for the program produced by @command{ld}; if this
894 option is not specified, the name @file{a.out} is used by default. The
895 script command @code{OUTPUT} can also specify the output file name.
896
897 @kindex --dependency-file=@var{depfile}
898 @cindex dependency file
899 @item --dependency-file=@var{depfile}
900 Write a @dfn{dependency file} to @var{depfile}. This file contains a rule
901 suitable for @code{make} describing the output file and all the input files
902 that were read to produce it. The output is similar to the compiler's
903 output with @samp{-M -MP} (@pxref{Preprocessor Options,, Options
904 Controlling the Preprocessor, gcc.info, Using the GNU Compiler
905 Collection}). Note that there is no option like the compiler's @samp{-MM},
906 to exclude ``system files'' (which is not a well-specified concept in the
907 linker, unlike ``system headers'' in the compiler). So the output from
908 @samp{--dependency-file} is always specific to the exact state of the
909 installation where it was produced, and should not be copied into
910 distributed makefiles without careful editing.
911
912 @kindex -O @var{level}
913 @cindex generating optimized output
914 @item -O @var{level}
915 If @var{level} is a numeric values greater than zero @command{ld} optimizes
916 the output. This might take significantly longer and therefore probably
917 should only be enabled for the final binary. At the moment this
918 option only affects ELF shared library generation. Future releases of
919 the linker may make more use of this option. Also currently there is
920 no difference in the linker's behaviour for different non-zero values
921 of this option. Again this may change with future releases.
922
923 @kindex -plugin @var{name}
924 @item -plugin @var{name}
925 Involve a plugin in the linking process. The @var{name} parameter is
926 the absolute filename of the plugin. Usually this parameter is
927 automatically added by the complier, when using link time
928 optimization, but users can also add their own plugins if they so
929 wish.
930
931 Note that the location of the compiler originated plugins is different
932 from the place where the @command{ar}, @command{nm} and
933 @command{ranlib} programs search for their plugins. In order for
934 those commands to make use of a compiler based plugin it must first be
935 copied into the @file{$@{libdir@}/bfd-plugins} directory. All gcc
936 based linker plugins are backward compatible, so it is sufficient to
937 just copy in the newest one.
938
939 @kindex --push-state
940 @cindex push state governing input file handling
941 @item --push-state
942 The @option{--push-state} allows one to preserve the current state of the
943 flags which govern the input file handling so that they can all be
944 restored with one corresponding @option{--pop-state} option.
945
946 The option which are covered are: @option{-Bdynamic}, @option{-Bstatic},
947 @option{-dn}, @option{-dy}, @option{-call_shared}, @option{-non_shared},
948 @option{-static}, @option{-N}, @option{-n}, @option{--whole-archive},
949 @option{--no-whole-archive}, @option{-r}, @option{-Ur},
950 @option{--copy-dt-needed-entries}, @option{--no-copy-dt-needed-entries},
951 @option{--as-needed}, @option{--no-as-needed}, and @option{-a}.
952
953 One target for this option are specifications for @file{pkg-config}. When
954 used with the @option{--libs} option all possibly needed libraries are
955 listed and then possibly linked with all the time. It is better to return
956 something as follows:
957
958 @smallexample
959 -Wl,--push-state,--as-needed -libone -libtwo -Wl,--pop-state
960 @end smallexample
961
962 @kindex --pop-state
963 @cindex pop state governing input file handling
964 @item --pop-state
965 Undoes the effect of --push-state, restores the previous values of the
966 flags governing input file handling.
967
968 @kindex -q
969 @kindex --emit-relocs
970 @cindex retain relocations in final executable
971 @item -q
972 @itemx --emit-relocs
973 Leave relocation sections and contents in fully linked executables.
974 Post link analysis and optimization tools may need this information in
975 order to perform correct modifications of executables. This results
976 in larger executables.
977
978 This option is currently only supported on ELF platforms.
979
980 @kindex --force-dynamic
981 @cindex forcing the creation of dynamic sections
982 @item --force-dynamic
983 Force the output file to have dynamic sections. This option is specific
984 to VxWorks targets.
985
986 @cindex partial link
987 @cindex relocatable output
988 @kindex -r
989 @kindex --relocatable
990 @item -r
991 @itemx --relocatable
992 Generate relocatable output---i.e., generate an output file that can in
993 turn serve as input to @command{ld}. This is often called @dfn{partial
994 linking}. As a side effect, in environments that support standard Unix
995 magic numbers, this option also sets the output file's magic number to
996 @code{OMAGIC}.
997 @c ; see @option{-N}.
998 If this option is not specified, an absolute file is produced. When
999 linking C++ programs, this option @emph{will not} resolve references to
1000 constructors; to do that, use @samp{-Ur}.
1001
1002 When an input file does not have the same format as the output file,
1003 partial linking is only supported if that input file does not contain any
1004 relocations. Different output formats can have further restrictions; for
1005 example some @code{a.out}-based formats do not support partial linking
1006 with input files in other formats at all.
1007
1008 This option does the same thing as @samp{-i}.
1009
1010 @kindex -R @var{file}
1011 @kindex --just-symbols=@var{file}
1012 @cindex symbol-only input
1013 @item -R @var{filename}
1014 @itemx --just-symbols=@var{filename}
1015 Read symbol names and their addresses from @var{filename}, but do not
1016 relocate it or include it in the output. This allows your output file
1017 to refer symbolically to absolute locations of memory defined in other
1018 programs. You may use this option more than once.
1019
1020 For compatibility with other ELF linkers, if the @option{-R} option is
1021 followed by a directory name, rather than a file name, it is treated as
1022 the @option{-rpath} option.
1023
1024 @kindex -s
1025 @kindex --strip-all
1026 @cindex strip all symbols
1027 @item -s
1028 @itemx --strip-all
1029 Omit all symbol information from the output file.
1030
1031 @kindex -S
1032 @kindex --strip-debug
1033 @cindex strip debugger symbols
1034 @item -S
1035 @itemx --strip-debug
1036 Omit debugger symbol information (but not all symbols) from the output file.
1037
1038 @kindex --strip-discarded
1039 @kindex --no-strip-discarded
1040 @item --strip-discarded
1041 @itemx --no-strip-discarded
1042 Omit (or do not omit) global symbols defined in discarded sections.
1043 Enabled by default.
1044
1045 @kindex -t
1046 @kindex --trace
1047 @cindex input files, displaying
1048 @item -t
1049 @itemx --trace
1050 Print the names of the input files as @command{ld} processes them. If
1051 @samp{-t} is given twice then members within archives are also printed.
1052 @samp{-t} output is useful to generate a list of all the object files
1053 and scripts involved in linking, for example, when packaging files for
1054 a linker bug report.
1055
1056 @kindex -T @var{script}
1057 @kindex --script=@var{script}
1058 @cindex script files
1059 @item -T @var{scriptfile}
1060 @itemx --script=@var{scriptfile}
1061 Use @var{scriptfile} as the linker script. This script replaces
1062 @command{ld}'s default linker script (rather than adding to it), so
1063 @var{commandfile} must specify everything necessary to describe the
1064 output file. @xref{Scripts}. If @var{scriptfile} does not exist in
1065 the current directory, @code{ld} looks for it in the directories
1066 specified by any preceding @samp{-L} options. Multiple @samp{-T}
1067 options accumulate.
1068
1069 @kindex -dT @var{script}
1070 @kindex --default-script=@var{script}
1071 @cindex script files
1072 @item -dT @var{scriptfile}
1073 @itemx --default-script=@var{scriptfile}
1074 Use @var{scriptfile} as the default linker script. @xref{Scripts}.
1075
1076 This option is similar to the @option{--script} option except that
1077 processing of the script is delayed until after the rest of the
1078 command line has been processed. This allows options placed after the
1079 @option{--default-script} option on the command line to affect the
1080 behaviour of the linker script, which can be important when the linker
1081 command line cannot be directly controlled by the user. (eg because
1082 the command line is being constructed by another tool, such as
1083 @samp{gcc}).
1084
1085 @kindex -u @var{symbol}
1086 @kindex --undefined=@var{symbol}
1087 @cindex undefined symbol
1088 @item -u @var{symbol}
1089 @itemx --undefined=@var{symbol}
1090 Force @var{symbol} to be entered in the output file as an undefined
1091 symbol. Doing this may, for example, trigger linking of additional
1092 modules from standard libraries. @samp{-u} may be repeated with
1093 different option arguments to enter additional undefined symbols. This
1094 option is equivalent to the @code{EXTERN} linker script command.
1095
1096 If this option is being used to force additional modules to be pulled
1097 into the link, and if it is an error for the symbol to remain
1098 undefined, then the option @option{--require-defined} should be used
1099 instead.
1100
1101 @kindex --require-defined=@var{symbol}
1102 @cindex symbols, require defined
1103 @cindex defined symbol
1104 @item --require-defined=@var{symbol}
1105 Require that @var{symbol} is defined in the output file. This option
1106 is the same as option @option{--undefined} except that if @var{symbol}
1107 is not defined in the output file then the linker will issue an error
1108 and exit. The same effect can be achieved in a linker script by using
1109 @code{EXTERN}, @code{ASSERT} and @code{DEFINED} together. This option
1110 can be used multiple times to require additional symbols.
1111
1112 @kindex -Ur
1113 @cindex constructors
1114 @item -Ur
1115 For anything other than C++ programs, this option is equivalent to
1116 @samp{-r}: it generates relocatable output---i.e., an output file that can in
1117 turn serve as input to @command{ld}. When linking C++ programs, @samp{-Ur}
1118 @emph{does} resolve references to constructors, unlike @samp{-r}.
1119 It does not work to use @samp{-Ur} on files that were themselves linked
1120 with @samp{-Ur}; once the constructor table has been built, it cannot
1121 be added to. Use @samp{-Ur} only for the last partial link, and
1122 @samp{-r} for the others.
1123
1124 @kindex --orphan-handling=@var{MODE}
1125 @cindex orphan sections
1126 @cindex sections, orphan
1127 @item --orphan-handling=@var{MODE}
1128 Control how orphan sections are handled. An orphan section is one not
1129 specifically mentioned in a linker script. @xref{Orphan Sections}.
1130
1131 @var{MODE} can have any of the following values:
1132
1133 @table @code
1134 @item place
1135 Orphan sections are placed into a suitable output section following
1136 the strategy described in @ref{Orphan Sections}. The option
1137 @samp{--unique} also affects how sections are placed.
1138
1139 @item discard
1140 All orphan sections are discarded, by placing them in the
1141 @samp{/DISCARD/} section (@pxref{Output Section Discarding}).
1142
1143 @item warn
1144 The linker will place the orphan section as for @code{place} and also
1145 issue a warning.
1146
1147 @item error
1148 The linker will exit with an error if any orphan section is found.
1149 @end table
1150
1151 The default if @samp{--orphan-handling} is not given is @code{place}.
1152
1153 @kindex --unique[=@var{SECTION}]
1154 @item --unique[=@var{SECTION}]
1155 Creates a separate output section for every input section matching
1156 @var{SECTION}, or if the optional wildcard @var{SECTION} argument is
1157 missing, for every orphan input section. An orphan section is one not
1158 specifically mentioned in a linker script. You may use this option
1159 multiple times on the command line; It prevents the normal merging of
1160 input sections with the same name, overriding output section assignments
1161 in a linker script.
1162
1163 @kindex -v
1164 @kindex -V
1165 @kindex --version
1166 @cindex version
1167 @item -v
1168 @itemx --version
1169 @itemx -V
1170 Display the version number for @command{ld}. The @option{-V} option also
1171 lists the supported emulations.
1172
1173 @kindex -x
1174 @kindex --discard-all
1175 @cindex deleting local symbols
1176 @item -x
1177 @itemx --discard-all
1178 Delete all local symbols.
1179
1180 @kindex -X
1181 @kindex --discard-locals
1182 @cindex local symbols, deleting
1183 @item -X
1184 @itemx --discard-locals
1185 Delete all temporary local symbols. (These symbols start with
1186 system-specific local label prefixes, typically @samp{.L} for ELF systems
1187 or @samp{L} for traditional a.out systems.)
1188
1189 @kindex -y @var{symbol}
1190 @kindex --trace-symbol=@var{symbol}
1191 @cindex symbol tracing
1192 @item -y @var{symbol}
1193 @itemx --trace-symbol=@var{symbol}
1194 Print the name of each linked file in which @var{symbol} appears. This
1195 option may be given any number of times. On many systems it is necessary
1196 to prepend an underscore.
1197
1198 This option is useful when you have an undefined symbol in your link but
1199 don't know where the reference is coming from.
1200
1201 @kindex -Y @var{path}
1202 @item -Y @var{path}
1203 Add @var{path} to the default library search path. This option exists
1204 for Solaris compatibility.
1205
1206 @kindex -z @var{keyword}
1207 @item -z @var{keyword}
1208 The recognized keywords are:
1209 @table @samp
1210
1211 @item bndplt
1212 Always generate BND prefix in PLT entries. Supported for Linux/x86_64.
1213
1214 @item call-nop=prefix-addr
1215 @itemx call-nop=suffix-nop
1216 @itemx call-nop=prefix-@var{byte}
1217 @itemx call-nop=suffix-@var{byte}
1218 Specify the 1-byte @code{NOP} padding when transforming indirect call
1219 to a locally defined function, foo, via its GOT slot.
1220 @option{call-nop=prefix-addr} generates @code{0x67 call foo}.
1221 @option{call-nop=suffix-nop} generates @code{call foo 0x90}.
1222 @option{call-nop=prefix-@var{byte}} generates @code{@var{byte} call foo}.
1223 @option{call-nop=suffix-@var{byte}} generates @code{call foo @var{byte}}.
1224 Supported for i386 and x86_64.
1225
1226 @item cet-report=none
1227 @itemx cet-report=warning
1228 @itemx cet-report=error
1229 Specify how to report the missing GNU_PROPERTY_X86_FEATURE_1_IBT and
1230 GNU_PROPERTY_X86_FEATURE_1_SHSTK properties in input .note.gnu.property
1231 section. @option{cet-report=none}, which is the default, will make the
1232 linker not report missing properties in input files.
1233 @option{cet-report=warning} will make the linker issue a warning for
1234 missing properties in input files. @option{cet-report=error} will make
1235 the linker issue an error for missing properties in input files.
1236 Note that @option{ibt} will turn off the missing
1237 GNU_PROPERTY_X86_FEATURE_1_IBT property report and @option{shstk} will
1238 turn off the missing GNU_PROPERTY_X86_FEATURE_1_SHSTK property report.
1239 Supported for Linux/i386 and Linux/x86_64.
1240
1241 @item combreloc
1242 @itemx nocombreloc
1243 Combine multiple dynamic relocation sections and sort to improve
1244 dynamic symbol lookup caching. Do not do this if @samp{nocombreloc}.
1245
1246 @item common
1247 @itemx nocommon
1248 Generate common symbols with STT_COMMON type during a relocatable
1249 link. Use STT_OBJECT type if @samp{nocommon}.
1250
1251 @item common-page-size=@var{value}
1252 Set the page size most commonly used to @var{value}. Memory image
1253 layout will be optimized to minimize memory pages if the system is
1254 using pages of this size.
1255
1256 @item defs
1257 Report unresolved symbol references from regular object files. This
1258 is done even if the linker is creating a non-symbolic shared library.
1259 This option is the inverse of @samp{-z undefs}.
1260
1261 @item dynamic-undefined-weak
1262 @itemx nodynamic-undefined-weak
1263 Make undefined weak symbols dynamic when building a dynamic object,
1264 if they are referenced from a regular object file and not forced local
1265 by symbol visibility or versioning. Do not make them dynamic if
1266 @samp{nodynamic-undefined-weak}. If neither option is given, a target
1267 may default to either option being in force, or make some other
1268 selection of undefined weak symbols dynamic. Not all targets support
1269 these options.
1270
1271 @item execstack
1272 Marks the object as requiring executable stack.
1273
1274 @item global
1275 This option is only meaningful when building a shared object. It makes
1276 the symbols defined by this shared object available for symbol resolution
1277 of subsequently loaded libraries.
1278
1279 @item globalaudit
1280 This option is only meaningful when building a dynamic executable.
1281 This option marks the executable as requiring global auditing by
1282 setting the @code{DF_1_GLOBAUDIT} bit in the @code{DT_FLAGS_1} dynamic
1283 tag. Global auditing requires that any auditing library defined via
1284 the @option{--depaudit} or @option{-P} command-line options be run for
1285 all dynamic objects loaded by the application.
1286
1287 @item ibtplt
1288 Generate Intel Indirect Branch Tracking (IBT) enabled PLT entries.
1289 Supported for Linux/i386 and Linux/x86_64.
1290
1291 @item ibt
1292 Generate GNU_PROPERTY_X86_FEATURE_1_IBT in .note.gnu.property section
1293 to indicate compatibility with IBT. This also implies @option{ibtplt}.
1294 Supported for Linux/i386 and Linux/x86_64.
1295
1296 @item indirect-extern-access
1297 @itemx noindirect-extern-access
1298 Generate GNU_PROPERTY_1_NEEDED_INDIRECT_EXTERN_ACCESS in
1299 .note.gnu.property section to indicate that object file requires
1300 canonical function pointers and cannot be used with copy relocation.
1301 This option also implies @option{noextern-protected-data} and
1302 @option{nocopyreloc}. Supported for i386 and x86-64.
1303
1304 @option{noindirect-extern-access} removes
1305 GNU_PROPERTY_1_NEEDED_INDIRECT_EXTERN_ACCESS from .note.gnu.property
1306 section.
1307
1308 @item initfirst
1309 This option is only meaningful when building a shared object.
1310 It marks the object so that its runtime initialization will occur
1311 before the runtime initialization of any other objects brought into
1312 the process at the same time. Similarly the runtime finalization of
1313 the object will occur after the runtime finalization of any other
1314 objects.
1315
1316 @item interpose
1317 Specify that the dynamic loader should modify its symbol search order
1318 so that symbols in this shared library interpose all other shared
1319 libraries not so marked.
1320
1321 @item unique
1322 @itemx nounique
1323 When generating a shared library or other dynamically loadable ELF
1324 object mark it as one that should (by default) only ever be loaded once,
1325 and only in the main namespace (when using @code{dlmopen}). This is
1326 primarily used to mark fundamental libraries such as libc, libpthread et
1327 al which do not usually function correctly unless they are the sole instances
1328 of themselves. This behaviour can be overridden by the @code{dlmopen} caller
1329 and does not apply to certain loading mechanisms (such as audit libraries).
1330
1331 @item lam-u48
1332 Generate GNU_PROPERTY_X86_FEATURE_1_LAM_U48 in .note.gnu.property section
1333 to indicate compatibility with Intel LAM_U48. Supported for Linux/x86_64.
1334
1335 @item lam-u57
1336 Generate GNU_PROPERTY_X86_FEATURE_1_LAM_U57 in .note.gnu.property section
1337 to indicate compatibility with Intel LAM_U57. Supported for Linux/x86_64.
1338
1339 @item lam-u48-report=none
1340 @itemx lam-u48-report=warning
1341 @itemx lam-u48-report=error
1342 Specify how to report the missing GNU_PROPERTY_X86_FEATURE_1_LAM_U48
1343 property in input .note.gnu.property section.
1344 @option{lam-u48-report=none}, which is the default, will make the
1345 linker not report missing properties in input files.
1346 @option{lam-u48-report=warning} will make the linker issue a warning for
1347 missing properties in input files. @option{lam-u48-report=error} will
1348 make the linker issue an error for missing properties in input files.
1349 Supported for Linux/x86_64.
1350
1351 @item lam-u57-report=none
1352 @itemx lam-u57-report=warning
1353 @itemx lam-u57-report=error
1354 Specify how to report the missing GNU_PROPERTY_X86_FEATURE_1_LAM_U57
1355 property in input .note.gnu.property section.
1356 @option{lam-u57-report=none}, which is the default, will make the
1357 linker not report missing properties in input files.
1358 @option{lam-u57-report=warning} will make the linker issue a warning for
1359 missing properties in input files. @option{lam-u57-report=error} will
1360 make the linker issue an error for missing properties in input files.
1361 Supported for Linux/x86_64.
1362
1363 @item lam-report=none
1364 @itemx lam-report=warning
1365 @itemx lam-report=error
1366 Specify how to report the missing GNU_PROPERTY_X86_FEATURE_1_LAM_U48 and
1367 GNU_PROPERTY_X86_FEATURE_1_LAM_U57 properties in input .note.gnu.property
1368 section. @option{lam-report=none}, which is the default, will make the
1369 linker not report missing properties in input files.
1370 @option{lam-report=warning} will make the linker issue a warning for
1371 missing properties in input files. @option{lam-report=error} will make
1372 the linker issue an error for missing properties in input files.
1373 Supported for Linux/x86_64.
1374
1375 @item lazy
1376 When generating an executable or shared library, mark it to tell the
1377 dynamic linker to defer function call resolution to the point when
1378 the function is called (lazy binding), rather than at load time.
1379 Lazy binding is the default.
1380
1381 @item loadfltr
1382 Specify that the object's filters be processed immediately at runtime.
1383
1384 @item max-page-size=@var{value}
1385 Set the maximum memory page size supported to @var{value}.
1386
1387 @item muldefs
1388 Allow multiple definitions.
1389
1390 @item nocopyreloc
1391 Disable linker generated .dynbss variables used in place of variables
1392 defined in shared libraries. May result in dynamic text relocations.
1393
1394 @item nodefaultlib
1395 Specify that the dynamic loader search for dependencies of this object
1396 should ignore any default library search paths.
1397
1398 @item nodelete
1399 Specify that the object shouldn't be unloaded at runtime.
1400
1401 @item nodlopen
1402 Specify that the object is not available to @code{dlopen}.
1403
1404 @item nodump
1405 Specify that the object can not be dumped by @code{dldump}.
1406
1407 @item noexecstack
1408 Marks the object as not requiring executable stack.
1409
1410 @item noextern-protected-data
1411 Don't treat protected data symbols as external when building a shared
1412 library. This option overrides the linker backend default. It can be
1413 used to work around incorrect relocations against protected data symbols
1414 generated by compiler. Updates on protected data symbols by another
1415 module aren't visible to the resulting shared library. Supported for
1416 i386 and x86-64.
1417
1418 @item noreloc-overflow
1419 Disable relocation overflow check. This can be used to disable
1420 relocation overflow check if there will be no dynamic relocation
1421 overflow at run-time. Supported for x86_64.
1422
1423 @item now
1424 When generating an executable or shared library, mark it to tell the
1425 dynamic linker to resolve all symbols when the program is started, or
1426 when the shared library is loaded by dlopen, instead of deferring
1427 function call resolution to the point when the function is first
1428 called.
1429
1430 @item origin
1431 Specify that the object requires @samp{$ORIGIN} handling in paths.
1432
1433 @item pack-relative-relocs
1434 @itemx nopack-relative-relocs
1435 Generate compact relative relocation in position-independent executable
1436 and shared library. It adds @code{DT_RELR}, @code{DT_RELRSZ} and
1437 @code{DT_RELRENT} entries to the dynamic section. It is ignored when
1438 building position-dependent executable and relocatable output.
1439 @option{nopack-relative-relocs} is the default, which disables compact
1440 relative relocation. When linked against the GNU C Library, a
1441 GLIBC_ABI_DT_RELR symbol version dependency on the shared C Library is
1442 added to the output. Supported for i386 and x86-64.
1443
1444 @item relro
1445 @itemx norelro
1446 Create an ELF @code{PT_GNU_RELRO} segment header in the object. This
1447 specifies a memory segment that should be made read-only after
1448 relocation, if supported. Specifying @samp{common-page-size} smaller
1449 than the system page size will render this protection ineffective.
1450 Don't create an ELF @code{PT_GNU_RELRO} segment if @samp{norelro}.
1451
1452 @item report-relative-reloc
1453 Report dynamic relative relocations generated by linker. Supported for
1454 Linux/i386 and Linux/x86_64.
1455
1456 @item separate-code
1457 @itemx noseparate-code
1458 Create separate code @code{PT_LOAD} segment header in the object. This
1459 specifies a memory segment that should contain only instructions and must
1460 be in wholly disjoint pages from any other data. Don't create separate
1461 code @code{PT_LOAD} segment if @samp{noseparate-code} is used.
1462
1463 @item shstk
1464 Generate GNU_PROPERTY_X86_FEATURE_1_SHSTK in .note.gnu.property section
1465 to indicate compatibility with Intel Shadow Stack. Supported for
1466 Linux/i386 and Linux/x86_64.
1467
1468 @item stack-size=@var{value}
1469 Specify a stack size for an ELF @code{PT_GNU_STACK} segment.
1470 Specifying zero will override any default non-zero sized
1471 @code{PT_GNU_STACK} segment creation.
1472
1473 @item start-stop-gc
1474 @itemx nostart-stop-gc
1475 @cindex start-stop-gc
1476 When @samp{--gc-sections} is in effect, a reference from a retained
1477 section to @code{__start_SECNAME} or @code{__stop_SECNAME} causes all
1478 input sections named @code{SECNAME} to also be retained, if
1479 @code{SECNAME} is representable as a C identifier and either
1480 @code{__start_SECNAME} or @code{__stop_SECNAME} is synthesized by the
1481 linker. @samp{-z start-stop-gc} disables this effect, allowing
1482 sections to be garbage collected as if the special synthesized symbols
1483 were not defined. @samp{-z start-stop-gc} has no effect on a
1484 definition of @code{__start_SECNAME} or @code{__stop_SECNAME} in an
1485 object file or linker script. Such a definition will prevent the
1486 linker providing a synthesized @code{__start_SECNAME} or
1487 @code{__stop_SECNAME} respectively, and therefore the special
1488 treatment by garbage collection for those references.
1489
1490 @item start-stop-visibility=@var{value}
1491 @cindex visibility
1492 @cindex ELF symbol visibility
1493 Specify the ELF symbol visibility for synthesized
1494 @code{__start_SECNAME} and @code{__stop_SECNAME} symbols (@pxref{Input
1495 Section Example}). @var{value} must be exactly @samp{default},
1496 @samp{internal}, @samp{hidden}, or @samp{protected}. If no @samp{-z
1497 start-stop-visibility} option is given, @samp{protected} is used for
1498 compatibility with historical practice. However, it's highly
1499 recommended to use @samp{-z start-stop-visibility=hidden} in new
1500 programs and shared libraries so that these symbols are not exported
1501 between shared objects, which is not usually what's intended.
1502
1503 @item text
1504 @itemx notext
1505 @itemx textoff
1506 Report an error if DT_TEXTREL is set, i.e., if the position-independent
1507 or shared object has dynamic relocations in read-only sections. Don't
1508 report an error if @samp{notext} or @samp{textoff}.
1509
1510 @item undefs
1511 Do not report unresolved symbol references from regular object files,
1512 either when creating an executable, or when creating a shared library.
1513 This option is the inverse of @samp{-z defs}.
1514
1515 @item unique-symbol
1516 @itemx nounique-symbol
1517 Avoid duplicated local symbol names in the symbol string table. Append
1518 ".@code{number}" to duplicated local symbol names if @samp{unique-symbol}
1519 is used. @option{nounique-symbol} is the default.
1520
1521 @item x86-64-baseline
1522 @item x86-64-v2
1523 @item x86-64-v3
1524 @itemx x86-64-v4
1525 Specify the x86-64 ISA level needed in .note.gnu.property section.
1526 @option{x86-64-baseline} generates @code{GNU_PROPERTY_X86_ISA_1_BASELINE}.
1527 @option{x86-64-v2} generates @code{GNU_PROPERTY_X86_ISA_1_V2}.
1528 @option{x86-64-v3} generates @code{GNU_PROPERTY_X86_ISA_1_V3}.
1529 @option{x86-64-v4} generates @code{GNU_PROPERTY_X86_ISA_1_V4}.
1530 Supported for Linux/i386 and Linux/x86_64.
1531
1532 @end table
1533
1534 Other keywords are ignored for Solaris compatibility.
1535
1536 @kindex -(
1537 @cindex groups of archives
1538 @item -( @var{archives} -)
1539 @itemx --start-group @var{archives} --end-group
1540 The @var{archives} should be a list of archive files. They may be
1541 either explicit file names, or @samp{-l} options.
1542
1543 The specified archives are searched repeatedly until no new undefined
1544 references are created. Normally, an archive is searched only once in
1545 the order that it is specified on the command line. If a symbol in that
1546 archive is needed to resolve an undefined symbol referred to by an
1547 object in an archive that appears later on the command line, the linker
1548 would not be able to resolve that reference. By grouping the archives,
1549 they will all be searched repeatedly until all possible references are
1550 resolved.
1551
1552 Using this option has a significant performance cost. It is best to use
1553 it only when there are unavoidable circular references between two or
1554 more archives.
1555
1556 @kindex --accept-unknown-input-arch
1557 @kindex --no-accept-unknown-input-arch
1558 @item --accept-unknown-input-arch
1559 @itemx --no-accept-unknown-input-arch
1560 Tells the linker to accept input files whose architecture cannot be
1561 recognised. The assumption is that the user knows what they are doing
1562 and deliberately wants to link in these unknown input files. This was
1563 the default behaviour of the linker, before release 2.14. The default
1564 behaviour from release 2.14 onwards is to reject such input files, and
1565 so the @samp{--accept-unknown-input-arch} option has been added to
1566 restore the old behaviour.
1567
1568 @kindex --as-needed
1569 @kindex --no-as-needed
1570 @item --as-needed
1571 @itemx --no-as-needed
1572 This option affects ELF DT_NEEDED tags for dynamic libraries mentioned
1573 on the command line after the @option{--as-needed} option. Normally
1574 the linker will add a DT_NEEDED tag for each dynamic library mentioned
1575 on the command line, regardless of whether the library is actually
1576 needed or not. @option{--as-needed} causes a DT_NEEDED tag to only be
1577 emitted for a library that @emph{at that point in the link} satisfies a
1578 non-weak undefined symbol reference from a regular object file or, if
1579 the library is not found in the DT_NEEDED lists of other needed libraries, a
1580 non-weak undefined symbol reference from another needed dynamic library.
1581 Object files or libraries appearing on the command line @emph{after}
1582 the library in question do not affect whether the library is seen as
1583 needed. This is similar to the rules for extraction of object files
1584 from archives. @option{--no-as-needed} restores the default behaviour.
1585
1586 Note: On Linux based systems the @option{--as-needed} option also has
1587 an affect on the behaviour of the @option{--rpath} and
1588 @option{--rpath-link} options. See the description of
1589 @option{--rpath-link} for more details.
1590
1591 @kindex --add-needed
1592 @kindex --no-add-needed
1593 @item --add-needed
1594 @itemx --no-add-needed
1595 These two options have been deprecated because of the similarity of
1596 their names to the @option{--as-needed} and @option{--no-as-needed}
1597 options. They have been replaced by @option{--copy-dt-needed-entries}
1598 and @option{--no-copy-dt-needed-entries}.
1599
1600 @kindex -assert @var{keyword}
1601 @item -assert @var{keyword}
1602 This option is ignored for SunOS compatibility.
1603
1604 @kindex -Bdynamic
1605 @kindex -dy
1606 @kindex -call_shared
1607 @item -Bdynamic
1608 @itemx -dy
1609 @itemx -call_shared
1610 Link against dynamic libraries. This is only meaningful on platforms
1611 for which shared libraries are supported. This option is normally the
1612 default on such platforms. The different variants of this option are
1613 for compatibility with various systems. You may use this option
1614 multiple times on the command line: it affects library searching for
1615 @option{-l} options which follow it.
1616
1617 @kindex -Bgroup
1618 @item -Bgroup
1619 Set the @code{DF_1_GROUP} flag in the @code{DT_FLAGS_1} entry in the dynamic
1620 section. This causes the runtime linker to handle lookups in this
1621 object and its dependencies to be performed only inside the group.
1622 @option{--unresolved-symbols=report-all} is implied. This option is
1623 only meaningful on ELF platforms which support shared libraries.
1624
1625 @kindex -Bstatic
1626 @kindex -dn
1627 @kindex -non_shared
1628 @kindex -static
1629 @item -Bstatic
1630 @itemx -dn
1631 @itemx -non_shared
1632 @itemx -static
1633 Do not link against shared libraries. This is only meaningful on
1634 platforms for which shared libraries are supported. The different
1635 variants of this option are for compatibility with various systems. You
1636 may use this option multiple times on the command line: it affects
1637 library searching for @option{-l} options which follow it. This
1638 option also implies @option{--unresolved-symbols=report-all}. This
1639 option can be used with @option{-shared}. Doing so means that a
1640 shared library is being created but that all of the library's external
1641 references must be resolved by pulling in entries from static
1642 libraries.
1643
1644 @kindex -Bsymbolic
1645 @item -Bsymbolic
1646 When creating a shared library, bind references to global symbols to the
1647 definition within the shared library, if any. Normally, it is possible
1648 for a program linked against a shared library to override the definition
1649 within the shared library. This option is only meaningful on ELF
1650 platforms which support shared libraries.
1651
1652 @kindex -Bsymbolic-functions
1653 @item -Bsymbolic-functions
1654 When creating a shared library, bind references to global function
1655 symbols to the definition within the shared library, if any.
1656 This option is only meaningful on ELF platforms which support shared
1657 libraries.
1658
1659 @kindex -Bno-symbolic
1660 @item -Bno-symbolic
1661 This option can cancel previously specified @samp{-Bsymbolic} and
1662 @samp{-Bsymbolic-functions}.
1663
1664 @kindex --dynamic-list=@var{dynamic-list-file}
1665 @item --dynamic-list=@var{dynamic-list-file}
1666 Specify the name of a dynamic list file to the linker. This is
1667 typically used when creating shared libraries to specify a list of
1668 global symbols whose references shouldn't be bound to the definition
1669 within the shared library, or creating dynamically linked executables
1670 to specify a list of symbols which should be added to the symbol table
1671 in the executable. This option is only meaningful on ELF platforms
1672 which support shared libraries.
1673
1674 The format of the dynamic list is the same as the version node without
1675 scope and node name. See @ref{VERSION} for more information.
1676
1677 @kindex --dynamic-list-data
1678 @item --dynamic-list-data
1679 Include all global data symbols to the dynamic list.
1680
1681 @kindex --dynamic-list-cpp-new
1682 @item --dynamic-list-cpp-new
1683 Provide the builtin dynamic list for C++ operator new and delete. It
1684 is mainly useful for building shared libstdc++.
1685
1686 @kindex --dynamic-list-cpp-typeinfo
1687 @item --dynamic-list-cpp-typeinfo
1688 Provide the builtin dynamic list for C++ runtime type identification.
1689
1690 @kindex --check-sections
1691 @kindex --no-check-sections
1692 @item --check-sections
1693 @itemx --no-check-sections
1694 Asks the linker @emph{not} to check section addresses after they have
1695 been assigned to see if there are any overlaps. Normally the linker will
1696 perform this check, and if it finds any overlaps it will produce
1697 suitable error messages. The linker does know about, and does make
1698 allowances for sections in overlays. The default behaviour can be
1699 restored by using the command-line switch @option{--check-sections}.
1700 Section overlap is not usually checked for relocatable links. You can
1701 force checking in that case by using the @option{--check-sections}
1702 option.
1703
1704 @kindex --copy-dt-needed-entries
1705 @kindex --no-copy-dt-needed-entries
1706 @item --copy-dt-needed-entries
1707 @itemx --no-copy-dt-needed-entries
1708 This option affects the treatment of dynamic libraries referred to
1709 by DT_NEEDED tags @emph{inside} ELF dynamic libraries mentioned on the
1710 command line. Normally the linker won't add a DT_NEEDED tag to the
1711 output binary for each library mentioned in a DT_NEEDED tag in an
1712 input dynamic library. With @option{--copy-dt-needed-entries}
1713 specified on the command line however any dynamic libraries that
1714 follow it will have their DT_NEEDED entries added. The default
1715 behaviour can be restored with @option{--no-copy-dt-needed-entries}.
1716
1717 This option also has an effect on the resolution of symbols in dynamic
1718 libraries. With @option{--copy-dt-needed-entries} dynamic libraries
1719 mentioned on the command line will be recursively searched, following
1720 their DT_NEEDED tags to other libraries, in order to resolve symbols
1721 required by the output binary. With the default setting however
1722 the searching of dynamic libraries that follow it will stop with the
1723 dynamic library itself. No DT_NEEDED links will be traversed to resolve
1724 symbols.
1725
1726 @cindex cross reference table
1727 @kindex --cref
1728 @item --cref
1729 Output a cross reference table. If a linker map file is being
1730 generated, the cross reference table is printed to the map file.
1731 Otherwise, it is printed on the standard output.
1732
1733 The format of the table is intentionally simple, so that it may be
1734 easily processed by a script if necessary. The symbols are printed out,
1735 sorted by name. For each symbol, a list of file names is given. If the
1736 symbol is defined, the first file listed is the location of the
1737 definition. If the symbol is defined as a common value then any files
1738 where this happens appear next. Finally any files that reference the
1739 symbol are listed.
1740
1741 @cindex ctf variables
1742 @kindex --ctf-variables
1743 @kindex --no-ctf-variables
1744 @item --ctf-variables
1745 @item --no-ctf-variables
1746 The CTF debuginfo format supports a section which encodes the names and
1747 types of variables found in the program which do not appear in any symbol
1748 table. These variables clearly cannot be looked up by address by
1749 conventional debuggers, so the space used for their types and names is
1750 usually wasted: the types are usually small but the names are often not.
1751 @option{--ctf-variables} causes the generation of such a section.
1752 The default behaviour can be restored with @option{--no-ctf-variables}.
1753
1754 @cindex ctf type sharing
1755 @kindex --ctf-share-types
1756 @item --ctf-share-types=@var{method}
1757 Adjust the method used to share types between translation units in CTF.
1758
1759 @table @samp
1760 @item share-unconflicted
1761 Put all types that do not have ambiguous definitions into the shared dictionary,
1762 where debuggers can easily access them, even if they only occur in one
1763 translation unit. This is the default.
1764
1765 @item share-duplicated
1766 Put only types that occur in multiple translation units into the shared
1767 dictionary: types with only one definition go into per-translation-unit
1768 dictionaries. Types with ambiguous definitions in multiple translation units
1769 always go into per-translation-unit dictionaries. This tends to make the CTF
1770 larger, but may reduce the amount of CTF in the shared dictionary. For very
1771 large projects this may speed up opening the CTF and save memory in the CTF
1772 consumer at runtime.
1773 @end table
1774
1775 @cindex common allocation
1776 @kindex --no-define-common
1777 @item --no-define-common
1778 This option inhibits the assignment of addresses to common symbols.
1779 The script command @code{INHIBIT_COMMON_ALLOCATION} has the same effect.
1780 @xref{Miscellaneous Commands}.
1781
1782 The @samp{--no-define-common} option allows decoupling
1783 the decision to assign addresses to Common symbols from the choice
1784 of the output file type; otherwise a non-Relocatable output type
1785 forces assigning addresses to Common symbols.
1786 Using @samp{--no-define-common} allows Common symbols that are referenced
1787 from a shared library to be assigned addresses only in the main program.
1788 This eliminates the unused duplicate space in the shared library,
1789 and also prevents any possible confusion over resolving to the wrong
1790 duplicate when there are many dynamic modules with specialized search
1791 paths for runtime symbol resolution.
1792
1793 @cindex group allocation in linker script
1794 @cindex section groups
1795 @cindex COMDAT
1796 @kindex --force-group-allocation
1797 @item --force-group-allocation
1798 This option causes the linker to place section group members like
1799 normal input sections, and to delete the section groups. This is the
1800 default behaviour for a final link but this option can be used to
1801 change the behaviour of a relocatable link (@samp{-r}). The script
1802 command @code{FORCE_GROUP_ALLOCATION} has the same
1803 effect. @xref{Miscellaneous Commands}.
1804
1805 @cindex symbols, from command line
1806 @kindex --defsym=@var{symbol}=@var{exp}
1807 @item --defsym=@var{symbol}=@var{expression}
1808 Create a global symbol in the output file, containing the absolute
1809 address given by @var{expression}. You may use this option as many
1810 times as necessary to define multiple symbols in the command line. A
1811 limited form of arithmetic is supported for the @var{expression} in this
1812 context: you may give a hexadecimal constant or the name of an existing
1813 symbol, or use @code{+} and @code{-} to add or subtract hexadecimal
1814 constants or symbols. If you need more elaborate expressions, consider
1815 using the linker command language from a script (@pxref{Assignments}).
1816 @emph{Note:} there should be no white space between @var{symbol}, the
1817 equals sign (``@key{=}''), and @var{expression}.
1818
1819 The linker processes @samp{--defsym} arguments and @samp{-T} arguments
1820 in order, placing @samp{--defsym} before @samp{-T} will define the
1821 symbol before the linker script from @samp{-T} is processed, while
1822 placing @samp{--defsym} after @samp{-T} will define the symbol after
1823 the linker script has been processed. This difference has
1824 consequences for expressions within the linker script that use the
1825 @samp{--defsym} symbols, which order is correct will depend on what
1826 you are trying to achieve.
1827
1828 @cindex demangling, from command line
1829 @kindex --demangle[=@var{style}]
1830 @kindex --no-demangle
1831 @item --demangle[=@var{style}]
1832 @itemx --no-demangle
1833 These options control whether to demangle symbol names in error messages
1834 and other output. When the linker is told to demangle, it tries to
1835 present symbol names in a readable fashion: it strips leading
1836 underscores if they are used by the object file format, and converts C++
1837 mangled symbol names into user readable names. Different compilers have
1838 different mangling styles. The optional demangling style argument can be used
1839 to choose an appropriate demangling style for your compiler. The linker will
1840 demangle by default unless the environment variable @samp{COLLECT_NO_DEMANGLE}
1841 is set. These options may be used to override the default.
1842
1843 @cindex dynamic linker, from command line
1844 @kindex -I@var{file}
1845 @kindex --dynamic-linker=@var{file}
1846 @item -I@var{file}
1847 @itemx --dynamic-linker=@var{file}
1848 Set the name of the dynamic linker. This is only meaningful when
1849 generating dynamically linked ELF executables. The default dynamic
1850 linker is normally correct; don't use this unless you know what you are
1851 doing.
1852
1853 @kindex --no-dynamic-linker
1854 @item --no-dynamic-linker
1855 When producing an executable file, omit the request for a dynamic
1856 linker to be used at load-time. This is only meaningful for ELF
1857 executables that contain dynamic relocations, and usually requires
1858 entry point code that is capable of processing these relocations.
1859
1860 @kindex --embedded-relocs
1861 @item --embedded-relocs
1862 This option is similar to the @option{--emit-relocs} option except
1863 that the relocs are stored in a target-specific section. This option
1864 is only supported by the @samp{BFIN}, @samp{CR16} and @emph{M68K}
1865 targets.
1866
1867 @kindex --disable-multiple-abs-defs
1868 @item --disable-multiple-abs-defs
1869 Do not allow multiple definitions with symbols included
1870 in filename invoked by -R or --just-symbols
1871
1872 @kindex --fatal-warnings
1873 @kindex --no-fatal-warnings
1874 @item --fatal-warnings
1875 @itemx --no-fatal-warnings
1876 Treat all warnings as errors. The default behaviour can be restored
1877 with the option @option{--no-fatal-warnings}.
1878
1879 @kindex --force-exe-suffix
1880 @item --force-exe-suffix
1881 Make sure that an output file has a .exe suffix.
1882
1883 If a successfully built fully linked output file does not have a
1884 @code{.exe} or @code{.dll} suffix, this option forces the linker to copy
1885 the output file to one of the same name with a @code{.exe} suffix. This
1886 option is useful when using unmodified Unix makefiles on a Microsoft
1887 Windows host, since some versions of Windows won't run an image unless
1888 it ends in a @code{.exe} suffix.
1889
1890 @kindex --gc-sections
1891 @kindex --no-gc-sections
1892 @cindex garbage collection
1893 @item --gc-sections
1894 @itemx --no-gc-sections
1895 Enable garbage collection of unused input sections. It is ignored on
1896 targets that do not support this option. The default behaviour (of not
1897 performing this garbage collection) can be restored by specifying
1898 @samp{--no-gc-sections} on the command line. Note that garbage
1899 collection for COFF and PE format targets is supported, but the
1900 implementation is currently considered to be experimental.
1901
1902 @samp{--gc-sections} decides which input sections are used by
1903 examining symbols and relocations. The section containing the entry
1904 symbol and all sections containing symbols undefined on the
1905 command-line will be kept, as will sections containing symbols
1906 referenced by dynamic objects. Note that when building shared
1907 libraries, the linker must assume that any visible symbol is
1908 referenced. Once this initial set of sections has been determined,
1909 the linker recursively marks as used any section referenced by their
1910 relocations. See @samp{--entry}, @samp{--undefined}, and
1911 @samp{--gc-keep-exported}.
1912
1913 This option can be set when doing a partial link (enabled with option
1914 @samp{-r}). In this case the root of symbols kept must be explicitly
1915 specified either by one of the options @samp{--entry},
1916 @samp{--undefined}, or @samp{--gc-keep-exported} or by a @code{ENTRY}
1917 command in the linker script.
1918
1919 As a GNU extension, ELF input sections marked with the
1920 @code{SHF_GNU_RETAIN} flag will not be garbage collected.
1921
1922 @kindex --print-gc-sections
1923 @kindex --no-print-gc-sections
1924 @cindex garbage collection
1925 @item --print-gc-sections
1926 @itemx --no-print-gc-sections
1927 List all sections removed by garbage collection. The listing is
1928 printed on stderr. This option is only effective if garbage
1929 collection has been enabled via the @samp{--gc-sections}) option. The
1930 default behaviour (of not listing the sections that are removed) can
1931 be restored by specifying @samp{--no-print-gc-sections} on the command
1932 line.
1933
1934 @kindex --gc-keep-exported
1935 @cindex garbage collection
1936 @item --gc-keep-exported
1937 When @samp{--gc-sections} is enabled, this option prevents garbage
1938 collection of unused input sections that contain global symbols having
1939 default or protected visibility. This option is intended to be used for
1940 executables where unreferenced sections would otherwise be garbage
1941 collected regardless of the external visibility of contained symbols.
1942 Note that this option has no effect when linking shared objects since
1943 it is already the default behaviour. This option is only supported for
1944 ELF format targets.
1945
1946 @kindex --print-output-format
1947 @cindex output format
1948 @item --print-output-format
1949 Print the name of the default output format (perhaps influenced by
1950 other command-line options). This is the string that would appear
1951 in an @code{OUTPUT_FORMAT} linker script command (@pxref{File Commands}).
1952
1953 @kindex --print-memory-usage
1954 @cindex memory usage
1955 @item --print-memory-usage
1956 Print used size, total size and used size of memory regions created with
1957 the @ref{MEMORY} command. This is useful on embedded targets to have a
1958 quick view of amount of free memory. The format of the output has one
1959 headline and one line per region. It is both human readable and easily
1960 parsable by tools. Here is an example of an output:
1961
1962 @smallexample
1963 Memory region Used Size Region Size %age Used
1964 ROM: 256 KB 1 MB 25.00%
1965 RAM: 32 B 2 GB 0.00%
1966 @end smallexample
1967
1968 @cindex help
1969 @cindex usage
1970 @kindex --help
1971 @item --help
1972 Print a summary of the command-line options on the standard output and exit.
1973
1974 @kindex --target-help
1975 @item --target-help
1976 Print a summary of all target-specific options on the standard output and exit.
1977
1978 @kindex -Map=@var{mapfile}
1979 @item -Map=@var{mapfile}
1980 Print a link map to the file @var{mapfile}. See the description of the
1981 @option{-M} option, above. If @var{mapfile} is just the character
1982 @code{-} then the map will be written to stdout.
1983
1984 Specifying a directory as @var{mapfile} causes the linker map to be
1985 written as a file inside the directory. Normally name of the file
1986 inside the directory is computed as the basename of the @var{output}
1987 file with @code{.map} appended. If however the special character
1988 @code{%} is used then this will be replaced by the full path of the
1989 output file. Additionally if there are any characters after the
1990 @var{%} symbol then @code{.map} will no longer be appended.
1991
1992 @smallexample
1993 -o foo.exe -Map=bar [Creates ./bar]
1994 -o ../dir/foo.exe -Map=bar [Creates ./bar]
1995 -o foo.exe -Map=../dir [Creates ../dir/foo.exe.map]
1996 -o ../dir2/foo.exe -Map=../dir [Creates ../dir/foo.exe.map]
1997 -o foo.exe -Map=% [Creates ./foo.exe.map]
1998 -o ../dir/foo.exe -Map=% [Creates ../dir/foo.exe.map]
1999 -o foo.exe -Map=%.bar [Creates ./foo.exe.bar]
2000 -o ../dir/foo.exe -Map=%.bar [Creates ../dir/foo.exe.bar]
2001 -o ../dir2/foo.exe -Map=../dir/% [Creates ../dir/../dir2/foo.exe.map]
2002 -o ../dir2/foo.exe -Map=../dir/%.bar [Creates ../dir/../dir2/foo.exe.bar]
2003 @end smallexample
2004
2005 It is an error to specify more than one @code{%} character.
2006
2007 If the map file already exists then it will be overwritten by this
2008 operation.
2009
2010 @cindex memory usage
2011 @kindex --no-keep-memory
2012 @item --no-keep-memory
2013 @command{ld} normally optimizes for speed over memory usage by caching the
2014 symbol tables of input files in memory. This option tells @command{ld} to
2015 instead optimize for memory usage, by rereading the symbol tables as
2016 necessary. This may be required if @command{ld} runs out of memory space
2017 while linking a large executable.
2018
2019 @kindex --no-undefined
2020 @kindex -z defs
2021 @kindex -z undefs
2022 @item --no-undefined
2023 @itemx -z defs
2024 Report unresolved symbol references from regular object files. This
2025 is done even if the linker is creating a non-symbolic shared library.
2026 The switch @option{--[no-]allow-shlib-undefined} controls the
2027 behaviour for reporting unresolved references found in shared
2028 libraries being linked in.
2029
2030 The effects of this option can be reverted by using @code{-z undefs}.
2031
2032 @kindex --allow-multiple-definition
2033 @kindex -z muldefs
2034 @item --allow-multiple-definition
2035 @itemx -z muldefs
2036 Normally when a symbol is defined multiple times, the linker will
2037 report a fatal error. These options allow multiple definitions and the
2038 first definition will be used.
2039
2040 @kindex --allow-shlib-undefined
2041 @kindex --no-allow-shlib-undefined
2042 @item --allow-shlib-undefined
2043 @itemx --no-allow-shlib-undefined
2044 Allows or disallows undefined symbols in shared libraries.
2045 This switch is similar to @option{--no-undefined} except that it
2046 determines the behaviour when the undefined symbols are in a
2047 shared library rather than a regular object file. It does not affect
2048 how undefined symbols in regular object files are handled.
2049
2050 The default behaviour is to report errors for any undefined symbols
2051 referenced in shared libraries if the linker is being used to create
2052 an executable, but to allow them if the linker is being used to create
2053 a shared library.
2054
2055 The reasons for allowing undefined symbol references in shared
2056 libraries specified at link time are that:
2057
2058 @itemize @bullet
2059 @item
2060 A shared library specified at link time may not be the same as the one
2061 that is available at load time, so the symbol might actually be
2062 resolvable at load time.
2063 @item
2064 There are some operating systems, eg BeOS and HPPA, where undefined
2065 symbols in shared libraries are normal.
2066
2067 The BeOS kernel for example patches shared libraries at load time to
2068 select whichever function is most appropriate for the current
2069 architecture. This is used, for example, to dynamically select an
2070 appropriate memset function.
2071 @end itemize
2072
2073 @kindex --error-handling-script=@var{scriptname}
2074 @item --error-handling-script=@var{scriptname}
2075 If this option is provided then the linker will invoke
2076 @var{scriptname} whenever an error is encountered. Currently however
2077 only two kinds of error are supported: missing symbols and missing
2078 libraries. Two arguments will be passed to script: the keyword
2079 ``undefined-symbol'' or `missing-lib'' and the @var{name} of the
2080 undefined symbol or missing library. The intention is that the script
2081 will provide suggestions to the user as to where the symbol or library
2082 might be found. After the script has finished then the normal linker
2083 error message will be displayed.
2084
2085 The availability of this option is controlled by a configure time
2086 switch, so it may not be present in specific implementations.
2087
2088 @kindex --no-undefined-version
2089 @item --no-undefined-version
2090 Normally when a symbol has an undefined version, the linker will ignore
2091 it. This option disallows symbols with undefined version and a fatal error
2092 will be issued instead.
2093
2094 @kindex --default-symver
2095 @item --default-symver
2096 Create and use a default symbol version (the soname) for unversioned
2097 exported symbols.
2098
2099 @kindex --default-imported-symver
2100 @item --default-imported-symver
2101 Create and use a default symbol version (the soname) for unversioned
2102 imported symbols.
2103
2104 @kindex --no-warn-mismatch
2105 @item --no-warn-mismatch
2106 Normally @command{ld} will give an error if you try to link together input
2107 files that are mismatched for some reason, perhaps because they have
2108 been compiled for different processors or for different endiannesses.
2109 This option tells @command{ld} that it should silently permit such possible
2110 errors. This option should only be used with care, in cases when you
2111 have taken some special action that ensures that the linker errors are
2112 inappropriate.
2113
2114 @kindex --no-warn-search-mismatch
2115 @item --no-warn-search-mismatch
2116 Normally @command{ld} will give a warning if it finds an incompatible
2117 library during a library search. This option silences the warning.
2118
2119 @kindex --no-whole-archive
2120 @item --no-whole-archive
2121 Turn off the effect of the @option{--whole-archive} option for subsequent
2122 archive files.
2123
2124 @cindex output file after errors
2125 @kindex --noinhibit-exec
2126 @item --noinhibit-exec
2127 Retain the executable output file whenever it is still usable.
2128 Normally, the linker will not produce an output file if it encounters
2129 errors during the link process; it exits without writing an output file
2130 when it issues any error whatsoever.
2131
2132 @kindex -nostdlib
2133 @item -nostdlib
2134 Only search library directories explicitly specified on the
2135 command line. Library directories specified in linker scripts
2136 (including linker scripts specified on the command line) are ignored.
2137
2138 @ifclear SingleFormat
2139 @kindex --oformat=@var{output-format}
2140 @item --oformat=@var{output-format}
2141 @command{ld} may be configured to support more than one kind of object
2142 file. If your @command{ld} is configured this way, you can use the
2143 @samp{--oformat} option to specify the binary format for the output
2144 object file. Even when @command{ld} is configured to support alternative
2145 object formats, you don't usually need to specify this, as @command{ld}
2146 should be configured to produce as a default output format the most
2147 usual format on each machine. @var{output-format} is a text string, the
2148 name of a particular format supported by the BFD libraries. (You can
2149 list the available binary formats with @samp{objdump -i}.) The script
2150 command @code{OUTPUT_FORMAT} can also specify the output format, but
2151 this option overrides it. @xref{BFD}.
2152 @end ifclear
2153
2154 @kindex --out-implib
2155 @item --out-implib @var{file}
2156 Create an import library in @var{file} corresponding to the executable
2157 the linker is generating (eg. a DLL or ELF program). This import
2158 library (which should be called @code{*.dll.a} or @code{*.a} for DLLs)
2159 may be used to link clients against the generated executable; this
2160 behaviour makes it possible to skip a separate import library creation
2161 step (eg. @code{dlltool} for DLLs). This option is only available for
2162 the i386 PE and ELF targetted ports of the linker.
2163
2164 @kindex -pie
2165 @kindex --pic-executable
2166 @item -pie
2167 @itemx --pic-executable
2168 @cindex position independent executables
2169 Create a position independent executable. This is currently only supported on
2170 ELF platforms. Position independent executables are similar to shared
2171 libraries in that they are relocated by the dynamic linker to the virtual
2172 address the OS chooses for them (which can vary between invocations). Like
2173 normal dynamically linked executables they can be executed and symbols
2174 defined in the executable cannot be overridden by shared libraries.
2175
2176 @kindex -no-pie
2177 @item -no-pie
2178 @cindex position dependent executables
2179 Create a position dependent executable. This is the default.
2180
2181 @kindex -qmagic
2182 @item -qmagic
2183 This option is ignored for Linux compatibility.
2184
2185 @kindex -Qy
2186 @item -Qy
2187 This option is ignored for SVR4 compatibility.
2188
2189 @kindex --relax
2190 @cindex synthesizing linker
2191 @cindex relaxing addressing modes
2192 @cindex --no-relax
2193 @item --relax
2194 @itemx --no-relax
2195 An option with machine dependent effects.
2196 @ifset GENERIC
2197 This option is only supported on a few targets.
2198 @end ifset
2199 @ifset H8300
2200 @xref{H8/300,,@command{ld} and the H8/300}.
2201 @end ifset
2202 @ifset XTENSA
2203 @xref{Xtensa,, @command{ld} and Xtensa Processors}.
2204 @end ifset
2205 @ifset M68HC11
2206 @xref{M68HC11/68HC12,,@command{ld} and the 68HC11 and 68HC12}.
2207 @end ifset
2208 @ifset NIOSII
2209 @xref{Nios II,,@command{ld} and the Altera Nios II}.
2210 @end ifset
2211 @ifset POWERPC
2212 @xref{PowerPC ELF32,,@command{ld} and PowerPC 32-bit ELF Support}.
2213 @end ifset
2214
2215 On some platforms the @option{--relax} option performs target specific,
2216 global optimizations that become possible when the linker resolves
2217 addressing in the program, such as relaxing address modes,
2218 synthesizing new instructions, selecting shorter version of current
2219 instructions, and combining constant values.
2220
2221 On some platforms these link time global optimizations may make symbolic
2222 debugging of the resulting executable impossible.
2223 @ifset GENERIC
2224 This is known to be the case for the Matsushita MN10200 and MN10300
2225 family of processors.
2226 @end ifset
2227
2228 On platforms where the feature is supported, the option
2229 @option{--no-relax} will disable it.
2230
2231 On platforms where the feature is not supported, both @option{--relax}
2232 and @option{--no-relax} are accepted, but ignored.
2233
2234 @cindex retaining specified symbols
2235 @cindex stripping all but some symbols
2236 @cindex symbols, retaining selectively
2237 @kindex --retain-symbols-file=@var{filename}
2238 @item --retain-symbols-file=@var{filename}
2239 Retain @emph{only} the symbols listed in the file @var{filename},
2240 discarding all others. @var{filename} is simply a flat file, with one
2241 symbol name per line. This option is especially useful in environments
2242 @ifset GENERIC
2243 (such as VxWorks)
2244 @end ifset
2245 where a large global symbol table is accumulated gradually, to conserve
2246 run-time memory.
2247
2248 @samp{--retain-symbols-file} does @emph{not} discard undefined symbols,
2249 or symbols needed for relocations.
2250
2251 You may only specify @samp{--retain-symbols-file} once in the command
2252 line. It overrides @samp{-s} and @samp{-S}.
2253
2254 @ifset GENERIC
2255 @item -rpath=@var{dir}
2256 @cindex runtime library search path
2257 @kindex -rpath=@var{dir}
2258 Add a directory to the runtime library search path. This is used when
2259 linking an ELF executable with shared objects. All @option{-rpath}
2260 arguments are concatenated and passed to the runtime linker, which uses
2261 them to locate shared objects at runtime.
2262
2263 The @option{-rpath} option is also used when locating shared objects which
2264 are needed by shared objects explicitly included in the link; see the
2265 description of the @option{-rpath-link} option. Searching @option{-rpath}
2266 in this way is only supported by native linkers and cross linkers which
2267 have been configured with the @option{--with-sysroot} option.
2268
2269 If @option{-rpath} is not used when linking an ELF executable, the
2270 contents of the environment variable @code{LD_RUN_PATH} will be used if it
2271 is defined.
2272
2273 The @option{-rpath} option may also be used on SunOS. By default, on
2274 SunOS, the linker will form a runtime search path out of all the
2275 @option{-L} options it is given. If a @option{-rpath} option is used, the
2276 runtime search path will be formed exclusively using the @option{-rpath}
2277 options, ignoring the @option{-L} options. This can be useful when using
2278 gcc, which adds many @option{-L} options which may be on NFS mounted
2279 file systems.
2280
2281 For compatibility with other ELF linkers, if the @option{-R} option is
2282 followed by a directory name, rather than a file name, it is treated as
2283 the @option{-rpath} option.
2284 @end ifset
2285
2286 @ifset GENERIC
2287 @cindex link-time runtime library search path
2288 @kindex -rpath-link=@var{dir}
2289 @item -rpath-link=@var{dir}
2290 When using ELF or SunOS, one shared library may require another. This
2291 happens when an @code{ld -shared} link includes a shared library as one
2292 of the input files.
2293
2294 When the linker encounters such a dependency when doing a non-shared,
2295 non-relocatable link, it will automatically try to locate the required
2296 shared library and include it in the link, if it is not included
2297 explicitly. In such a case, the @option{-rpath-link} option
2298 specifies the first set of directories to search. The
2299 @option{-rpath-link} option may specify a sequence of directory names
2300 either by specifying a list of names separated by colons, or by
2301 appearing multiple times.
2302
2303 The tokens @var{$ORIGIN} and @var{$LIB} can appear in these search
2304 directories. They will be replaced by the full path to the directory
2305 containing the program or shared object in the case of @var{$ORIGIN}
2306 and either @samp{lib} - for 32-bit binaries - or @samp{lib64} - for
2307 64-bit binaries - in the case of @var{$LIB}.
2308
2309 The alternative form of these tokens - @var{$@{ORIGIN@}} and
2310 @var{$@{LIB@}} can also be used. The token @var{$PLATFORM} is not
2311 supported.
2312
2313 This option should be used with caution as it overrides the search path
2314 that may have been hard compiled into a shared library. In such a case it
2315 is possible to use unintentionally a different search path than the
2316 runtime linker would do.
2317
2318 The linker uses the following search paths to locate required shared
2319 libraries:
2320
2321 @enumerate
2322 @item
2323 Any directories specified by @option{-rpath-link} options.
2324 @item
2325 Any directories specified by @option{-rpath} options. The difference
2326 between @option{-rpath} and @option{-rpath-link} is that directories
2327 specified by @option{-rpath} options are included in the executable and
2328 used at runtime, whereas the @option{-rpath-link} option is only effective
2329 at link time. Searching @option{-rpath} in this way is only supported
2330 by native linkers and cross linkers which have been configured with
2331 the @option{--with-sysroot} option.
2332 @item
2333 On an ELF system, for native linkers, if the @option{-rpath} and
2334 @option{-rpath-link} options were not used, search the contents of the
2335 environment variable @code{LD_RUN_PATH}.
2336 @item
2337 On SunOS, if the @option{-rpath} option was not used, search any
2338 directories specified using @option{-L} options.
2339 @item
2340 For a native linker, search the contents of the environment
2341 variable @code{LD_LIBRARY_PATH}.
2342 @item
2343 For a native ELF linker, the directories in @code{DT_RUNPATH} or
2344 @code{DT_RPATH} of a shared library are searched for shared
2345 libraries needed by it. The @code{DT_RPATH} entries are ignored if
2346 @code{DT_RUNPATH} entries exist.
2347 @item
2348 For a linker for a Linux system, if the file @file{/etc/ld.so.conf}
2349 exists, the list of directories found in that file. Note: the path
2350 to this file is prefixed with the @code{sysroot} value, if that is
2351 defined, and then any @code{prefix} string if the linker was
2352 configured with the @command{--prefix=<path>} option.
2353 @item
2354 For a native linker on a FreeBSD system, any directories specified by
2355 the @code{_PATH_ELF_HINTS} macro defined in the @file{elf-hints.h}
2356 header file.
2357 @item
2358 Any directories specified by a @code{SEARCH_DIR} command in a
2359 linker script given on the command line, including scripts specified
2360 by @option{-T} (but not @option{-dT}).
2361 @item
2362 The default directories, normally @file{/lib} and @file{/usr/lib}.
2363 @item
2364 Any directories specified by a plugin LDPT_SET_EXTRA_LIBRARY_PATH.
2365 @item
2366 Any directories specified by a @code{SEARCH_DIR} command in a default
2367 linker script.
2368 @end enumerate
2369
2370 Note however on Linux based systems there is an additional caveat: If
2371 the @option{--as-needed} option is active @emph{and} a shared library
2372 is located which would normally satisfy the search @emph{and} this
2373 library does not have DT_NEEDED tag for @file{libc.so}
2374 @emph{and} there is a shared library later on in the set of search
2375 directories which also satisfies the search @emph{and}
2376 this second shared library does have a DT_NEEDED tag for
2377 @file{libc.so} @emph{then} the second library will be selected instead
2378 of the first.
2379
2380 If the required shared library is not found, the linker will issue a
2381 warning and continue with the link.
2382
2383 @end ifset
2384
2385 @kindex -shared
2386 @kindex -Bshareable
2387 @item -shared
2388 @itemx -Bshareable
2389 @cindex shared libraries
2390 Create a shared library. This is currently only supported on ELF, XCOFF
2391 and SunOS platforms. On SunOS, the linker will automatically create a
2392 shared library if the @option{-e} option is not used and there are
2393 undefined symbols in the link.
2394
2395 @kindex --sort-common
2396 @item --sort-common
2397 @itemx --sort-common=ascending
2398 @itemx --sort-common=descending
2399 This option tells @command{ld} to sort the common symbols by alignment in
2400 ascending or descending order when it places them in the appropriate output
2401 sections. The symbol alignments considered are sixteen-byte or larger,
2402 eight-byte, four-byte, two-byte, and one-byte. This is to prevent gaps
2403 between symbols due to alignment constraints. If no sorting order is
2404 specified, then descending order is assumed.
2405
2406 @kindex --sort-section=name
2407 @item --sort-section=name
2408 This option will apply @code{SORT_BY_NAME} to all wildcard section
2409 patterns in the linker script.
2410
2411 @kindex --sort-section=alignment
2412 @item --sort-section=alignment
2413 This option will apply @code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} to all wildcard section
2414 patterns in the linker script.
2415
2416 @kindex --spare-dynamic-tags
2417 @item --spare-dynamic-tags=@var{count}
2418 This option specifies the number of empty slots to leave in the
2419 .dynamic section of ELF shared objects. Empty slots may be needed by
2420 post processing tools, such as the prelinker. The default is 5.
2421
2422 @kindex --split-by-file
2423 @item --split-by-file[=@var{size}]
2424 Similar to @option{--split-by-reloc} but creates a new output section for
2425 each input file when @var{size} is reached. @var{size} defaults to a
2426 size of 1 if not given.
2427
2428 @kindex --split-by-reloc
2429 @item --split-by-reloc[=@var{count}]
2430 Tries to creates extra sections in the output file so that no single
2431 output section in the file contains more than @var{count} relocations.
2432 This is useful when generating huge relocatable files for downloading into
2433 certain real time kernels with the COFF object file format; since COFF
2434 cannot represent more than 65535 relocations in a single section. Note
2435 that this will fail to work with object file formats which do not
2436 support arbitrary sections. The linker will not split up individual
2437 input sections for redistribution, so if a single input section contains
2438 more than @var{count} relocations one output section will contain that
2439 many relocations. @var{count} defaults to a value of 32768.
2440
2441 @kindex --stats
2442 @item --stats
2443 Compute and display statistics about the operation of the linker, such
2444 as execution time and memory usage.
2445
2446 @kindex --sysroot=@var{directory}
2447 @item --sysroot=@var{directory}
2448 Use @var{directory} as the location of the sysroot, overriding the
2449 configure-time default. This option is only supported by linkers
2450 that were configured using @option{--with-sysroot}.
2451
2452 @kindex --task-link
2453 @item --task-link
2454 This is used by COFF/PE based targets to create a task-linked object
2455 file where all of the global symbols have been converted to statics.
2456
2457 @kindex --traditional-format
2458 @cindex traditional format
2459 @item --traditional-format
2460 For some targets, the output of @command{ld} is different in some ways from
2461 the output of some existing linker. This switch requests @command{ld} to
2462 use the traditional format instead.
2463
2464 @cindex dbx
2465 For example, on SunOS, @command{ld} combines duplicate entries in the
2466 symbol string table. This can reduce the size of an output file with
2467 full debugging information by over 30 percent. Unfortunately, the SunOS
2468 @code{dbx} program can not read the resulting program (@code{gdb} has no
2469 trouble). The @samp{--traditional-format} switch tells @command{ld} to not
2470 combine duplicate entries.
2471
2472 @kindex --section-start=@var{sectionname}=@var{org}
2473 @item --section-start=@var{sectionname}=@var{org}
2474 Locate a section in the output file at the absolute
2475 address given by @var{org}. You may use this option as many
2476 times as necessary to locate multiple sections in the command
2477 line.
2478 @var{org} must be a single hexadecimal integer;
2479 for compatibility with other linkers, you may omit the leading
2480 @samp{0x} usually associated with hexadecimal values. @emph{Note:} there
2481 should be no white space between @var{sectionname}, the equals
2482 sign (``@key{=}''), and @var{org}.
2483
2484 @kindex -Tbss=@var{org}
2485 @kindex -Tdata=@var{org}
2486 @kindex -Ttext=@var{org}
2487 @cindex segment origins, cmd line
2488 @item -Tbss=@var{org}
2489 @itemx -Tdata=@var{org}
2490 @itemx -Ttext=@var{org}
2491 Same as @option{--section-start}, with @code{.bss}, @code{.data} or
2492 @code{.text} as the @var{sectionname}.
2493
2494 @kindex -Ttext-segment=@var{org}
2495 @item -Ttext-segment=@var{org}
2496 @cindex text segment origin, cmd line
2497 When creating an ELF executable, it will set the address of the first
2498 byte of the text segment.
2499
2500 @kindex -Trodata-segment=@var{org}
2501 @item -Trodata-segment=@var{org}
2502 @cindex rodata segment origin, cmd line
2503 When creating an ELF executable or shared object for a target where
2504 the read-only data is in its own segment separate from the executable
2505 text, it will set the address of the first byte of the read-only data segment.
2506
2507 @kindex -Tldata-segment=@var{org}
2508 @item -Tldata-segment=@var{org}
2509 @cindex ldata segment origin, cmd line
2510 When creating an ELF executable or shared object for x86-64 medium memory
2511 model, it will set the address of the first byte of the ldata segment.
2512
2513 @kindex --unresolved-symbols
2514 @item --unresolved-symbols=@var{method}
2515 Determine how to handle unresolved symbols. There are four possible
2516 values for @samp{method}:
2517
2518 @table @samp
2519 @item ignore-all
2520 Do not report any unresolved symbols.
2521
2522 @item report-all
2523 Report all unresolved symbols. This is the default.
2524
2525 @item ignore-in-object-files
2526 Report unresolved symbols that are contained in shared libraries, but
2527 ignore them if they come from regular object files.
2528
2529 @item ignore-in-shared-libs
2530 Report unresolved symbols that come from regular object files, but
2531 ignore them if they come from shared libraries. This can be useful
2532 when creating a dynamic binary and it is known that all the shared
2533 libraries that it should be referencing are included on the linker's
2534 command line.
2535 @end table
2536
2537 The behaviour for shared libraries on their own can also be controlled
2538 by the @option{--[no-]allow-shlib-undefined} option.
2539
2540 Normally the linker will generate an error message for each reported
2541 unresolved symbol but the option @option{--warn-unresolved-symbols}
2542 can change this to a warning.
2543
2544 @kindex --verbose[=@var{NUMBER}]
2545 @cindex verbose[=@var{NUMBER}]
2546 @item --dll-verbose
2547 @itemx --verbose[=@var{NUMBER}]
2548 Display the version number for @command{ld} and list the linker emulations
2549 supported. Display which input files can and cannot be opened. Display
2550 the linker script being used by the linker. If the optional @var{NUMBER}
2551 argument > 1, plugin symbol status will also be displayed.
2552
2553 @kindex --version-script=@var{version-scriptfile}
2554 @cindex version script, symbol versions
2555 @item --version-script=@var{version-scriptfile}
2556 Specify the name of a version script to the linker. This is typically
2557 used when creating shared libraries to specify additional information
2558 about the version hierarchy for the library being created. This option
2559 is only fully supported on ELF platforms which support shared libraries;
2560 see @ref{VERSION}. It is partially supported on PE platforms, which can
2561 use version scripts to filter symbol visibility in auto-export mode: any
2562 symbols marked @samp{local} in the version script will not be exported.
2563 @xref{WIN32}.
2564
2565 @kindex --warn-common
2566 @cindex warnings, on combining symbols
2567 @cindex combining symbols, warnings on
2568 @item --warn-common
2569 Warn when a common symbol is combined with another common symbol or with
2570 a symbol definition. Unix linkers allow this somewhat sloppy practice,
2571 but linkers on some other operating systems do not. This option allows
2572 you to find potential problems from combining global symbols.
2573 Unfortunately, some C libraries use this practice, so you may get some
2574 warnings about symbols in the libraries as well as in your programs.
2575
2576 There are three kinds of global symbols, illustrated here by C examples:
2577
2578 @table @samp
2579 @item int i = 1;
2580 A definition, which goes in the initialized data section of the output
2581 file.
2582
2583 @item extern int i;
2584 An undefined reference, which does not allocate space.
2585 There must be either a definition or a common symbol for the
2586 variable somewhere.
2587
2588 @item int i;
2589 A common symbol. If there are only (one or more) common symbols for a
2590 variable, it goes in the uninitialized data area of the output file.
2591 The linker merges multiple common symbols for the same variable into a
2592 single symbol. If they are of different sizes, it picks the largest
2593 size. The linker turns a common symbol into a declaration, if there is
2594 a definition of the same variable.
2595 @end table
2596
2597 The @samp{--warn-common} option can produce five kinds of warnings.
2598 Each warning consists of a pair of lines: the first describes the symbol
2599 just encountered, and the second describes the previous symbol
2600 encountered with the same name. One or both of the two symbols will be
2601 a common symbol.
2602
2603 @enumerate
2604 @item
2605 Turning a common symbol into a reference, because there is already a
2606 definition for the symbol.
2607 @smallexample
2608 @var{file}(@var{section}): warning: common of `@var{symbol}'
2609 overridden by definition
2610 @var{file}(@var{section}): warning: defined here
2611 @end smallexample
2612
2613 @item
2614 Turning a common symbol into a reference, because a later definition for
2615 the symbol is encountered. This is the same as the previous case,
2616 except that the symbols are encountered in a different order.
2617 @smallexample
2618 @var{file}(@var{section}): warning: definition of `@var{symbol}'
2619 overriding common
2620 @var{file}(@var{section}): warning: common is here
2621 @end smallexample
2622
2623 @item
2624 Merging a common symbol with a previous same-sized common symbol.
2625 @smallexample
2626 @var{file}(@var{section}): warning: multiple common
2627 of `@var{symbol}'
2628 @var{file}(@var{section}): warning: previous common is here
2629 @end smallexample
2630
2631 @item
2632 Merging a common symbol with a previous larger common symbol.
2633 @smallexample
2634 @var{file}(@var{section}): warning: common of `@var{symbol}'
2635 overridden by larger common
2636 @var{file}(@var{section}): warning: larger common is here
2637 @end smallexample
2638
2639 @item
2640 Merging a common symbol with a previous smaller common symbol. This is
2641 the same as the previous case, except that the symbols are
2642 encountered in a different order.
2643 @smallexample
2644 @var{file}(@var{section}): warning: common of `@var{symbol}'
2645 overriding smaller common
2646 @var{file}(@var{section}): warning: smaller common is here
2647 @end smallexample
2648 @end enumerate
2649
2650 @kindex --warn-constructors
2651 @item --warn-constructors
2652 Warn if any global constructors are used. This is only useful for a few
2653 object file formats. For formats like COFF or ELF, the linker can not
2654 detect the use of global constructors.
2655
2656 @kindex --warn-execstack
2657 @cindex warnings, on executable stack
2658 @cindex executable stack, warnings on
2659 @item --warn-execstack
2660 @itemx --no-warn-execstack
2661 On ELF platforms this option controls how the linker generates warning
2662 messages when it creates an output file with an executable stack. By
2663 default the linker will not warn if the @command{-z execstack} command
2664 line option has been used, but this behaviour can be overridden by the
2665 @option{--warn-execstack} option.
2666
2667 On the other hand the linker will normally warn if the stack is made
2668 executable because one or more of the input files need an execuable
2669 stack and neither of the @command{-z execstack} or @command{-z
2670 noexecstack} command line options have been specified. This warning
2671 can be disabled via the @command{--no-warn-execstack} option.
2672
2673 Note: ELF format input files specify that they need an executable
2674 stack by having a @var{.note.GNU-stack} section with the executable
2675 bit set in its section flags. They can specify that they do not need
2676 an executable stack by having that section, but without the executable
2677 flag bit set. If an input file does not have a @var{.note.GNU-stack}
2678 section present then the default behaviour is target specific. For
2679 some targets, then absence of such a section implies that an
2680 executable stack @emph{is} required. This is often a problem for hand
2681 crafted assembler files.
2682
2683 @kindex --warn-multiple-gp
2684 @item --warn-multiple-gp
2685 Warn if multiple global pointer values are required in the output file.
2686 This is only meaningful for certain processors, such as the Alpha.
2687 Specifically, some processors put large-valued constants in a special
2688 section. A special register (the global pointer) points into the middle
2689 of this section, so that constants can be loaded efficiently via a
2690 base-register relative addressing mode. Since the offset in
2691 base-register relative mode is fixed and relatively small (e.g., 16
2692 bits), this limits the maximum size of the constant pool. Thus, in
2693 large programs, it is often necessary to use multiple global pointer
2694 values in order to be able to address all possible constants. This
2695 option causes a warning to be issued whenever this case occurs.
2696
2697 @kindex --warn-once
2698 @cindex warnings, on undefined symbols
2699 @cindex undefined symbols, warnings on
2700 @item --warn-once
2701 Only warn once for each undefined symbol, rather than once per module
2702 which refers to it.
2703
2704 @kindex --warn-rwx-segments
2705 @cindex warnings, on writeable and exectuable segments
2706 @cindex executable segments, warnings on
2707 @item --warn-rwx-segments
2708 @itemx --no-warn-rwx-segments
2709 Warn if the linker creates a loadable, non-zero sized segment that has
2710 all three of the read, write and execute permission flags set. Such a
2711 segment represents a potential security vulnerability. In addition
2712 warnings will be generated if a thread local storage segment is
2713 created with the execute permission flag set, regardless of whether or
2714 not it has the read and/or write flags set.
2715
2716 These warnings are enabled by default. They can be disabled via the
2717 @option{--no-warn-rwx-segments} option and re-enabled via the
2718 @option{--warn-rwx-segments} option.
2719
2720 @kindex --warn-section-align
2721 @cindex warnings, on section alignment
2722 @cindex section alignment, warnings on
2723 @item --warn-section-align
2724 Warn if the address of an output section is changed because of
2725 alignment. Typically, the alignment will be set by an input section.
2726 The address will only be changed if it not explicitly specified; that
2727 is, if the @code{SECTIONS} command does not specify a start address for
2728 the section (@pxref{SECTIONS}).
2729
2730 @kindex --warn-textrel
2731 @item --warn-textrel
2732 Warn if the linker adds DT_TEXTREL to a position-independent executable
2733 or shared object.
2734
2735 @kindex --warn-alternate-em
2736 @item --warn-alternate-em
2737 Warn if an object has alternate ELF machine code.
2738
2739 @kindex --warn-unresolved-symbols
2740 @item --warn-unresolved-symbols
2741 If the linker is going to report an unresolved symbol (see the option
2742 @option{--unresolved-symbols}) it will normally generate an error.
2743 This option makes it generate a warning instead.
2744
2745 @kindex --error-unresolved-symbols
2746 @item --error-unresolved-symbols
2747 This restores the linker's default behaviour of generating errors when
2748 it is reporting unresolved symbols.
2749
2750 @kindex --whole-archive
2751 @cindex including an entire archive
2752 @item --whole-archive
2753 For each archive mentioned on the command line after the
2754 @option{--whole-archive} option, include every object file in the archive
2755 in the link, rather than searching the archive for the required object
2756 files. This is normally used to turn an archive file into a shared
2757 library, forcing every object to be included in the resulting shared
2758 library. This option may be used more than once.
2759
2760 Two notes when using this option from gcc: First, gcc doesn't know
2761 about this option, so you have to use @option{-Wl,-whole-archive}.
2762 Second, don't forget to use @option{-Wl,-no-whole-archive} after your
2763 list of archives, because gcc will add its own list of archives to
2764 your link and you may not want this flag to affect those as well.
2765
2766 @kindex --wrap=@var{symbol}
2767 @item --wrap=@var{symbol}
2768 Use a wrapper function for @var{symbol}. Any undefined reference to
2769 @var{symbol} will be resolved to @code{__wrap_@var{symbol}}. Any
2770 undefined reference to @code{__real_@var{symbol}} will be resolved to
2771 @var{symbol}.
2772
2773 This can be used to provide a wrapper for a system function. The
2774 wrapper function should be called @code{__wrap_@var{symbol}}. If it
2775 wishes to call the system function, it should call
2776 @code{__real_@var{symbol}}.
2777
2778 Here is a trivial example:
2779
2780 @smallexample
2781 void *
2782 __wrap_malloc (size_t c)
2783 @{
2784 printf ("malloc called with %zu\n", c);
2785 return __real_malloc (c);
2786 @}
2787 @end smallexample
2788
2789 If you link other code with this file using @option{--wrap malloc}, then
2790 all calls to @code{malloc} will call the function @code{__wrap_malloc}
2791 instead. The call to @code{__real_malloc} in @code{__wrap_malloc} will
2792 call the real @code{malloc} function.
2793
2794 You may wish to provide a @code{__real_malloc} function as well, so that
2795 links without the @option{--wrap} option will succeed. If you do this,
2796 you should not put the definition of @code{__real_malloc} in the same
2797 file as @code{__wrap_malloc}; if you do, the assembler may resolve the
2798 call before the linker has a chance to wrap it to @code{malloc}.
2799
2800 Only undefined references are replaced by the linker. So, translation unit
2801 internal references to @var{symbol} are not resolved to
2802 @code{__wrap_@var{symbol}}. In the next example, the call to @code{f} in
2803 @code{g} is not resolved to @code{__wrap_f}.
2804
2805 @smallexample
2806 int
2807 f (void)
2808 @{
2809 return 123;
2810 @}
2811
2812 int
2813 g (void)
2814 @{
2815 return f();
2816 @}
2817 @end smallexample
2818
2819 @kindex --eh-frame-hdr
2820 @kindex --no-eh-frame-hdr
2821 @item --eh-frame-hdr
2822 @itemx --no-eh-frame-hdr
2823 Request (@option{--eh-frame-hdr}) or suppress
2824 (@option{--no-eh-frame-hdr}) the creation of @code{.eh_frame_hdr}
2825 section and ELF @code{PT_GNU_EH_FRAME} segment header.
2826
2827 @kindex --ld-generated-unwind-info
2828 @item --no-ld-generated-unwind-info
2829 Request creation of @code{.eh_frame} unwind info for linker
2830 generated code sections like PLT. This option is on by default
2831 if linker generated unwind info is supported.
2832
2833 @kindex --enable-new-dtags
2834 @kindex --disable-new-dtags
2835 @item --enable-new-dtags
2836 @itemx --disable-new-dtags
2837 This linker can create the new dynamic tags in ELF. But the older ELF
2838 systems may not understand them. If you specify
2839 @option{--enable-new-dtags}, the new dynamic tags will be created as needed
2840 and older dynamic tags will be omitted.
2841 If you specify @option{--disable-new-dtags}, no new dynamic tags will be
2842 created. By default, the new dynamic tags are not created. Note that
2843 those options are only available for ELF systems.
2844
2845 @kindex --hash-size=@var{number}
2846 @item --hash-size=@var{number}
2847 Set the default size of the linker's hash tables to a prime number
2848 close to @var{number}. Increasing this value can reduce the length of
2849 time it takes the linker to perform its tasks, at the expense of
2850 increasing the linker's memory requirements. Similarly reducing this
2851 value can reduce the memory requirements at the expense of speed.
2852
2853 @kindex --hash-style=@var{style}
2854 @item --hash-style=@var{style}
2855 Set the type of linker's hash table(s). @var{style} can be either
2856 @code{sysv} for classic ELF @code{.hash} section, @code{gnu} for
2857 new style GNU @code{.gnu.hash} section or @code{both} for both
2858 the classic ELF @code{.hash} and new style GNU @code{.gnu.hash}
2859 hash tables. The default depends upon how the linker was configured,
2860 but for most Linux based systems it will be @code{both}.
2861
2862 @kindex --compress-debug-sections=none
2863 @kindex --compress-debug-sections=zlib
2864 @kindex --compress-debug-sections=zlib-gnu
2865 @kindex --compress-debug-sections=zlib-gabi
2866 @item --compress-debug-sections=none
2867 @itemx --compress-debug-sections=zlib
2868 @itemx --compress-debug-sections=zlib-gnu
2869 @itemx --compress-debug-sections=zlib-gabi
2870 On ELF platforms, these options control how DWARF debug sections are
2871 compressed using zlib.
2872
2873 @option{--compress-debug-sections=none} doesn't compress DWARF debug
2874 sections. @option{--compress-debug-sections=zlib-gnu} compresses
2875 DWARF debug sections and renames them to begin with @samp{.zdebug}
2876 instead of @samp{.debug}. @option{--compress-debug-sections=zlib-gabi}
2877 also compresses DWARF debug sections, but rather than renaming them it
2878 sets the SHF_COMPRESSED flag in the sections' headers.
2879
2880 The @option{--compress-debug-sections=zlib} option is an alias for
2881 @option{--compress-debug-sections=zlib-gabi}.
2882
2883 Note that this option overrides any compression in input debug
2884 sections, so if a binary is linked with @option{--compress-debug-sections=none}
2885 for example, then any compressed debug sections in input files will be
2886 uncompressed before they are copied into the output binary.
2887
2888 The default compression behaviour varies depending upon the target
2889 involved and the configure options used to build the toolchain. The
2890 default can be determined by examining the output from the linker's
2891 @option{--help} option.
2892
2893 @kindex --reduce-memory-overheads
2894 @item --reduce-memory-overheads
2895 This option reduces memory requirements at ld runtime, at the expense of
2896 linking speed. This was introduced to select the old O(n^2) algorithm
2897 for link map file generation, rather than the new O(n) algorithm which uses
2898 about 40% more memory for symbol storage.
2899
2900 Another effect of the switch is to set the default hash table size to
2901 1021, which again saves memory at the cost of lengthening the linker's
2902 run time. This is not done however if the @option{--hash-size} switch
2903 has been used.
2904
2905 The @option{--reduce-memory-overheads} switch may be also be used to
2906 enable other tradeoffs in future versions of the linker.
2907
2908 @kindex --max-cache-size=@var{size}
2909 @item --max-cache-size=@var{size}
2910 @command{ld} normally caches the relocation information and symbol tables
2911 of input files in memory with the unlimited size. This option sets the
2912 maximum cache size to @var{size}.
2913
2914 @kindex --build-id
2915 @kindex --build-id=@var{style}
2916 @item --build-id
2917 @itemx --build-id=@var{style}
2918 Request the creation of a @code{.note.gnu.build-id} ELF note section
2919 or a @code{.buildid} COFF section. The contents of the note are
2920 unique bits identifying this linked file. @var{style} can be
2921 @code{uuid} to use 128 random bits, @code{sha1} to use a 160-bit
2922 @sc{SHA1} hash on the normative parts of the output contents,
2923 @code{md5} to use a 128-bit @sc{MD5} hash on the normative parts of
2924 the output contents, or @code{0x@var{hexstring}} to use a chosen bit
2925 string specified as an even number of hexadecimal digits (@code{-} and
2926 @code{:} characters between digit pairs are ignored). If @var{style}
2927 is omitted, @code{sha1} is used.
2928
2929 The @code{md5} and @code{sha1} styles produces an identifier
2930 that is always the same in an identical output file, but will be
2931 unique among all nonidentical output files. It is not intended
2932 to be compared as a checksum for the file's contents. A linked
2933 file may be changed later by other tools, but the build ID bit
2934 string identifying the original linked file does not change.
2935
2936 Passing @code{none} for @var{style} disables the setting from any
2937 @code{--build-id} options earlier on the command line.
2938
2939 @kindex --package-metadata=@var{JSON}
2940 @item --package-metadata=@var{JSON}
2941 Request the creation of a @code{.note.package} ELF note section. The
2942 contents of the note are in JSON format, as per the package metadata
2943 specification. For more information see:
2944 https://systemd.io/ELF_PACKAGE_METADATA/
2945 If the JSON argument is missing/empty then this will disable the
2946 creation of the metadata note, if one had been enabled by an earlier
2947 occurrence of the --package-metdata option.
2948 If the linker has been built with libjansson, then the JSON string
2949 will be validated.
2950 @end table
2951
2952 @c man end
2953
2954 @subsection Options Specific to i386 PE Targets
2955
2956 @c man begin OPTIONS
2957
2958 The i386 PE linker supports the @option{-shared} option, which causes
2959 the output to be a dynamically linked library (DLL) instead of a
2960 normal executable. You should name the output @code{*.dll} when you
2961 use this option. In addition, the linker fully supports the standard
2962 @code{*.def} files, which may be specified on the linker command line
2963 like an object file (in fact, it should precede archives it exports
2964 symbols from, to ensure that they get linked in, just like a normal
2965 object file).
2966
2967 In addition to the options common to all targets, the i386 PE linker
2968 support additional command-line options that are specific to the i386
2969 PE target. Options that take values may be separated from their
2970 values by either a space or an equals sign.
2971
2972 @table @gcctabopt
2973
2974 @kindex --add-stdcall-alias
2975 @item --add-stdcall-alias
2976 If given, symbols with a stdcall suffix (@@@var{nn}) will be exported
2977 as-is and also with the suffix stripped.
2978 [This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
2979
2980 @kindex --base-file
2981 @item --base-file @var{file}
2982 Use @var{file} as the name of a file in which to save the base
2983 addresses of all the relocations needed for generating DLLs with
2984 @file{dlltool}.
2985 [This is an i386 PE specific option]
2986
2987 @kindex --dll
2988 @item --dll
2989 Create a DLL instead of a regular executable. You may also use
2990 @option{-shared} or specify a @code{LIBRARY} in a given @code{.def}
2991 file.
2992 [This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
2993
2994 @kindex --enable-long-section-names
2995 @kindex --disable-long-section-names
2996 @item --enable-long-section-names
2997 @itemx --disable-long-section-names
2998 The PE variants of the COFF object format add an extension that permits
2999 the use of section names longer than eight characters, the normal limit
3000 for COFF. By default, these names are only allowed in object files, as
3001 fully-linked executable images do not carry the COFF string table required
3002 to support the longer names. As a GNU extension, it is possible to
3003 allow their use in executable images as well, or to (probably pointlessly!)
3004 disallow it in object files, by using these two options. Executable images
3005 generated with these long section names are slightly non-standard, carrying
3006 as they do a string table, and may generate confusing output when examined
3007 with non-GNU PE-aware tools, such as file viewers and dumpers. However,
3008 GDB relies on the use of PE long section names to find Dwarf-2 debug
3009 information sections in an executable image at runtime, and so if neither
3010 option is specified on the command-line, @command{ld} will enable long
3011 section names, overriding the default and technically correct behaviour,
3012 when it finds the presence of debug information while linking an executable
3013 image and not stripping symbols.
3014 [This option is valid for all PE targeted ports of the linker]
3015
3016 @kindex --enable-stdcall-fixup
3017 @kindex --disable-stdcall-fixup
3018 @item --enable-stdcall-fixup
3019 @itemx --disable-stdcall-fixup
3020 If the link finds a symbol that it cannot resolve, it will attempt to
3021 do ``fuzzy linking'' by looking for another defined symbol that differs
3022 only in the format of the symbol name (cdecl vs stdcall) and will
3023 resolve that symbol by linking to the match. For example, the
3024 undefined symbol @code{_foo} might be linked to the function
3025 @code{_foo@@12}, or the undefined symbol @code{_bar@@16} might be linked
3026 to the function @code{_bar}. When the linker does this, it prints a
3027 warning, since it normally should have failed to link, but sometimes
3028 import libraries generated from third-party dlls may need this feature
3029 to be usable. If you specify @option{--enable-stdcall-fixup}, this
3030 feature is fully enabled and warnings are not printed. If you specify
3031 @option{--disable-stdcall-fixup}, this feature is disabled and such
3032 mismatches are considered to be errors.
3033 [This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
3034
3035 @kindex --leading-underscore
3036 @kindex --no-leading-underscore
3037 @item --leading-underscore
3038 @itemx --no-leading-underscore
3039 For most targets default symbol-prefix is an underscore and is defined
3040 in target's description. By this option it is possible to
3041 disable/enable the default underscore symbol-prefix.
3042
3043 @cindex DLLs, creating
3044 @kindex --export-all-symbols
3045 @item --export-all-symbols
3046 If given, all global symbols in the objects used to build a DLL will
3047 be exported by the DLL. Note that this is the default if there
3048 otherwise wouldn't be any exported symbols. When symbols are
3049 explicitly exported via DEF files or implicitly exported via function
3050 attributes, the default is to not export anything else unless this
3051 option is given. Note that the symbols @code{DllMain@@12},
3052 @code{DllEntryPoint@@0}, @code{DllMainCRTStartup@@12}, and
3053 @code{impure_ptr} will not be automatically
3054 exported. Also, symbols imported from other DLLs will not be
3055 re-exported, nor will symbols specifying the DLL's internal layout
3056 such as those beginning with @code{_head_} or ending with
3057 @code{_iname}. In addition, no symbols from @code{libgcc},
3058 @code{libstd++}, @code{libmingw32}, or @code{crtX.o} will be exported.
3059 Symbols whose names begin with @code{__rtti_} or @code{__builtin_} will
3060 not be exported, to help with C++ DLLs. Finally, there is an
3061 extensive list of cygwin-private symbols that are not exported
3062 (obviously, this applies on when building DLLs for cygwin targets).
3063 These cygwin-excludes are: @code{_cygwin_dll_entry@@12},
3064 @code{_cygwin_crt0_common@@8}, @code{_cygwin_noncygwin_dll_entry@@12},
3065 @code{_fmode}, @code{_impure_ptr}, @code{cygwin_attach_dll},
3066 @code{cygwin_premain0}, @code{cygwin_premain1}, @code{cygwin_premain2},
3067 @code{cygwin_premain3}, and @code{environ}.
3068 [This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
3069
3070 @kindex --exclude-symbols
3071 @item --exclude-symbols @var{symbol},@var{symbol},...
3072 Specifies a list of symbols which should not be automatically
3073 exported. The symbol names may be delimited by commas or colons.
3074 [This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
3075
3076 @kindex --exclude-all-symbols
3077 @item --exclude-all-symbols
3078 Specifies no symbols should be automatically exported.
3079 [This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
3080
3081 @kindex --file-alignment
3082 @item --file-alignment
3083 Specify the file alignment. Sections in the file will always begin at
3084 file offsets which are multiples of this number. This defaults to
3085 512.
3086 [This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
3087
3088 @cindex heap size
3089 @kindex --heap
3090 @item --heap @var{reserve}
3091 @itemx --heap @var{reserve},@var{commit}
3092 Specify the number of bytes of memory to reserve (and optionally commit)
3093 to be used as heap for this program. The default is 1MB reserved, 4K
3094 committed.
3095 [This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
3096
3097 @cindex image base
3098 @kindex --image-base
3099 @item --image-base @var{value}
3100 Use @var{value} as the base address of your program or dll. This is
3101 the lowest memory location that will be used when your program or dll
3102 is loaded. To reduce the need to relocate and improve performance of
3103 your dlls, each should have a unique base address and not overlap any
3104 other dlls. The default is 0x400000 for executables, and 0x10000000
3105 for dlls.
3106 [This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
3107
3108 @kindex --kill-at
3109 @item --kill-at
3110 If given, the stdcall suffixes (@@@var{nn}) will be stripped from
3111 symbols before they are exported.
3112 [This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
3113
3114 @kindex --large-address-aware
3115 @item --large-address-aware
3116 If given, the appropriate bit in the ``Characteristics'' field of the COFF
3117 header is set to indicate that this executable supports virtual addresses
3118 greater than 2 gigabytes. This should be used in conjunction with the /3GB
3119 or /USERVA=@var{value} megabytes switch in the ``[operating systems]''
3120 section of the BOOT.INI. Otherwise, this bit has no effect.
3121 [This option is specific to PE targeted ports of the linker]
3122
3123 @kindex --disable-large-address-aware
3124 @item --disable-large-address-aware
3125 Reverts the effect of a previous @samp{--large-address-aware} option.
3126 This is useful if @samp{--large-address-aware} is always set by the compiler
3127 driver (e.g. Cygwin gcc) and the executable does not support virtual
3128 addresses greater than 2 gigabytes.
3129 [This option is specific to PE targeted ports of the linker]
3130
3131 @kindex --major-image-version
3132 @item --major-image-version @var{value}
3133 Sets the major number of the ``image version''. Defaults to 1.
3134 [This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
3135
3136 @kindex --major-os-version
3137 @item --major-os-version @var{value}
3138 Sets the major number of the ``os version''. Defaults to 4.
3139 [This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
3140
3141 @kindex --major-subsystem-version
3142 @item --major-subsystem-version @var{value}
3143 Sets the major number of the ``subsystem version''. Defaults to 4.
3144 [This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
3145
3146 @kindex --minor-image-version
3147 @item --minor-image-version @var{value}
3148 Sets the minor number of the ``image version''. Defaults to 0.
3149 [This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
3150
3151 @kindex --minor-os-version
3152 @item --minor-os-version @var{value}
3153 Sets the minor number of the ``os version''. Defaults to 0.
3154 [This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
3155
3156 @kindex --minor-subsystem-version
3157 @item --minor-subsystem-version @var{value}
3158 Sets the minor number of the ``subsystem version''. Defaults to 0.
3159 [This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
3160
3161 @cindex DEF files, creating
3162 @cindex DLLs, creating
3163 @kindex --output-def
3164 @item --output-def @var{file}
3165 The linker will create the file @var{file} which will contain a DEF
3166 file corresponding to the DLL the linker is generating. This DEF file
3167 (which should be called @code{*.def}) may be used to create an import
3168 library with @code{dlltool} or may be used as a reference to
3169 automatically or implicitly exported symbols.
3170 [This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
3171
3172 @cindex DLLs, creating
3173 @kindex --enable-auto-image-base
3174 @item --enable-auto-image-base
3175 @itemx --enable-auto-image-base=@var{value}
3176 Automatically choose the image base for DLLs, optionally starting with base
3177 @var{value}, unless one is specified using the @code{--image-base} argument.
3178 By using a hash generated from the dllname to create unique image bases
3179 for each DLL, in-memory collisions and relocations which can delay program
3180 execution are avoided.
3181 [This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
3182
3183 @kindex --disable-auto-image-base
3184 @item --disable-auto-image-base
3185 Do not automatically generate a unique image base. If there is no
3186 user-specified image base (@code{--image-base}) then use the platform
3187 default.
3188 [This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
3189
3190 @cindex DLLs, linking to
3191 @kindex --dll-search-prefix
3192 @item --dll-search-prefix @var{string}
3193 When linking dynamically to a dll without an import library,
3194 search for @code{<string><basename>.dll} in preference to
3195 @code{lib<basename>.dll}. This behaviour allows easy distinction
3196 between DLLs built for the various "subplatforms": native, cygwin,
3197 uwin, pw, etc. For instance, cygwin DLLs typically use
3198 @code{--dll-search-prefix=cyg}.
3199 [This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
3200
3201 @kindex --enable-auto-import
3202 @item --enable-auto-import
3203 Do sophisticated linking of @code{_symbol} to @code{__imp__symbol} for
3204 DATA imports from DLLs, thus making it possible to bypass the dllimport
3205 mechanism on the user side and to reference unmangled symbol names.
3206 [This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
3207
3208 The following remarks pertain to the original implementation of the
3209 feature and are obsolete nowadays for Cygwin and MinGW targets.
3210
3211 Note: Use of the 'auto-import' extension will cause the text section
3212 of the image file to be made writable. This does not conform to the
3213 PE-COFF format specification published by Microsoft.
3214
3215 Note - use of the 'auto-import' extension will also cause read only
3216 data which would normally be placed into the .rdata section to be
3217 placed into the .data section instead. This is in order to work
3218 around a problem with consts that is described here:
3219 http://www.cygwin.com/ml/cygwin/2004-09/msg01101.html
3220
3221 Using 'auto-import' generally will 'just work' -- but sometimes you may
3222 see this message:
3223
3224 "variable '<var>' can't be auto-imported. Please read the
3225 documentation for ld's @code{--enable-auto-import} for details."
3226
3227 This message occurs when some (sub)expression accesses an address
3228 ultimately given by the sum of two constants (Win32 import tables only
3229 allow one). Instances where this may occur include accesses to member
3230 fields of struct variables imported from a DLL, as well as using a
3231 constant index into an array variable imported from a DLL. Any
3232 multiword variable (arrays, structs, long long, etc) may trigger
3233 this error condition. However, regardless of the exact data type
3234 of the offending exported variable, ld will always detect it, issue
3235 the warning, and exit.
3236
3237 There are several ways to address this difficulty, regardless of the
3238 data type of the exported variable:
3239
3240 One way is to use --enable-runtime-pseudo-reloc switch. This leaves the task
3241 of adjusting references in your client code for runtime environment, so
3242 this method works only when runtime environment supports this feature.
3243
3244 A second solution is to force one of the 'constants' to be a variable --
3245 that is, unknown and un-optimizable at compile time. For arrays,
3246 there are two possibilities: a) make the indexee (the array's address)
3247 a variable, or b) make the 'constant' index a variable. Thus:
3248
3249 @example
3250 extern type extern_array[];
3251 extern_array[1] -->
3252 @{ volatile type *t=extern_array; t[1] @}
3253 @end example
3254
3255 or
3256
3257 @example
3258 extern type extern_array[];
3259 extern_array[1] -->
3260 @{ volatile int t=1; extern_array[t] @}
3261 @end example
3262
3263 For structs (and most other multiword data types) the only option
3264 is to make the struct itself (or the long long, or the ...) variable:
3265
3266 @example
3267 extern struct s extern_struct;
3268 extern_struct.field -->
3269 @{ volatile struct s *t=&extern_struct; t->field @}
3270 @end example
3271
3272 or
3273
3274 @example
3275 extern long long extern_ll;
3276 extern_ll -->
3277 @{ volatile long long * local_ll=&extern_ll; *local_ll @}
3278 @end example
3279
3280 A third method of dealing with this difficulty is to abandon
3281 'auto-import' for the offending symbol and mark it with
3282 @code{__declspec(dllimport)}. However, in practice that
3283 requires using compile-time #defines to indicate whether you are
3284 building a DLL, building client code that will link to the DLL, or
3285 merely building/linking to a static library. In making the choice
3286 between the various methods of resolving the 'direct address with
3287 constant offset' problem, you should consider typical real-world usage:
3288
3289 Original:
3290 @example
3291 --foo.h
3292 extern int arr[];
3293 --foo.c
3294 #include "foo.h"
3295 void main(int argc, char **argv)@{
3296 printf("%d\n",arr[1]);
3297 @}
3298 @end example
3299
3300 Solution 1:
3301 @example
3302 --foo.h
3303 extern int arr[];
3304 --foo.c
3305 #include "foo.h"
3306 void main(int argc, char **argv)@{
3307 /* This workaround is for win32 and cygwin; do not "optimize" */
3308 volatile int *parr = arr;
3309 printf("%d\n",parr[1]);
3310 @}
3311 @end example
3312
3313 Solution 2:
3314 @example
3315 --foo.h
3316 /* Note: auto-export is assumed (no __declspec(dllexport)) */
3317 #if (defined(_WIN32) || defined(__CYGWIN__)) && \
3318 !(defined(FOO_BUILD_DLL) || defined(FOO_STATIC))
3319 #define FOO_IMPORT __declspec(dllimport)
3320 #else
3321 #define FOO_IMPORT
3322 #endif
3323 extern FOO_IMPORT int arr[];
3324 --foo.c
3325 #include "foo.h"
3326 void main(int argc, char **argv)@{
3327 printf("%d\n",arr[1]);
3328 @}
3329 @end example
3330
3331 A fourth way to avoid this problem is to re-code your
3332 library to use a functional interface rather than a data interface
3333 for the offending variables (e.g. set_foo() and get_foo() accessor
3334 functions).
3335
3336 @kindex --disable-auto-import
3337 @item --disable-auto-import
3338 Do not attempt to do sophisticated linking of @code{_symbol} to
3339 @code{__imp__symbol} for DATA imports from DLLs.
3340 [This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
3341
3342 @kindex --enable-runtime-pseudo-reloc
3343 @item --enable-runtime-pseudo-reloc
3344 If your code contains expressions described in --enable-auto-import section,
3345 that is, DATA imports from DLL with non-zero offset, this switch will create
3346 a vector of 'runtime pseudo relocations' which can be used by runtime
3347 environment to adjust references to such data in your client code.
3348 [This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
3349
3350 @kindex --disable-runtime-pseudo-reloc
3351 @item --disable-runtime-pseudo-reloc
3352 Do not create pseudo relocations for non-zero offset DATA imports from DLLs.
3353 [This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
3354
3355 @kindex --enable-extra-pe-debug
3356 @item --enable-extra-pe-debug
3357 Show additional debug info related to auto-import symbol thunking.
3358 [This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
3359
3360 @kindex --section-alignment
3361 @item --section-alignment
3362 Sets the section alignment. Sections in memory will always begin at
3363 addresses which are a multiple of this number. Defaults to 0x1000.
3364 [This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
3365
3366 @cindex stack size
3367 @kindex --stack
3368 @item --stack @var{reserve}
3369 @itemx --stack @var{reserve},@var{commit}
3370 Specify the number of bytes of memory to reserve (and optionally commit)
3371 to be used as stack for this program. The default is 2MB reserved, 4K
3372 committed.
3373 [This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
3374
3375 @kindex --subsystem
3376 @item --subsystem @var{which}
3377 @itemx --subsystem @var{which}:@var{major}
3378 @itemx --subsystem @var{which}:@var{major}.@var{minor}
3379 Specifies the subsystem under which your program will execute. The
3380 legal values for @var{which} are @code{native}, @code{windows},
3381 @code{console}, @code{posix}, and @code{xbox}. You may optionally set
3382 the subsystem version also. Numeric values are also accepted for
3383 @var{which}.
3384 [This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
3385
3386 The following options set flags in the @code{DllCharacteristics} field
3387 of the PE file header:
3388 [These options are specific to PE targeted ports of the linker]
3389
3390 @kindex --high-entropy-va
3391 @item --high-entropy-va
3392 @itemx --disable-high-entropy-va
3393 Image is compatible with 64-bit address space layout randomization
3394 (ASLR). This option is enabled by default for 64-bit PE images.
3395
3396 This option also implies @option{--dynamicbase} and
3397 @option{--enable-reloc-section}.
3398
3399 @kindex --dynamicbase
3400 @item --dynamicbase
3401 @itemx --disable-dynamicbase
3402 The image base address may be relocated using address space layout
3403 randomization (ASLR). This feature was introduced with MS Windows
3404 Vista for i386 PE targets. This option is enabled by default but
3405 can be disabled via the @option{--disable-dynamicbase} option.
3406 This option also implies @option{--enable-reloc-section}.
3407
3408 @kindex --forceinteg
3409 @item --forceinteg
3410 @itemx --disable-forceinteg
3411 Code integrity checks are enforced. This option is disabled by
3412 default.
3413
3414 @kindex --nxcompat
3415 @item --nxcompat
3416 @item --disable-nxcompat
3417 The image is compatible with the Data Execution Prevention.
3418 This feature was introduced with MS Windows XP SP2 for i386 PE
3419 targets. The option is enabled by default.
3420
3421 @kindex --no-isolation
3422 @item --no-isolation
3423 @itemx --disable-no-isolation
3424 Although the image understands isolation, do not isolate the image.
3425 This option is disabled by default.
3426
3427 @kindex --no-seh
3428 @item --no-seh
3429 @itemx --disable-no-seh
3430 The image does not use SEH. No SE handler may be called from
3431 this image. This option is disabled by default.
3432
3433 @kindex --no-bind
3434 @item --no-bind
3435 @itemx --disable-no-bind
3436 Do not bind this image. This option is disabled by default.
3437
3438 @kindex --wdmdriver
3439 @item --wdmdriver
3440 @itemx --disable-wdmdriver
3441 The driver uses the MS Windows Driver Model. This option is disabled
3442 by default.
3443
3444 @kindex --tsaware
3445 @item --tsaware
3446 @itemx --disable-tsaware
3447 The image is Terminal Server aware. This option is disabled by
3448 default.
3449
3450 @kindex --insert-timestamp
3451 @item --insert-timestamp
3452 @itemx --no-insert-timestamp
3453 Insert a real timestamp into the image. This is the default behaviour
3454 as it matches legacy code and it means that the image will work with
3455 other, proprietary tools. The problem with this default is that it
3456 will result in slightly different images being produced each time the
3457 same sources are linked. The option @option{--no-insert-timestamp}
3458 can be used to insert a zero value for the timestamp, this ensuring
3459 that binaries produced from identical sources will compare
3460 identically.
3461
3462 @kindex --enable-reloc-section
3463 @item --enable-reloc-section
3464 @itemx --disable-reloc-section
3465 Create the base relocation table, which is necessary if the image
3466 is loaded at a different image base than specified in the PE header.
3467 This option is enabled by default.
3468 @end table
3469
3470 @c man end
3471
3472 @ifset C6X
3473 @subsection Options specific to C6X uClinux targets
3474
3475 @c man begin OPTIONS
3476
3477 The C6X uClinux target uses a binary format called DSBT to support shared
3478 libraries. Each shared library in the system needs to have a unique index;
3479 all executables use an index of 0.
3480
3481 @table @gcctabopt
3482
3483 @kindex --dsbt-size
3484 @item --dsbt-size @var{size}
3485 This option sets the number of entries in the DSBT of the current executable
3486 or shared library to @var{size}. The default is to create a table with 64
3487 entries.
3488
3489 @kindex --dsbt-index
3490 @item --dsbt-index @var{index}
3491 This option sets the DSBT index of the current executable or shared library
3492 to @var{index}. The default is 0, which is appropriate for generating
3493 executables. If a shared library is generated with a DSBT index of 0, the
3494 @code{R_C6000_DSBT_INDEX} relocs are copied into the output file.
3495
3496 @kindex --no-merge-exidx-entries
3497 The @samp{--no-merge-exidx-entries} switch disables the merging of adjacent
3498 exidx entries in frame unwind info.
3499
3500 @end table
3501
3502 @c man end
3503 @end ifset
3504
3505 @ifset CSKY
3506 @subsection Options specific to C-SKY targets
3507
3508 @c man begin OPTIONS
3509
3510 @table @gcctabopt
3511
3512 @kindex --branch-stub on C-SKY
3513 @item --branch-stub
3514 This option enables linker branch relaxation by inserting branch stub
3515 sections when needed to extend the range of branches. This option is
3516 usually not required since C-SKY supports branch and call instructions that
3517 can access the full memory range and branch relaxation is normally handled by
3518 the compiler or assembler.
3519
3520 @kindex --stub-group-size on C-SKY
3521 @item --stub-group-size=@var{N}
3522 This option allows finer control of linker branch stub creation.
3523 It sets the maximum size of a group of input sections that can
3524 be handled by one stub section. A negative value of @var{N} locates
3525 stub sections after their branches, while a positive value allows stub
3526 sections to appear either before or after the branches. Values of
3527 @samp{1} or @samp{-1} indicate that the
3528 linker should choose suitable defaults.
3529
3530 @end table
3531
3532 @c man end
3533 @end ifset
3534
3535 @ifset M68HC11
3536 @subsection Options specific to Motorola 68HC11 and 68HC12 targets
3537
3538 @c man begin OPTIONS
3539
3540 The 68HC11 and 68HC12 linkers support specific options to control the
3541 memory bank switching mapping and trampoline code generation.
3542
3543 @table @gcctabopt
3544
3545 @kindex --no-trampoline
3546 @item --no-trampoline
3547 This option disables the generation of trampoline. By default a trampoline
3548 is generated for each far function which is called using a @code{jsr}
3549 instruction (this happens when a pointer to a far function is taken).
3550
3551 @kindex --bank-window
3552 @item --bank-window @var{name}
3553 This option indicates to the linker the name of the memory region in
3554 the @samp{MEMORY} specification that describes the memory bank window.
3555 The definition of such region is then used by the linker to compute
3556 paging and addresses within the memory window.
3557
3558 @end table
3559
3560 @c man end
3561 @end ifset
3562
3563 @ifset M68K
3564 @subsection Options specific to Motorola 68K target
3565
3566 @c man begin OPTIONS
3567
3568 The following options are supported to control handling of GOT generation
3569 when linking for 68K targets.
3570
3571 @table @gcctabopt
3572
3573 @kindex --got
3574 @item --got=@var{type}
3575 This option tells the linker which GOT generation scheme to use.
3576 @var{type} should be one of @samp{single}, @samp{negative},
3577 @samp{multigot} or @samp{target}. For more information refer to the
3578 Info entry for @file{ld}.
3579
3580 @end table
3581
3582 @c man end
3583 @end ifset
3584
3585 @ifset MIPS
3586 @subsection Options specific to MIPS targets
3587
3588 @c man begin OPTIONS
3589
3590 The following options are supported to control microMIPS instruction
3591 generation and branch relocation checks for ISA mode transitions when
3592 linking for MIPS targets.
3593
3594 @table @gcctabopt
3595
3596 @kindex --insn32
3597 @item --insn32
3598 @kindex --no-insn32
3599 @itemx --no-insn32
3600 These options control the choice of microMIPS instructions used in code
3601 generated by the linker, such as that in the PLT or lazy binding stubs,
3602 or in relaxation. If @samp{--insn32} is used, then the linker only uses
3603 32-bit instruction encodings. By default or if @samp{--no-insn32} is
3604 used, all instruction encodings are used, including 16-bit ones where
3605 possible.
3606
3607 @kindex --ignore-branch-isa
3608 @item --ignore-branch-isa
3609 @kindex --no-ignore-branch-isa
3610 @itemx --no-ignore-branch-isa
3611 These options control branch relocation checks for invalid ISA mode
3612 transitions. If @samp{--ignore-branch-isa} is used, then the linker
3613 accepts any branch relocations and any ISA mode transition required
3614 is lost in relocation calculation, except for some cases of @code{BAL}
3615 instructions which meet relaxation conditions and are converted to
3616 equivalent @code{JALX} instructions as the associated relocation is
3617 calculated. By default or if @samp{--no-ignore-branch-isa} is used
3618 a check is made causing the loss of an ISA mode transition to produce
3619 an error.
3620
3621 @kindex --compact-branches
3622 @item --compact-branches
3623 @kindex --no-compact-branches
3624 @itemx --no-compact-branches
3625 These options control the generation of compact instructions by the linker
3626 in the PLT entries for MIPS R6.
3627
3628 @end table
3629
3630 @c man end
3631 @end ifset
3632
3633
3634 @ifset PDP11
3635 @subsection Options specific to PDP11 targets
3636
3637 @c man begin OPTIONS
3638
3639 For the pdp11-aout target, three variants of the output format can be
3640 produced as selected by the following options. The default variant
3641 for pdp11-aout is the @samp{--omagic} option, whereas for other
3642 targets @samp{--nmagic} is the default. The @samp{--imagic} option is
3643 defined only for the pdp11-aout target, while the others are described
3644 here as they apply to the pdp11-aout target.
3645
3646 @table @gcctabopt
3647
3648 @kindex -N
3649 @item -N
3650 @kindex --omagic
3651 @itemx --omagic
3652
3653 Mark the output as @code{OMAGIC} (0407) in the @file{a.out} header to
3654 indicate that the text segment is not to be write-protected and
3655 shared. Since the text and data sections are both readable and
3656 writable, the data section is allocated immediately contiguous after
3657 the text segment. This is the oldest format for PDP11 executable
3658 programs and is the default for @command{ld} on PDP11 Unix systems
3659 from the beginning through 2.11BSD.
3660
3661 @kindex -n
3662 @item -n
3663 @kindex --nmagic
3664 @itemx --nmagic
3665
3666 Mark the output as @code{NMAGIC} (0410) in the @file{a.out} header to
3667 indicate that when the output file is executed, the text portion will
3668 be read-only and shareable among all processes executing the same
3669 file. This involves moving the data areas up to the first possible 8K
3670 byte page boundary following the end of the text. This option creates
3671 a @emph{pure executable} format.
3672
3673 @kindex -z
3674 @item -z
3675 @kindex --imagic
3676 @itemx --imagic
3677
3678 Mark the output as @code{IMAGIC} (0411) in the @file{a.out} header to
3679 indicate that when the output file is executed, the program text and
3680 data areas will be loaded into separate address spaces using the split
3681 instruction and data space feature of the memory management unit in
3682 larger models of the PDP11. This doubles the address space available
3683 to the program. The text segment is again pure, write-protected, and
3684 shareable. The only difference in the output format between this
3685 option and the others, besides the magic number, is that both the text
3686 and data sections start at location 0. The @samp{-z} option selected
3687 this format in 2.11BSD. This option creates a @emph{separate
3688 executable} format.
3689
3690 @kindex --no-omagic
3691 @item --no-omagic
3692
3693 Equivalent to @samp{--nmagic} for pdp11-aout.
3694
3695 @end table
3696
3697 @c man end
3698 @end ifset
3699
3700 @ifset UsesEnvVars
3701 @node Environment
3702 @section Environment Variables
3703
3704 @c man begin ENVIRONMENT
3705
3706 You can change the behaviour of @command{ld} with the environment variables
3707 @ifclear SingleFormat
3708 @code{GNUTARGET},
3709 @end ifclear
3710 @code{LDEMULATION} and @code{COLLECT_NO_DEMANGLE}.
3711
3712 @ifclear SingleFormat
3713 @kindex GNUTARGET
3714 @cindex default input format
3715 @code{GNUTARGET} determines the input-file object format if you don't
3716 use @samp{-b} (or its synonym @samp{--format}). Its value should be one
3717 of the BFD names for an input format (@pxref{BFD}). If there is no
3718 @code{GNUTARGET} in the environment, @command{ld} uses the natural format
3719 of the target. If @code{GNUTARGET} is set to @code{default} then BFD
3720 attempts to discover the input format by examining binary input files;
3721 this method often succeeds, but there are potential ambiguities, since
3722 there is no method of ensuring that the magic number used to specify
3723 object-file formats is unique. However, the configuration procedure for
3724 BFD on each system places the conventional format for that system first
3725 in the search-list, so ambiguities are resolved in favor of convention.
3726 @end ifclear
3727
3728 @kindex LDEMULATION
3729 @cindex default emulation
3730 @cindex emulation, default
3731 @code{LDEMULATION} determines the default emulation if you don't use the
3732 @samp{-m} option. The emulation can affect various aspects of linker
3733 behaviour, particularly the default linker script. You can list the
3734 available emulations with the @samp{--verbose} or @samp{-V} options. If
3735 the @samp{-m} option is not used, and the @code{LDEMULATION} environment
3736 variable is not defined, the default emulation depends upon how the
3737 linker was configured.
3738
3739 @kindex COLLECT_NO_DEMANGLE
3740 @cindex demangling, default
3741 Normally, the linker will default to demangling symbols. However, if
3742 @code{COLLECT_NO_DEMANGLE} is set in the environment, then it will
3743 default to not demangling symbols. This environment variable is used in
3744 a similar fashion by the @code{gcc} linker wrapper program. The default
3745 may be overridden by the @samp{--demangle} and @samp{--no-demangle}
3746 options.
3747
3748 @c man end
3749 @end ifset
3750
3751 @node Scripts
3752 @chapter Linker Scripts
3753
3754 @cindex scripts
3755 @cindex linker scripts
3756 @cindex command files
3757 Every link is controlled by a @dfn{linker script}. This script is
3758 written in the linker command language.
3759
3760 The main purpose of the linker script is to describe how the sections in
3761 the input files should be mapped into the output file, and to control
3762 the memory layout of the output file. Most linker scripts do nothing
3763 more than this. However, when necessary, the linker script can also
3764 direct the linker to perform many other operations, using the commands
3765 described below.
3766
3767 The linker always uses a linker script. If you do not supply one
3768 yourself, the linker will use a default script that is compiled into the
3769 linker executable. You can use the @samp{--verbose} command-line option
3770 to display the default linker script. Certain command-line options,
3771 such as @samp{-r} or @samp{-N}, will affect the default linker script.
3772
3773 You may supply your own linker script by using the @samp{-T} command
3774 line option. When you do this, your linker script will replace the
3775 default linker script.
3776
3777 You may also use linker scripts implicitly by naming them as input files
3778 to the linker, as though they were files to be linked. @xref{Implicit
3779 Linker Scripts}.
3780
3781 @menu
3782 * Basic Script Concepts:: Basic Linker Script Concepts
3783 * Script Format:: Linker Script Format
3784 * Simple Example:: Simple Linker Script Example
3785 * Simple Commands:: Simple Linker Script Commands
3786 * Assignments:: Assigning Values to Symbols
3787 * SECTIONS:: SECTIONS Command
3788 * MEMORY:: MEMORY Command
3789 * PHDRS:: PHDRS Command
3790 * VERSION:: VERSION Command
3791 * Expressions:: Expressions in Linker Scripts
3792 * Implicit Linker Scripts:: Implicit Linker Scripts
3793 @end menu
3794
3795 @node Basic Script Concepts
3796 @section Basic Linker Script Concepts
3797 @cindex linker script concepts
3798 We need to define some basic concepts and vocabulary in order to
3799 describe the linker script language.
3800
3801 The linker combines input files into a single output file. The output
3802 file and each input file are in a special data format known as an
3803 @dfn{object file format}. Each file is called an @dfn{object file}.
3804 The output file is often called an @dfn{executable}, but for our
3805 purposes we will also call it an object file. Each object file has,
3806 among other things, a list of @dfn{sections}. We sometimes refer to a
3807 section in an input file as an @dfn{input section}; similarly, a section
3808 in the output file is an @dfn{output section}.
3809
3810 Each section in an object file has a name and a size. Most sections
3811 also have an associated block of data, known as the @dfn{section
3812 contents}. A section may be marked as @dfn{loadable}, which means that
3813 the contents should be loaded into memory when the output file is run.
3814 A section with no contents may be @dfn{allocatable}, which means that an
3815 area in memory should be set aside, but nothing in particular should be
3816 loaded there (in some cases this memory must be zeroed out). A section
3817 which is neither loadable nor allocatable typically contains some sort
3818 of debugging information.
3819
3820 Every loadable or allocatable output section has two addresses. The
3821 first is the @dfn{VMA}, or virtual memory address. This is the address
3822 the section will have when the output file is run. The second is the
3823 @dfn{LMA}, or load memory address. This is the address at which the
3824 section will be loaded. In most cases the two addresses will be the
3825 same. An example of when they might be different is when a data section
3826 is loaded into ROM, and then copied into RAM when the program starts up
3827 (this technique is often used to initialize global variables in a ROM
3828 based system). In this case the ROM address would be the LMA, and the
3829 RAM address would be the VMA.
3830
3831 You can see the sections in an object file by using the @code{objdump}
3832 program with the @samp{-h} option.
3833
3834 Every object file also has a list of @dfn{symbols}, known as the
3835 @dfn{symbol table}. A symbol may be defined or undefined. Each symbol
3836 has a name, and each defined symbol has an address, among other
3837 information. If you compile a C or C++ program into an object file, you
3838 will get a defined symbol for every defined function and global or
3839 static variable. Every undefined function or global variable which is
3840 referenced in the input file will become an undefined symbol.
3841
3842 You can see the symbols in an object file by using the @code{nm}
3843 program, or by using the @code{objdump} program with the @samp{-t}
3844 option.
3845
3846 @node Script Format
3847 @section Linker Script Format
3848 @cindex linker script format
3849 Linker scripts are text files.
3850
3851 You write a linker script as a series of commands. Each command is
3852 either a keyword, possibly followed by arguments, or an assignment to a
3853 symbol. You may separate commands using semicolons. Whitespace is
3854 generally ignored.
3855
3856 Strings such as file or format names can normally be entered directly.
3857 If the file name contains a character such as a comma which would
3858 otherwise serve to separate file names, you may put the file name in
3859 double quotes. There is no way to use a double quote character in a
3860 file name.
3861
3862 You may include comments in linker scripts just as in C, delimited by
3863 @samp{/*} and @samp{*/}. As in C, comments are syntactically equivalent
3864 to whitespace.
3865
3866 @node Simple Example
3867 @section Simple Linker Script Example
3868 @cindex linker script example
3869 @cindex example of linker script
3870 Many linker scripts are fairly simple.
3871
3872 The simplest possible linker script has just one command:
3873 @samp{SECTIONS}. You use the @samp{SECTIONS} command to describe the
3874 memory layout of the output file.
3875
3876 The @samp{SECTIONS} command is a powerful command. Here we will
3877 describe a simple use of it. Let's assume your program consists only of
3878 code, initialized data, and uninitialized data. These will be in the
3879 @samp{.text}, @samp{.data}, and @samp{.bss} sections, respectively.
3880 Let's assume further that these are the only sections which appear in
3881 your input files.
3882
3883 For this example, let's say that the code should be loaded at address
3884 0x10000, and that the data should start at address 0x8000000. Here is a
3885 linker script which will do that:
3886 @smallexample
3887 SECTIONS
3888 @{
3889 . = 0x10000;
3890 .text : @{ *(.text) @}
3891 . = 0x8000000;
3892 .data : @{ *(.data) @}
3893 .bss : @{ *(.bss) @}
3894 @}
3895 @end smallexample
3896
3897 You write the @samp{SECTIONS} command as the keyword @samp{SECTIONS},
3898 followed by a series of symbol assignments and output section
3899 descriptions enclosed in curly braces.
3900
3901 The first line inside the @samp{SECTIONS} command of the above example
3902 sets the value of the special symbol @samp{.}, which is the location
3903 counter. If you do not specify the address of an output section in some
3904 other way (other ways are described later), the address is set from the
3905 current value of the location counter. The location counter is then
3906 incremented by the size of the output section. At the start of the
3907 @samp{SECTIONS} command, the location counter has the value @samp{0}.
3908
3909 The second line defines an output section, @samp{.text}. The colon is
3910 required syntax which may be ignored for now. Within the curly braces
3911 after the output section name, you list the names of the input sections
3912 which should be placed into this output section. The @samp{*} is a
3913 wildcard which matches any file name. The expression @samp{*(.text)}
3914 means all @samp{.text} input sections in all input files.
3915
3916 Since the location counter is @samp{0x10000} when the output section
3917 @samp{.text} is defined, the linker will set the address of the
3918 @samp{.text} section in the output file to be @samp{0x10000}.
3919
3920 The remaining lines define the @samp{.data} and @samp{.bss} sections in
3921 the output file. The linker will place the @samp{.data} output section
3922 at address @samp{0x8000000}. After the linker places the @samp{.data}
3923 output section, the value of the location counter will be
3924 @samp{0x8000000} plus the size of the @samp{.data} output section. The
3925 effect is that the linker will place the @samp{.bss} output section
3926 immediately after the @samp{.data} output section in memory.
3927
3928 The linker will ensure that each output section has the required
3929 alignment, by increasing the location counter if necessary. In this
3930 example, the specified addresses for the @samp{.text} and @samp{.data}
3931 sections will probably satisfy any alignment constraints, but the linker
3932 may have to create a small gap between the @samp{.data} and @samp{.bss}
3933 sections.
3934
3935 That's it! That's a simple and complete linker script.
3936
3937 @node Simple Commands
3938 @section Simple Linker Script Commands
3939 @cindex linker script simple commands
3940 In this section we describe the simple linker script commands.
3941
3942 @menu
3943 * Entry Point:: Setting the entry point
3944 * File Commands:: Commands dealing with files
3945 @ifclear SingleFormat
3946 * Format Commands:: Commands dealing with object file formats
3947 @end ifclear
3948
3949 * REGION_ALIAS:: Assign alias names to memory regions
3950 * Miscellaneous Commands:: Other linker script commands
3951 @end menu
3952
3953 @node Entry Point
3954 @subsection Setting the Entry Point
3955 @kindex ENTRY(@var{symbol})
3956 @cindex start of execution
3957 @cindex first instruction
3958 @cindex entry point
3959 The first instruction to execute in a program is called the @dfn{entry
3960 point}. You can use the @code{ENTRY} linker script command to set the
3961 entry point. The argument is a symbol name:
3962 @smallexample
3963 ENTRY(@var{symbol})
3964 @end smallexample
3965
3966 There are several ways to set the entry point. The linker will set the
3967 entry point by trying each of the following methods in order, and
3968 stopping when one of them succeeds:
3969 @itemize @bullet
3970 @item
3971 the @samp{-e} @var{entry} command-line option;
3972 @item
3973 the @code{ENTRY(@var{symbol})} command in a linker script;
3974 @item
3975 the value of a target-specific symbol, if it is defined; For many
3976 targets this is @code{start}, but PE- and BeOS-based systems for example
3977 check a list of possible entry symbols, matching the first one found.
3978 @item
3979 the address of the first byte of the code section, if present and an
3980 executable is being created - the code section is usually
3981 @samp{.text}, but can be something else;
3982 @item
3983 The address @code{0}.
3984 @end itemize
3985
3986 @node File Commands
3987 @subsection Commands Dealing with Files
3988 @cindex linker script file commands
3989 Several linker script commands deal with files.
3990
3991 @table @code
3992 @item INCLUDE @var{filename}
3993 @kindex INCLUDE @var{filename}
3994 @cindex including a linker script
3995 Include the linker script @var{filename} at this point. The file will
3996 be searched for in the current directory, and in any directory specified
3997 with the @option{-L} option. You can nest calls to @code{INCLUDE} up to
3998 10 levels deep.
3999
4000 You can place @code{INCLUDE} directives at the top level, in @code{MEMORY} or
4001 @code{SECTIONS} commands, or in output section descriptions.
4002
4003 @item INPUT(@var{file}, @var{file}, @dots{})
4004 @itemx INPUT(@var{file} @var{file} @dots{})
4005 @kindex INPUT(@var{files})
4006 @cindex input files in linker scripts
4007 @cindex input object files in linker scripts
4008 @cindex linker script input object files
4009 The @code{INPUT} command directs the linker to include the named files
4010 in the link, as though they were named on the command line.
4011
4012 For example, if you always want to include @file{subr.o} any time you do
4013 a link, but you can't be bothered to put it on every link command line,
4014 then you can put @samp{INPUT (subr.o)} in your linker script.
4015
4016 In fact, if you like, you can list all of your input files in the linker
4017 script, and then invoke the linker with nothing but a @samp{-T} option.
4018
4019 In case a @dfn{sysroot prefix} is configured, and the filename starts
4020 with the @samp{/} character, and the script being processed was
4021 located inside the @dfn{sysroot prefix}, the filename will be looked
4022 for in the @dfn{sysroot prefix}. The @dfn{sysroot prefix} can also be forced by specifying
4023 @code{=} as the first character in the filename path, or prefixing the
4024 filename path with @code{$SYSROOT}. See also the description of
4025 @samp{-L} in @ref{Options,,Command-line Options}.
4026
4027 If a @dfn{sysroot prefix} is not used then the linker will try to open
4028 the file in the directory containing the linker script. If it is not
4029 found the linker will then search the current directory. If it is still
4030 not found the linker will search through the archive library search
4031 path.
4032
4033 If you use @samp{INPUT (-l@var{file})}, @command{ld} will transform the
4034 name to @code{lib@var{file}.a}, as with the command-line argument
4035 @samp{-l}.
4036
4037 When you use the @code{INPUT} command in an implicit linker script, the
4038 files will be included in the link at the point at which the linker
4039 script file is included. This can affect archive searching.
4040
4041 @item GROUP(@var{file}, @var{file}, @dots{})
4042 @itemx GROUP(@var{file} @var{file} @dots{})
4043 @kindex GROUP(@var{files})
4044 @cindex grouping input files
4045 The @code{GROUP} command is like @code{INPUT}, except that the named
4046 files should all be archives, and they are searched repeatedly until no
4047 new undefined references are created. See the description of @samp{-(}
4048 in @ref{Options,,Command-line Options}.
4049
4050 @item AS_NEEDED(@var{file}, @var{file}, @dots{})
4051 @itemx AS_NEEDED(@var{file} @var{file} @dots{})
4052 @kindex AS_NEEDED(@var{files})
4053 This construct can appear only inside of the @code{INPUT} or @code{GROUP}
4054 commands, among other filenames. The files listed will be handled
4055 as if they appear directly in the @code{INPUT} or @code{GROUP} commands,
4056 with the exception of ELF shared libraries, that will be added only
4057 when they are actually needed. This construct essentially enables
4058 @option{--as-needed} option for all the files listed inside of it
4059 and restores previous @option{--as-needed} resp. @option{--no-as-needed}
4060 setting afterwards.
4061
4062 @item OUTPUT(@var{filename})
4063 @kindex OUTPUT(@var{filename})
4064 @cindex output file name in linker script
4065 The @code{OUTPUT} command names the output file. Using
4066 @code{OUTPUT(@var{filename})} in the linker script is exactly like using
4067 @samp{-o @var{filename}} on the command line (@pxref{Options,,Command
4068 Line Options}). If both are used, the command-line option takes
4069 precedence.
4070
4071 You can use the @code{OUTPUT} command to define a default name for the
4072 output file other than the usual default of @file{a.out}.
4073
4074 @item SEARCH_DIR(@var{path})
4075 @kindex SEARCH_DIR(@var{path})
4076 @cindex library search path in linker script
4077 @cindex archive search path in linker script
4078 @cindex search path in linker script
4079 The @code{SEARCH_DIR} command adds @var{path} to the list of paths where
4080 @command{ld} looks for archive libraries. Using
4081 @code{SEARCH_DIR(@var{path})} is exactly like using @samp{-L @var{path}}
4082 on the command line (@pxref{Options,,Command-line Options}). If both
4083 are used, then the linker will search both paths. Paths specified using
4084 the command-line option are searched first.
4085
4086 @item STARTUP(@var{filename})
4087 @kindex STARTUP(@var{filename})
4088 @cindex first input file
4089 The @code{STARTUP} command is just like the @code{INPUT} command, except
4090 that @var{filename} will become the first input file to be linked, as
4091 though it were specified first on the command line. This may be useful
4092 when using a system in which the entry point is always the start of the
4093 first file.
4094 @end table
4095
4096 @ifclear SingleFormat
4097 @node Format Commands
4098 @subsection Commands Dealing with Object File Formats
4099 A couple of linker script commands deal with object file formats.
4100
4101 @table @code
4102 @item OUTPUT_FORMAT(@var{bfdname})
4103 @itemx OUTPUT_FORMAT(@var{default}, @var{big}, @var{little})
4104 @kindex OUTPUT_FORMAT(@var{bfdname})
4105 @cindex output file format in linker script
4106 The @code{OUTPUT_FORMAT} command names the BFD format to use for the
4107 output file (@pxref{BFD}). Using @code{OUTPUT_FORMAT(@var{bfdname})} is
4108 exactly like using @samp{--oformat @var{bfdname}} on the command line
4109 (@pxref{Options,,Command-line Options}). If both are used, the command
4110 line option takes precedence.
4111
4112 You can use @code{OUTPUT_FORMAT} with three arguments to use different
4113 formats based on the @samp{-EB} and @samp{-EL} command-line options.
4114 This permits the linker script to set the output format based on the
4115 desired endianness.
4116
4117 If neither @samp{-EB} nor @samp{-EL} are used, then the output format
4118 will be the first argument, @var{default}. If @samp{-EB} is used, the
4119 output format will be the second argument, @var{big}. If @samp{-EL} is
4120 used, the output format will be the third argument, @var{little}.
4121
4122 For example, the default linker script for the MIPS ELF target uses this
4123 command:
4124 @smallexample
4125 OUTPUT_FORMAT(elf32-bigmips, elf32-bigmips, elf32-littlemips)
4126 @end smallexample
4127 This says that the default format for the output file is
4128 @samp{elf32-bigmips}, but if the user uses the @samp{-EL} command-line
4129 option, the output file will be created in the @samp{elf32-littlemips}
4130 format.
4131
4132 @item TARGET(@var{bfdname})
4133 @kindex TARGET(@var{bfdname})
4134 @cindex input file format in linker script
4135 The @code{TARGET} command names the BFD format to use when reading input
4136 files. It affects subsequent @code{INPUT} and @code{GROUP} commands.
4137 This command is like using @samp{-b @var{bfdname}} on the command line
4138 (@pxref{Options,,Command-line Options}). If the @code{TARGET} command
4139 is used but @code{OUTPUT_FORMAT} is not, then the last @code{TARGET}
4140 command is also used to set the format for the output file. @xref{BFD}.
4141 @end table
4142 @end ifclear
4143
4144 @node REGION_ALIAS
4145 @subsection Assign alias names to memory regions
4146 @kindex REGION_ALIAS(@var{alias}, @var{region})
4147 @cindex region alias
4148 @cindex region names
4149
4150 Alias names can be added to existing memory regions created with the
4151 @ref{MEMORY} command. Each name corresponds to at most one memory region.
4152
4153 @smallexample
4154 REGION_ALIAS(@var{alias}, @var{region})
4155 @end smallexample
4156
4157 The @code{REGION_ALIAS} function creates an alias name @var{alias} for the
4158 memory region @var{region}. This allows a flexible mapping of output sections
4159 to memory regions. An example follows.
4160
4161 Suppose we have an application for embedded systems which come with various
4162 memory storage devices. All have a general purpose, volatile memory @code{RAM}
4163 that allows code execution or data storage. Some may have a read-only,
4164 non-volatile memory @code{ROM} that allows code execution and read-only data
4165 access. The last variant is a read-only, non-volatile memory @code{ROM2} with
4166 read-only data access and no code execution capability. We have four output
4167 sections:
4168
4169 @itemize @bullet
4170 @item
4171 @code{.text} program code;
4172 @item
4173 @code{.rodata} read-only data;
4174 @item
4175 @code{.data} read-write initialized data;
4176 @item
4177 @code{.bss} read-write zero initialized data.
4178 @end itemize
4179
4180 The goal is to provide a linker command file that contains a system independent
4181 part defining the output sections and a system dependent part mapping the
4182 output sections to the memory regions available on the system. Our embedded
4183 systems come with three different memory setups @code{A}, @code{B} and
4184 @code{C}:
4185 @multitable @columnfractions .25 .25 .25 .25
4186 @item Section @tab Variant A @tab Variant B @tab Variant C
4187 @item .text @tab RAM @tab ROM @tab ROM
4188 @item .rodata @tab RAM @tab ROM @tab ROM2
4189 @item .data @tab RAM @tab RAM/ROM @tab RAM/ROM2
4190 @item .bss @tab RAM @tab RAM @tab RAM
4191 @end multitable
4192 The notation @code{RAM/ROM} or @code{RAM/ROM2} means that this section is
4193 loaded into region @code{ROM} or @code{ROM2} respectively. Please note that
4194 the load address of the @code{.data} section starts in all three variants at
4195 the end of the @code{.rodata} section.
4196
4197 The base linker script that deals with the output sections follows. It
4198 includes the system dependent @code{linkcmds.memory} file that describes the
4199 memory layout:
4200 @smallexample
4201 INCLUDE linkcmds.memory
4202
4203 SECTIONS
4204 @{
4205 .text :
4206 @{
4207 *(.text)
4208 @} > REGION_TEXT
4209 .rodata :
4210 @{
4211 *(.rodata)
4212 rodata_end = .;
4213 @} > REGION_RODATA
4214 .data : AT (rodata_end)
4215 @{
4216 data_start = .;
4217 *(.data)
4218 @} > REGION_DATA
4219 data_size = SIZEOF(.data);
4220 data_load_start = LOADADDR(.data);
4221 .bss :
4222 @{
4223 *(.bss)
4224 @} > REGION_BSS
4225 @}
4226 @end smallexample
4227
4228 Now we need three different @code{linkcmds.memory} files to define memory
4229 regions and alias names. The content of @code{linkcmds.memory} for the three
4230 variants @code{A}, @code{B} and @code{C}:
4231 @table @code
4232 @item A
4233 Here everything goes into the @code{RAM}.
4234 @smallexample
4235 MEMORY
4236 @{
4237 RAM : ORIGIN = 0, LENGTH = 4M
4238 @}
4239
4240 REGION_ALIAS("REGION_TEXT", RAM);
4241 REGION_ALIAS("REGION_RODATA", RAM);
4242 REGION_ALIAS("REGION_DATA", RAM);
4243 REGION_ALIAS("REGION_BSS", RAM);
4244 @end smallexample
4245 @item B
4246 Program code and read-only data go into the @code{ROM}. Read-write data goes
4247 into the @code{RAM}. An image of the initialized data is loaded into the
4248 @code{ROM} and will be copied during system start into the @code{RAM}.
4249 @smallexample
4250 MEMORY
4251 @{
4252 ROM : ORIGIN = 0, LENGTH = 3M
4253 RAM : ORIGIN = 0x10000000, LENGTH = 1M
4254 @}
4255
4256 REGION_ALIAS("REGION_TEXT", ROM);
4257 REGION_ALIAS("REGION_RODATA", ROM);
4258 REGION_ALIAS("REGION_DATA", RAM);
4259 REGION_ALIAS("REGION_BSS", RAM);
4260 @end smallexample
4261 @item C
4262 Program code goes into the @code{ROM}. Read-only data goes into the
4263 @code{ROM2}. Read-write data goes into the @code{RAM}. An image of the
4264 initialized data is loaded into the @code{ROM2} and will be copied during
4265 system start into the @code{RAM}.
4266 @smallexample
4267 MEMORY
4268 @{
4269 ROM : ORIGIN = 0, LENGTH = 2M
4270 ROM2 : ORIGIN = 0x10000000, LENGTH = 1M
4271 RAM : ORIGIN = 0x20000000, LENGTH = 1M
4272 @}
4273
4274 REGION_ALIAS("REGION_TEXT", ROM);
4275 REGION_ALIAS("REGION_RODATA", ROM2);
4276 REGION_ALIAS("REGION_DATA", RAM);
4277 REGION_ALIAS("REGION_BSS", RAM);
4278 @end smallexample
4279 @end table
4280
4281 It is possible to write a common system initialization routine to copy the
4282 @code{.data} section from @code{ROM} or @code{ROM2} into the @code{RAM} if
4283 necessary:
4284 @smallexample
4285 #include <string.h>
4286
4287 extern char data_start [];
4288 extern char data_size [];
4289 extern char data_load_start [];
4290
4291 void copy_data(void)
4292 @{
4293 if (data_start != data_load_start)
4294 @{
4295 memcpy(data_start, data_load_start, (size_t) data_size);
4296 @}
4297 @}
4298 @end smallexample
4299
4300 @node Miscellaneous Commands
4301 @subsection Other Linker Script Commands
4302 There are a few other linker scripts commands.
4303
4304 @table @code
4305 @item ASSERT(@var{exp}, @var{message})
4306 @kindex ASSERT
4307 @cindex assertion in linker script
4308 Ensure that @var{exp} is non-zero. If it is zero, then exit the linker
4309 with an error code, and print @var{message}.
4310
4311 Note that assertions are checked before the final stages of linking
4312 take place. This means that expressions involving symbols PROVIDEd
4313 inside section definitions will fail if the user has not set values
4314 for those symbols. The only exception to this rule is PROVIDEd
4315 symbols that just reference dot. Thus an assertion like this:
4316
4317 @smallexample
4318 .stack :
4319 @{
4320 PROVIDE (__stack = .);
4321 PROVIDE (__stack_size = 0x100);
4322 ASSERT ((__stack > (_end + __stack_size)), "Error: No room left for the stack");
4323 @}
4324 @end smallexample
4325
4326 will fail if @code{__stack_size} is not defined elsewhere. Symbols
4327 PROVIDEd outside of section definitions are evaluated earlier, so they
4328 can be used inside ASSERTions. Thus:
4329
4330 @smallexample
4331 PROVIDE (__stack_size = 0x100);
4332 .stack :
4333 @{
4334 PROVIDE (__stack = .);
4335 ASSERT ((__stack > (_end + __stack_size)), "Error: No room left for the stack");
4336 @}
4337 @end smallexample
4338
4339 will work.
4340
4341 @item EXTERN(@var{symbol} @var{symbol} @dots{})
4342 @kindex EXTERN
4343 @cindex undefined symbol in linker script
4344 Force @var{symbol} to be entered in the output file as an undefined
4345 symbol. Doing this may, for example, trigger linking of additional
4346 modules from standard libraries. You may list several @var{symbol}s for
4347 each @code{EXTERN}, and you may use @code{EXTERN} multiple times. This
4348 command has the same effect as the @samp{-u} command-line option.
4349
4350 @item FORCE_COMMON_ALLOCATION
4351 @kindex FORCE_COMMON_ALLOCATION
4352 @cindex common allocation in linker script
4353 This command has the same effect as the @samp{-d} command-line option:
4354 to make @command{ld} assign space to common symbols even if a relocatable
4355 output file is specified (@samp{-r}).
4356
4357 @item INHIBIT_COMMON_ALLOCATION
4358 @kindex INHIBIT_COMMON_ALLOCATION
4359 @cindex common allocation in linker script
4360 This command has the same effect as the @samp{--no-define-common}
4361 command-line option: to make @code{ld} omit the assignment of addresses
4362 to common symbols even for a non-relocatable output file.
4363
4364 @item FORCE_GROUP_ALLOCATION
4365 @kindex FORCE_GROUP_ALLOCATION
4366 @cindex group allocation in linker script
4367 @cindex section groups
4368 @cindex COMDAT
4369 This command has the same effect as the
4370 @samp{--force-group-allocation} command-line option: to make
4371 @command{ld} place section group members like normal input sections,
4372 and to delete the section groups even if a relocatable output file is
4373 specified (@samp{-r}).
4374
4375 @item INSERT [ AFTER | BEFORE ] @var{output_section}
4376 @kindex INSERT
4377 @cindex insert user script into default script
4378 This command is typically used in a script specified by @samp{-T} to
4379 augment the default @code{SECTIONS} with, for example, overlays. It
4380 inserts all prior linker script statements after (or before)
4381 @var{output_section}, and also causes @samp{-T} to not override the
4382 default linker script. The exact insertion point is as for orphan
4383 sections. @xref{Location Counter}. The insertion happens after the
4384 linker has mapped input sections to output sections. Prior to the
4385 insertion, since @samp{-T} scripts are parsed before the default
4386 linker script, statements in the @samp{-T} script occur before the
4387 default linker script statements in the internal linker representation
4388 of the script. In particular, input section assignments will be made
4389 to @samp{-T} output sections before those in the default script. Here
4390 is an example of how a @samp{-T} script using @code{INSERT} might look:
4391
4392 @smallexample
4393 SECTIONS
4394 @{
4395 OVERLAY :
4396 @{
4397 .ov1 @{ ov1*(.text) @}
4398 .ov2 @{ ov2*(.text) @}
4399 @}
4400 @}
4401 INSERT AFTER .text;
4402 @end smallexample
4403
4404 @item NOCROSSREFS(@var{section} @var{section} @dots{})
4405 @kindex NOCROSSREFS(@var{sections})
4406 @cindex cross references
4407 This command may be used to tell @command{ld} to issue an error about any
4408 references among certain output sections.
4409
4410 In certain types of programs, particularly on embedded systems when
4411 using overlays, when one section is loaded into memory, another section
4412 will not be. Any direct references between the two sections would be
4413 errors. For example, it would be an error if code in one section called
4414 a function defined in the other section.
4415
4416 The @code{NOCROSSREFS} command takes a list of output section names. If
4417 @command{ld} detects any cross references between the sections, it reports
4418 an error and returns a non-zero exit status. Note that the
4419 @code{NOCROSSREFS} command uses output section names, not input section
4420 names.
4421
4422 @item NOCROSSREFS_TO(@var{tosection} @var{fromsection} @dots{})
4423 @kindex NOCROSSREFS_TO(@var{tosection} @var{fromsections})
4424 @cindex cross references
4425 This command may be used to tell @command{ld} to issue an error about any
4426 references to one section from a list of other sections.
4427
4428 The @code{NOCROSSREFS} command is useful when ensuring that two or more
4429 output sections are entirely independent but there are situations where
4430 a one-way dependency is needed. For example, in a multi-core application
4431 there may be shared code that can be called from each core but for safety
4432 must never call back.
4433
4434 The @code{NOCROSSREFS_TO} command takes a list of output section names.
4435 The first section can not be referenced from any of the other sections.
4436 If @command{ld} detects any references to the first section from any of
4437 the other sections, it reports an error and returns a non-zero exit
4438 status. Note that the @code{NOCROSSREFS_TO} command uses output section
4439 names, not input section names.
4440
4441 @ifclear SingleFormat
4442 @item OUTPUT_ARCH(@var{bfdarch})
4443 @kindex OUTPUT_ARCH(@var{bfdarch})
4444 @cindex machine architecture
4445 @cindex architecture
4446 Specify a particular output machine architecture. The argument is one
4447 of the names used by the BFD library (@pxref{BFD}). You can see the
4448 architecture of an object file by using the @code{objdump} program with
4449 the @samp{-f} option.
4450 @end ifclear
4451
4452 @item LD_FEATURE(@var{string})
4453 @kindex LD_FEATURE(@var{string})
4454 This command may be used to modify @command{ld} behavior. If
4455 @var{string} is @code{"SANE_EXPR"} then absolute symbols and numbers
4456 in a script are simply treated as numbers everywhere.
4457 @xref{Expression Section}.
4458 @end table
4459
4460 @node Assignments
4461 @section Assigning Values to Symbols
4462 @cindex assignment in scripts
4463 @cindex symbol definition, scripts
4464 @cindex variables, defining
4465 You may assign a value to a symbol in a linker script. This will define
4466 the symbol and place it into the symbol table with a global scope.
4467
4468 @menu
4469 * Simple Assignments:: Simple Assignments
4470 * HIDDEN:: HIDDEN
4471 * PROVIDE:: PROVIDE
4472 * PROVIDE_HIDDEN:: PROVIDE_HIDDEN
4473 * Source Code Reference:: How to use a linker script defined symbol in source code
4474 @end menu
4475
4476 @node Simple Assignments
4477 @subsection Simple Assignments
4478
4479 You may assign to a symbol using any of the C assignment operators:
4480
4481 @table @code
4482 @item @var{symbol} = @var{expression} ;
4483 @itemx @var{symbol} += @var{expression} ;
4484 @itemx @var{symbol} -= @var{expression} ;
4485 @itemx @var{symbol} *= @var{expression} ;
4486 @itemx @var{symbol} /= @var{expression} ;
4487 @itemx @var{symbol} <<= @var{expression} ;
4488 @itemx @var{symbol} >>= @var{expression} ;
4489 @itemx @var{symbol} &= @var{expression} ;
4490 @itemx @var{symbol} |= @var{expression} ;
4491 @end table
4492
4493 The first case will define @var{symbol} to the value of
4494 @var{expression}. In the other cases, @var{symbol} must already be
4495 defined, and the value will be adjusted accordingly.
4496
4497 The special symbol name @samp{.} indicates the location counter. You
4498 may only use this within a @code{SECTIONS} command. @xref{Location Counter}.
4499
4500 The semicolon after @var{expression} is required.
4501
4502 Expressions are defined below; see @ref{Expressions}.
4503
4504 You may write symbol assignments as commands in their own right, or as
4505 statements within a @code{SECTIONS} command, or as part of an output
4506 section description in a @code{SECTIONS} command.
4507
4508 The section of the symbol will be set from the section of the
4509 expression; for more information, see @ref{Expression Section}.
4510
4511 Here is an example showing the three different places that symbol
4512 assignments may be used:
4513
4514 @smallexample
4515 floating_point = 0;
4516 SECTIONS
4517 @{
4518 .text :
4519 @{
4520 *(.text)
4521 _etext = .;
4522 @}
4523 _bdata = (. + 3) & ~ 3;
4524 .data : @{ *(.data) @}
4525 @}
4526 @end smallexample
4527 @noindent
4528 In this example, the symbol @samp{floating_point} will be defined as
4529 zero. The symbol @samp{_etext} will be defined as the address following
4530 the last @samp{.text} input section. The symbol @samp{_bdata} will be
4531 defined as the address following the @samp{.text} output section aligned
4532 upward to a 4 byte boundary.
4533
4534 @node HIDDEN
4535 @subsection HIDDEN
4536 @cindex HIDDEN
4537 For ELF targeted ports, define a symbol that will be hidden and won't be
4538 exported. The syntax is @code{HIDDEN(@var{symbol} = @var{expression})}.
4539
4540 Here is the example from @ref{Simple Assignments}, rewritten to use
4541 @code{HIDDEN}:
4542
4543 @smallexample
4544 HIDDEN(floating_point = 0);
4545 SECTIONS
4546 @{
4547 .text :
4548 @{
4549 *(.text)
4550 HIDDEN(_etext = .);
4551 @}
4552 HIDDEN(_bdata = (. + 3) & ~ 3);
4553 .data : @{ *(.data) @}
4554 @}
4555 @end smallexample
4556 @noindent
4557 In this case none of the three symbols will be visible outside this module.
4558
4559 @node PROVIDE
4560 @subsection PROVIDE
4561 @cindex PROVIDE
4562 In some cases, it is desirable for a linker script to define a symbol
4563 only if it is referenced and is not defined by any object included in
4564 the link. For example, traditional linkers defined the symbol
4565 @samp{etext}. However, ANSI C requires that the user be able to use
4566 @samp{etext} as a function name without encountering an error. The
4567 @code{PROVIDE} keyword may be used to define a symbol, such as
4568 @samp{etext}, only if it is referenced but not defined. The syntax is
4569 @code{PROVIDE(@var{symbol} = @var{expression})}.
4570
4571 Here is an example of using @code{PROVIDE} to define @samp{etext}:
4572 @smallexample
4573 SECTIONS
4574 @{
4575 .text :
4576 @{
4577 *(.text)
4578 _etext = .;
4579 PROVIDE(etext = .);
4580 @}
4581 @}
4582 @end smallexample
4583
4584 In this example, if the program defines @samp{_etext} (with a leading
4585 underscore), the linker will give a multiple definition diagnostic. If,
4586 on the other hand, the program defines @samp{etext} (with no leading
4587 underscore), the linker will silently use the definition in the program.
4588 If the program references @samp{etext} but does not define it, the
4589 linker will use the definition in the linker script.
4590
4591 Note - the @code{PROVIDE} directive considers a common symbol to be
4592 defined, even though such a symbol could be combined with the symbol
4593 that the @code{PROVIDE} would create. This is particularly important
4594 when considering constructor and destructor list symbols such as
4595 @samp{__CTOR_LIST__} as these are often defined as common symbols.
4596
4597 @node PROVIDE_HIDDEN
4598 @subsection PROVIDE_HIDDEN
4599 @cindex PROVIDE_HIDDEN
4600 Similar to @code{PROVIDE}. For ELF targeted ports, the symbol will be
4601 hidden and won't be exported.
4602
4603 @node Source Code Reference
4604 @subsection Source Code Reference
4605
4606 Accessing a linker script defined variable from source code is not
4607 intuitive. In particular a linker script symbol is not equivalent to
4608 a variable declaration in a high level language, it is instead a
4609 symbol that does not have a value.
4610
4611 Before going further, it is important to note that compilers often
4612 transform names in the source code into different names when they are
4613 stored in the symbol table. For example, Fortran compilers commonly
4614 prepend or append an underscore, and C++ performs extensive @samp{name
4615 mangling}. Therefore there might be a discrepancy between the name
4616 of a variable as it is used in source code and the name of the same
4617 variable as it is defined in a linker script. For example in C a
4618 linker script variable might be referred to as:
4619
4620 @smallexample
4621 extern int foo;
4622 @end smallexample
4623
4624 But in the linker script it might be defined as:
4625
4626 @smallexample
4627 _foo = 1000;
4628 @end smallexample
4629
4630 In the remaining examples however it is assumed that no name
4631 transformation has taken place.
4632
4633 When a symbol is declared in a high level language such as C, two
4634 things happen. The first is that the compiler reserves enough space
4635 in the program's memory to hold the @emph{value} of the symbol. The
4636 second is that the compiler creates an entry in the program's symbol
4637 table which holds the symbol's @emph{address}. ie the symbol table
4638 contains the address of the block of memory holding the symbol's
4639 value. So for example the following C declaration, at file scope:
4640
4641 @smallexample
4642 int foo = 1000;
4643 @end smallexample
4644
4645 creates an entry called @samp{foo} in the symbol table. This entry
4646 holds the address of an @samp{int} sized block of memory where the
4647 number 1000 is initially stored.
4648
4649 When a program references a symbol the compiler generates code that
4650 first accesses the symbol table to find the address of the symbol's
4651 memory block and then code to read the value from that memory block.
4652 So:
4653
4654 @smallexample
4655 foo = 1;
4656 @end smallexample
4657
4658 looks up the symbol @samp{foo} in the symbol table, gets the address
4659 associated with this symbol and then writes the value 1 into that
4660 address. Whereas:
4661
4662 @smallexample
4663 int * a = & foo;
4664 @end smallexample
4665
4666 looks up the symbol @samp{foo} in the symbol table, gets its address
4667 and then copies this address into the block of memory associated with
4668 the variable @samp{a}.
4669
4670 Linker scripts symbol declarations, by contrast, create an entry in
4671 the symbol table but do not assign any memory to them. Thus they are
4672 an address without a value. So for example the linker script definition:
4673
4674 @smallexample
4675 foo = 1000;
4676 @end smallexample
4677
4678 creates an entry in the symbol table called @samp{foo} which holds
4679 the address of memory location 1000, but nothing special is stored at
4680 address 1000. This means that you cannot access the @emph{value} of a
4681 linker script defined symbol - it has no value - all you can do is
4682 access the @emph{address} of a linker script defined symbol.
4683
4684 Hence when you are using a linker script defined symbol in source code
4685 you should always take the address of the symbol, and never attempt to
4686 use its value. For example suppose you want to copy the contents of a
4687 section of memory called .ROM into a section called .FLASH and the
4688 linker script contains these declarations:
4689
4690 @smallexample
4691 @group
4692 start_of_ROM = .ROM;
4693 end_of_ROM = .ROM + sizeof (.ROM);
4694 start_of_FLASH = .FLASH;
4695 @end group
4696 @end smallexample
4697
4698 Then the C source code to perform the copy would be:
4699
4700 @smallexample
4701 @group
4702 extern char start_of_ROM, end_of_ROM, start_of_FLASH;
4703
4704 memcpy (& start_of_FLASH, & start_of_ROM, & end_of_ROM - & start_of_ROM);
4705 @end group
4706 @end smallexample
4707
4708 Note the use of the @samp{&} operators. These are correct.
4709 Alternatively the symbols can be treated as the names of vectors or
4710 arrays and then the code will again work as expected:
4711
4712 @smallexample
4713 @group
4714 extern char start_of_ROM[], end_of_ROM[], start_of_FLASH[];
4715
4716 memcpy (start_of_FLASH, start_of_ROM, end_of_ROM - start_of_ROM);
4717 @end group
4718 @end smallexample
4719
4720 Note how using this method does not require the use of @samp{&}
4721 operators.
4722
4723 @node SECTIONS
4724 @section SECTIONS Command
4725 @kindex SECTIONS
4726 The @code{SECTIONS} command tells the linker how to map input sections
4727 into output sections, and how to place the output sections in memory.
4728
4729 The format of the @code{SECTIONS} command is:
4730 @smallexample
4731 SECTIONS
4732 @{
4733 @var{sections-command}
4734 @var{sections-command}
4735 @dots{}
4736 @}
4737 @end smallexample
4738
4739 Each @var{sections-command} may of be one of the following:
4740
4741 @itemize @bullet
4742 @item
4743 an @code{ENTRY} command (@pxref{Entry Point,,Entry command})
4744 @item
4745 a symbol assignment (@pxref{Assignments})
4746 @item
4747 an output section description
4748 @item
4749 an overlay description
4750 @end itemize
4751
4752 The @code{ENTRY} command and symbol assignments are permitted inside the
4753 @code{SECTIONS} command for convenience in using the location counter in
4754 those commands. This can also make the linker script easier to
4755 understand because you can use those commands at meaningful points in
4756 the layout of the output file.
4757
4758 Output section descriptions and overlay descriptions are described
4759 below.
4760
4761 If you do not use a @code{SECTIONS} command in your linker script, the
4762 linker will place each input section into an identically named output
4763 section in the order that the sections are first encountered in the
4764 input files. If all input sections are present in the first file, for
4765 example, the order of sections in the output file will match the order
4766 in the first input file. The first section will be at address zero.
4767
4768 @menu
4769 * Output Section Description:: Output section description
4770 * Output Section Name:: Output section name
4771 * Output Section Address:: Output section address
4772 * Input Section:: Input section description
4773 * Output Section Data:: Output section data
4774 * Output Section Keywords:: Output section keywords
4775 * Output Section Discarding:: Output section discarding
4776 * Output Section Attributes:: Output section attributes
4777 * Overlay Description:: Overlay description
4778 @end menu
4779
4780 @node Output Section Description
4781 @subsection Output Section Description
4782 The full description of an output section looks like this:
4783 @smallexample
4784 @group
4785 @var{section} [@var{address}] [(@var{type})] :
4786 [AT(@var{lma})]
4787 [ALIGN(@var{section_align}) | ALIGN_WITH_INPUT]
4788 [SUBALIGN(@var{subsection_align})]
4789 [@var{constraint}]
4790 @{
4791 @var{output-section-command}
4792 @var{output-section-command}
4793 @dots{}
4794 @} [>@var{region}] [AT>@var{lma_region}] [:@var{phdr} :@var{phdr} @dots{}] [=@var{fillexp}] [,]
4795 @end group
4796 @end smallexample
4797
4798 Most output sections do not use most of the optional section attributes.
4799
4800 The whitespace around @var{section} is required, so that the section
4801 name is unambiguous. The colon and the curly braces are also required.
4802 The comma at the end may be required if a @var{fillexp} is used and
4803 the next @var{sections-command} looks like a continuation of the expression.
4804 The line breaks and other white space are optional.
4805
4806 Each @var{output-section-command} may be one of the following:
4807
4808 @itemize @bullet
4809 @item
4810 a symbol assignment (@pxref{Assignments})
4811 @item
4812 an input section description (@pxref{Input Section})
4813 @item
4814 data values to include directly (@pxref{Output Section Data})
4815 @item
4816 a special output section keyword (@pxref{Output Section Keywords})
4817 @end itemize
4818
4819 @node Output Section Name
4820 @subsection Output Section Name
4821 @cindex name, section
4822 @cindex section name
4823 The name of the output section is @var{section}. @var{section} must
4824 meet the constraints of your output format. In formats which only
4825 support a limited number of sections, such as @code{a.out}, the name
4826 must be one of the names supported by the format (@code{a.out}, for
4827 example, allows only @samp{.text}, @samp{.data} or @samp{.bss}). If the
4828 output format supports any number of sections, but with numbers and not
4829 names (as is the case for Oasys), the name should be supplied as a
4830 quoted numeric string. A section name may consist of any sequence of
4831 characters, but a name which contains any unusual characters such as
4832 commas must be quoted.
4833
4834 The output section name @samp{/DISCARD/} is special; @ref{Output Section
4835 Discarding}.
4836
4837 @node Output Section Address
4838 @subsection Output Section Address
4839 @cindex address, section
4840 @cindex section address
4841 The @var{address} is an expression for the VMA (the virtual memory
4842 address) of the output section. This address is optional, but if it
4843 is provided then the output address will be set exactly as specified.
4844
4845 If the output address is not specified then one will be chosen for the
4846 section, based on the heuristic below. This address will be adjusted
4847 to fit the alignment requirement of the output section. The
4848 alignment requirement is the strictest alignment of any input section
4849 contained within the output section.
4850
4851 The output section address heuristic is as follows:
4852
4853 @itemize @bullet
4854 @item
4855 If an output memory @var{region} is set for the section then it
4856 is added to this region and its address will be the next free address
4857 in that region.
4858
4859 @item
4860 If the MEMORY command has been used to create a list of memory
4861 regions then the first region which has attributes compatible with the
4862 section is selected to contain it. The section's output address will
4863 be the next free address in that region; @ref{MEMORY}.
4864
4865 @item
4866 If no memory regions were specified, or none match the section then
4867 the output address will be based on the current value of the location
4868 counter.
4869 @end itemize
4870
4871 @noindent
4872 For example:
4873
4874 @smallexample
4875 .text . : @{ *(.text) @}
4876 @end smallexample
4877
4878 @noindent
4879 and
4880
4881 @smallexample
4882 .text : @{ *(.text) @}
4883 @end smallexample
4884
4885 @noindent
4886 are subtly different. The first will set the address of the
4887 @samp{.text} output section to the current value of the location
4888 counter. The second will set it to the current value of the location
4889 counter aligned to the strictest alignment of any of the @samp{.text}
4890 input sections.
4891
4892 The @var{address} may be an arbitrary expression; @ref{Expressions}.
4893 For example, if you want to align the section on a 0x10 byte boundary,
4894 so that the lowest four bits of the section address are zero, you could
4895 do something like this:
4896 @smallexample
4897 .text ALIGN(0x10) : @{ *(.text) @}
4898 @end smallexample
4899 @noindent
4900 This works because @code{ALIGN} returns the current location counter
4901 aligned upward to the specified value.
4902
4903 Specifying @var{address} for a section will change the value of the
4904 location counter, provided that the section is non-empty. (Empty
4905 sections are ignored).
4906
4907 @node Input Section
4908 @subsection Input Section Description
4909 @cindex input sections
4910 @cindex mapping input sections to output sections
4911 The most common output section command is an input section description.
4912
4913 The input section description is the most basic linker script operation.
4914 You use output sections to tell the linker how to lay out your program
4915 in memory. You use input section descriptions to tell the linker how to
4916 map the input files into your memory layout.
4917
4918 @menu
4919 * Input Section Basics:: Input section basics
4920 * Input Section Wildcards:: Input section wildcard patterns
4921 * Input Section Common:: Input section for common symbols
4922 * Input Section Keep:: Input section and garbage collection
4923 * Input Section Example:: Input section example
4924 @end menu
4925
4926 @node Input Section Basics
4927 @subsubsection Input Section Basics
4928 @cindex input section basics
4929 An input section description consists of a file name optionally followed
4930 by a list of section names in parentheses.
4931
4932 The file name and the section name may be wildcard patterns, which we
4933 describe further below (@pxref{Input Section Wildcards}).
4934
4935 The most common input section description is to include all input
4936 sections with a particular name in the output section. For example, to
4937 include all input @samp{.text} sections, you would write:
4938 @smallexample
4939 *(.text)
4940 @end smallexample
4941 @noindent
4942 Here the @samp{*} is a wildcard which matches any file name. To exclude a list
4943 @cindex EXCLUDE_FILE
4944 of files from matching the file name wildcard, EXCLUDE_FILE may be used to
4945 match all files except the ones specified in the EXCLUDE_FILE list. For
4946 example:
4947 @smallexample
4948 EXCLUDE_FILE (*crtend.o *otherfile.o) *(.ctors)
4949 @end smallexample
4950 @noindent
4951 will cause all .ctors sections from all files except @file{crtend.o}
4952 and @file{otherfile.o} to be included. The EXCLUDE_FILE can also be
4953 placed inside the section list, for example:
4954 @smallexample
4955 *(EXCLUDE_FILE (*crtend.o *otherfile.o) .ctors)
4956 @end smallexample
4957 @noindent
4958 The result of this is identically to the previous example. Supporting
4959 two syntaxes for EXCLUDE_FILE is useful if the section list contains
4960 more than one section, as described below.
4961
4962 There are two ways to include more than one section:
4963 @smallexample
4964 *(.text .rdata)
4965 *(.text) *(.rdata)
4966 @end smallexample
4967 @noindent
4968 The difference between these is the order in which the @samp{.text} and
4969 @samp{.rdata} input sections will appear in the output section. In the
4970 first example, they will be intermingled, appearing in the same order as
4971 they are found in the linker input. In the second example, all
4972 @samp{.text} input sections will appear first, followed by all
4973 @samp{.rdata} input sections.
4974
4975 When using EXCLUDE_FILE with more than one section, if the exclusion
4976 is within the section list then the exclusion only applies to the
4977 immediately following section, for example:
4978 @smallexample
4979 *(EXCLUDE_FILE (*somefile.o) .text .rdata)
4980 @end smallexample
4981 @noindent
4982 will cause all @samp{.text} sections from all files except
4983 @file{somefile.o} to be included, while all @samp{.rdata} sections
4984 from all files, including @file{somefile.o}, will be included. To
4985 exclude the @samp{.rdata} sections from @file{somefile.o} the example
4986 could be modified to:
4987 @smallexample
4988 *(EXCLUDE_FILE (*somefile.o) .text EXCLUDE_FILE (*somefile.o) .rdata)
4989 @end smallexample
4990 @noindent
4991 Alternatively, placing the EXCLUDE_FILE outside of the section list,
4992 before the input file selection, will cause the exclusion to apply for
4993 all sections. Thus the previous example can be rewritten as:
4994 @smallexample
4995 EXCLUDE_FILE (*somefile.o) *(.text .rdata)
4996 @end smallexample
4997
4998 You can specify a file name to include sections from a particular file.
4999 You would do this if one or more of your files contain special data that
5000 needs to be at a particular location in memory. For example:
5001 @smallexample
5002 data.o(.data)
5003 @end smallexample
5004
5005 To refine the sections that are included based on the section flags
5006 of an input section, INPUT_SECTION_FLAGS may be used.
5007
5008 Here is a simple example for using Section header flags for ELF sections:
5009
5010 @smallexample
5011 @group
5012 SECTIONS @{
5013 .text : @{ INPUT_SECTION_FLAGS (SHF_MERGE & SHF_STRINGS) *(.text) @}
5014 .text2 : @{ INPUT_SECTION_FLAGS (!SHF_WRITE) *(.text) @}
5015 @}
5016 @end group
5017 @end smallexample
5018
5019 In this example, the output section @samp{.text} will be comprised of any
5020 input section matching the name *(.text) whose section header flags
5021 @code{SHF_MERGE} and @code{SHF_STRINGS} are set. The output section
5022 @samp{.text2} will be comprised of any input section matching the name *(.text)
5023 whose section header flag @code{SHF_WRITE} is clear.
5024
5025 You can also specify files within archives by writing a pattern
5026 matching the archive, a colon, then the pattern matching the file,
5027 with no whitespace around the colon.
5028
5029 @table @samp
5030 @item archive:file
5031 matches file within archive
5032 @item archive:
5033 matches the whole archive
5034 @item :file
5035 matches file but not one in an archive
5036 @end table
5037
5038 Either one or both of @samp{archive} and @samp{file} can contain shell
5039 wildcards. On DOS based file systems, the linker will assume that a
5040 single letter followed by a colon is a drive specifier, so
5041 @samp{c:myfile.o} is a simple file specification, not @samp{myfile.o}
5042 within an archive called @samp{c}. @samp{archive:file} filespecs may
5043 also be used within an @code{EXCLUDE_FILE} list, but may not appear in
5044 other linker script contexts. For instance, you cannot extract a file
5045 from an archive by using @samp{archive:file} in an @code{INPUT}
5046 command.
5047
5048 If you use a file name without a list of sections, then all sections in
5049 the input file will be included in the output section. This is not
5050 commonly done, but it may by useful on occasion. For example:
5051 @smallexample
5052 data.o
5053 @end smallexample
5054
5055 When you use a file name which is not an @samp{archive:file} specifier
5056 and does not contain any wild card
5057 characters, the linker will first see if you also specified the file
5058 name on the linker command line or in an @code{INPUT} command. If you
5059 did not, the linker will attempt to open the file as an input file, as
5060 though it appeared on the command line. Note that this differs from an
5061 @code{INPUT} command, because the linker will not search for the file in
5062 the archive search path.
5063
5064 @node Input Section Wildcards
5065 @subsubsection Input Section Wildcard Patterns
5066 @cindex input section wildcards
5067 @cindex wildcard file name patterns
5068 @cindex file name wildcard patterns
5069 @cindex section name wildcard patterns
5070 In an input section description, either the file name or the section
5071 name or both may be wildcard patterns.
5072
5073 The file name of @samp{*} seen in many examples is a simple wildcard
5074 pattern for the file name.
5075
5076 The wildcard patterns are like those used by the Unix shell.
5077
5078 @table @samp
5079 @item *
5080 matches any number of characters
5081 @item ?
5082 matches any single character
5083 @item [@var{chars}]
5084 matches a single instance of any of the @var{chars}; the @samp{-}
5085 character may be used to specify a range of characters, as in
5086 @samp{[a-z]} to match any lower case letter
5087 @item \
5088 quotes the following character
5089 @end table
5090
5091 File name wildcard patterns only match files which are explicitly
5092 specified on the command line or in an @code{INPUT} command. The linker
5093 does not search directories to expand wildcards.
5094
5095 If a file name matches more than one wildcard pattern, or if a file name
5096 appears explicitly and is also matched by a wildcard pattern, the linker
5097 will use the first match in the linker script. For example, this
5098 sequence of input section descriptions is probably in error, because the
5099 @file{data.o} rule will not be used:
5100 @smallexample
5101 .data : @{ *(.data) @}
5102 .data1 : @{ data.o(.data) @}
5103 @end smallexample
5104
5105 @cindex SORT_BY_NAME
5106 Normally, the linker will place files and sections matched by wildcards
5107 in the order in which they are seen during the link. You can change
5108 this by using the @code{SORT_BY_NAME} keyword, which appears before a wildcard
5109 pattern in parentheses (e.g., @code{SORT_BY_NAME(.text*)}). When the
5110 @code{SORT_BY_NAME} keyword is used, the linker will sort the files or sections
5111 into ascending order by name before placing them in the output file.
5112
5113 @cindex SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT
5114 @code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} is similar to @code{SORT_BY_NAME}.
5115 @code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} will sort sections into descending order of
5116 alignment before placing them in the output file. Placing larger
5117 alignments before smaller alignments can reduce the amount of padding
5118 needed.
5119
5120 @cindex SORT_BY_INIT_PRIORITY
5121 @code{SORT_BY_INIT_PRIORITY} is also similar to @code{SORT_BY_NAME}.
5122 @code{SORT_BY_INIT_PRIORITY} will sort sections into ascending
5123 numerical order of the GCC init_priority attribute encoded in the
5124 section name before placing them in the output file. In
5125 @code{.init_array.NNNNN} and @code{.fini_array.NNNNN}, @code{NNNNN} is
5126 the init_priority. In @code{.ctors.NNNNN} and @code{.dtors.NNNNN},
5127 @code{NNNNN} is 65535 minus the init_priority.
5128
5129 @cindex SORT
5130 @code{SORT} is an alias for @code{SORT_BY_NAME}.
5131
5132 When there are nested section sorting commands in linker script, there
5133 can be at most 1 level of nesting for section sorting commands.
5134
5135 @enumerate
5136 @item
5137 @code{SORT_BY_NAME} (@code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} (wildcard section pattern)).
5138 It will sort the input sections by name first, then by alignment if two
5139 sections have the same name.
5140 @item
5141 @code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} (@code{SORT_BY_NAME} (wildcard section pattern)).
5142 It will sort the input sections by alignment first, then by name if two
5143 sections have the same alignment.
5144 @item
5145 @code{SORT_BY_NAME} (@code{SORT_BY_NAME} (wildcard section pattern)) is
5146 treated the same as @code{SORT_BY_NAME} (wildcard section pattern).
5147 @item
5148 @code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} (@code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} (wildcard section pattern))
5149 is treated the same as @code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} (wildcard section pattern).
5150 @item
5151 All other nested section sorting commands are invalid.
5152 @end enumerate
5153
5154 When both command-line section sorting option and linker script
5155 section sorting command are used, section sorting command always
5156 takes precedence over the command-line option.
5157
5158 If the section sorting command in linker script isn't nested, the
5159 command-line option will make the section sorting command to be
5160 treated as nested sorting command.
5161
5162 @enumerate
5163 @item
5164 @code{SORT_BY_NAME} (wildcard section pattern ) with
5165 @option{--sort-sections alignment} is equivalent to
5166 @code{SORT_BY_NAME} (@code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} (wildcard section pattern)).
5167 @item
5168 @code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} (wildcard section pattern) with
5169 @option{--sort-section name} is equivalent to
5170 @code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} (@code{SORT_BY_NAME} (wildcard section pattern)).
5171 @end enumerate
5172
5173 If the section sorting command in linker script is nested, the
5174 command-line option will be ignored.
5175
5176 @cindex SORT_NONE
5177 @code{SORT_NONE} disables section sorting by ignoring the command-line
5178 section sorting option.
5179
5180 If you ever get confused about where input sections are going, use the
5181 @samp{-M} linker option to generate a map file. The map file shows
5182 precisely how input sections are mapped to output sections.
5183
5184 This example shows how wildcard patterns might be used to partition
5185 files. This linker script directs the linker to place all @samp{.text}
5186 sections in @samp{.text} and all @samp{.bss} sections in @samp{.bss}.
5187 The linker will place the @samp{.data} section from all files beginning
5188 with an upper case character in @samp{.DATA}; for all other files, the
5189 linker will place the @samp{.data} section in @samp{.data}.
5190 @smallexample
5191 @group
5192 SECTIONS @{
5193 .text : @{ *(.text) @}
5194 .DATA : @{ [A-Z]*(.data) @}
5195 .data : @{ *(.data) @}
5196 .bss : @{ *(.bss) @}
5197 @}
5198 @end group
5199 @end smallexample
5200
5201 @node Input Section Common
5202 @subsubsection Input Section for Common Symbols
5203 @cindex common symbol placement
5204 @cindex uninitialized data placement
5205 A special notation is needed for common symbols, because in many object
5206 file formats common symbols do not have a particular input section. The
5207 linker treats common symbols as though they are in an input section
5208 named @samp{COMMON}.
5209
5210 You may use file names with the @samp{COMMON} section just as with any
5211 other input sections. You can use this to place common symbols from a
5212 particular input file in one section while common symbols from other
5213 input files are placed in another section.
5214
5215 In most cases, common symbols in input files will be placed in the
5216 @samp{.bss} section in the output file. For example:
5217 @smallexample
5218 .bss @{ *(.bss) *(COMMON) @}
5219 @end smallexample
5220
5221 @cindex scommon section
5222 @cindex small common symbols
5223 Some object file formats have more than one type of common symbol. For
5224 example, the MIPS ELF object file format distinguishes standard common
5225 symbols and small common symbols. In this case, the linker will use a
5226 different special section name for other types of common symbols. In
5227 the case of MIPS ELF, the linker uses @samp{COMMON} for standard common
5228 symbols and @samp{.scommon} for small common symbols. This permits you
5229 to map the different types of common symbols into memory at different
5230 locations.
5231
5232 @cindex [COMMON]
5233 You will sometimes see @samp{[COMMON]} in old linker scripts. This
5234 notation is now considered obsolete. It is equivalent to
5235 @samp{*(COMMON)}.
5236
5237 @node Input Section Keep
5238 @subsubsection Input Section and Garbage Collection
5239 @cindex KEEP
5240 @cindex garbage collection
5241 When link-time garbage collection is in use (@samp{--gc-sections}),
5242 it is often useful to mark sections that should not be eliminated.
5243 This is accomplished by surrounding an input section's wildcard entry
5244 with @code{KEEP()}, as in @code{KEEP(*(.init))} or
5245 @code{KEEP(SORT_BY_NAME(*)(.ctors))}.
5246
5247 @node Input Section Example
5248 @subsubsection Input Section Example
5249 The following example is a complete linker script. It tells the linker
5250 to read all of the sections from file @file{all.o} and place them at the
5251 start of output section @samp{outputa} which starts at location
5252 @samp{0x10000}. All of section @samp{.input1} from file @file{foo.o}
5253 follows immediately, in the same output section. All of section
5254 @samp{.input2} from @file{foo.o} goes into output section
5255 @samp{outputb}, followed by section @samp{.input1} from @file{foo1.o}.
5256 All of the remaining @samp{.input1} and @samp{.input2} sections from any
5257 files are written to output section @samp{outputc}.
5258
5259 @smallexample
5260 @group
5261 SECTIONS @{
5262 outputa 0x10000 :
5263 @{
5264 all.o
5265 foo.o (.input1)
5266 @}
5267 @end group
5268 @group
5269 outputb :
5270 @{
5271 foo.o (.input2)
5272 foo1.o (.input1)
5273 @}
5274 @end group
5275 @group
5276 outputc :
5277 @{
5278 *(.input1)
5279 *(.input2)
5280 @}
5281 @}
5282 @end group
5283 @end smallexample
5284
5285 If an output section's name is the same as the input section's name
5286 and is representable as a C identifier, then the linker will
5287 automatically @pxref{PROVIDE} two symbols: __start_SECNAME and
5288 __stop_SECNAME, where SECNAME is the name of the section. These
5289 indicate the start address and end address of the output section
5290 respectively. Note: most section names are not representable as
5291 C identifiers because they contain a @samp{.} character.
5292
5293 @node Output Section Data
5294 @subsection Output Section Data
5295 @cindex data
5296 @cindex section data
5297 @cindex output section data
5298 @kindex BYTE(@var{expression})
5299 @kindex SHORT(@var{expression})
5300 @kindex LONG(@var{expression})
5301 @kindex QUAD(@var{expression})
5302 @kindex SQUAD(@var{expression})
5303 You can include explicit bytes of data in an output section by using
5304 @code{BYTE}, @code{SHORT}, @code{LONG}, @code{QUAD}, or @code{SQUAD} as
5305 an output section command. Each keyword is followed by an expression in
5306 parentheses providing the value to store (@pxref{Expressions}). The
5307 value of the expression is stored at the current value of the location
5308 counter.
5309
5310 The @code{BYTE}, @code{SHORT}, @code{LONG}, and @code{QUAD} commands
5311 store one, two, four, and eight bytes (respectively). After storing the
5312 bytes, the location counter is incremented by the number of bytes
5313 stored.
5314
5315 For example, this will store the byte 1 followed by the four byte value
5316 of the symbol @samp{addr}:
5317 @smallexample
5318 BYTE(1)
5319 LONG(addr)
5320 @end smallexample
5321
5322 When using a 64 bit host or target, @code{QUAD} and @code{SQUAD} are the
5323 same; they both store an 8 byte, or 64 bit, value. When both host and
5324 target are 32 bits, an expression is computed as 32 bits. In this case
5325 @code{QUAD} stores a 32 bit value zero extended to 64 bits, and
5326 @code{SQUAD} stores a 32 bit value sign extended to 64 bits.
5327
5328 If the object file format of the output file has an explicit endianness,
5329 which is the normal case, the value will be stored in that endianness.
5330 When the object file format does not have an explicit endianness, as is
5331 true of, for example, S-records, the value will be stored in the
5332 endianness of the first input object file.
5333
5334 Note---these commands only work inside a section description and not
5335 between them, so the following will produce an error from the linker:
5336 @smallexample
5337 SECTIONS @{@ .text : @{@ *(.text) @}@ LONG(1) .data : @{@ *(.data) @}@ @}@
5338 @end smallexample
5339 whereas this will work:
5340 @smallexample
5341 SECTIONS @{@ .text : @{@ *(.text) ; LONG(1) @}@ .data : @{@ *(.data) @}@ @}@
5342 @end smallexample
5343
5344 @kindex FILL(@var{expression})
5345 @cindex holes, filling
5346 @cindex unspecified memory
5347 You may use the @code{FILL} command to set the fill pattern for the
5348 current section. It is followed by an expression in parentheses. Any
5349 otherwise unspecified regions of memory within the section (for example,
5350 gaps left due to the required alignment of input sections) are filled
5351 with the value of the expression, repeated as
5352 necessary. A @code{FILL} statement covers memory locations after the
5353 point at which it occurs in the section definition; by including more
5354 than one @code{FILL} statement, you can have different fill patterns in
5355 different parts of an output section.
5356
5357 This example shows how to fill unspecified regions of memory with the
5358 value @samp{0x90}:
5359 @smallexample
5360 FILL(0x90909090)
5361 @end smallexample
5362
5363 The @code{FILL} command is similar to the @samp{=@var{fillexp}} output
5364 section attribute, but it only affects the
5365 part of the section following the @code{FILL} command, rather than the
5366 entire section. If both are used, the @code{FILL} command takes
5367 precedence. @xref{Output Section Fill}, for details on the fill
5368 expression.
5369
5370 @node Output Section Keywords
5371 @subsection Output Section Keywords
5372 There are a couple of keywords which can appear as output section
5373 commands.
5374
5375 @table @code
5376 @kindex CREATE_OBJECT_SYMBOLS
5377 @cindex input filename symbols
5378 @cindex filename symbols
5379 @item CREATE_OBJECT_SYMBOLS
5380 The command tells the linker to create a symbol for each input file.
5381 The name of each symbol will be the name of the corresponding input
5382 file. The section of each symbol will be the output section in which
5383 the @code{CREATE_OBJECT_SYMBOLS} command appears.
5384
5385 This is conventional for the a.out object file format. It is not
5386 normally used for any other object file format.
5387
5388 @kindex CONSTRUCTORS
5389 @cindex C++ constructors, arranging in link
5390 @cindex constructors, arranging in link
5391 @item CONSTRUCTORS
5392 When linking using the a.out object file format, the linker uses an
5393 unusual set construct to support C++ global constructors and
5394 destructors. When linking object file formats which do not support
5395 arbitrary sections, such as ECOFF and XCOFF, the linker will
5396 automatically recognize C++ global constructors and destructors by name.
5397 For these object file formats, the @code{CONSTRUCTORS} command tells the
5398 linker to place constructor information in the output section where the
5399 @code{CONSTRUCTORS} command appears. The @code{CONSTRUCTORS} command is
5400 ignored for other object file formats.
5401
5402 The symbol @w{@code{__CTOR_LIST__}} marks the start of the global
5403 constructors, and the symbol @w{@code{__CTOR_END__}} marks the end.
5404 Similarly, @w{@code{__DTOR_LIST__}} and @w{@code{__DTOR_END__}} mark
5405 the start and end of the global destructors. The
5406 first word in the list is the number of entries, followed by the address
5407 of each constructor or destructor, followed by a zero word. The
5408 compiler must arrange to actually run the code. For these object file
5409 formats @sc{gnu} C++ normally calls constructors from a subroutine
5410 @code{__main}; a call to @code{__main} is automatically inserted into
5411 the startup code for @code{main}. @sc{gnu} C++ normally runs
5412 destructors either by using @code{atexit}, or directly from the function
5413 @code{exit}.
5414
5415 For object file formats such as @code{COFF} or @code{ELF} which support
5416 arbitrary section names, @sc{gnu} C++ will normally arrange to put the
5417 addresses of global constructors and destructors into the @code{.ctors}
5418 and @code{.dtors} sections. Placing the following sequence into your
5419 linker script will build the sort of table which the @sc{gnu} C++
5420 runtime code expects to see.
5421
5422 @smallexample
5423 __CTOR_LIST__ = .;
5424 LONG((__CTOR_END__ - __CTOR_LIST__) / 4 - 2)
5425 *(.ctors)
5426 LONG(0)
5427 __CTOR_END__ = .;
5428 __DTOR_LIST__ = .;
5429 LONG((__DTOR_END__ - __DTOR_LIST__) / 4 - 2)
5430 *(.dtors)
5431 LONG(0)
5432 __DTOR_END__ = .;
5433 @end smallexample
5434
5435 If you are using the @sc{gnu} C++ support for initialization priority,
5436 which provides some control over the order in which global constructors
5437 are run, you must sort the constructors at link time to ensure that they
5438 are executed in the correct order. When using the @code{CONSTRUCTORS}
5439 command, use @samp{SORT_BY_NAME(CONSTRUCTORS)} instead. When using the
5440 @code{.ctors} and @code{.dtors} sections, use @samp{*(SORT_BY_NAME(.ctors))} and
5441 @samp{*(SORT_BY_NAME(.dtors))} instead of just @samp{*(.ctors)} and
5442 @samp{*(.dtors)}.
5443
5444 Normally the compiler and linker will handle these issues automatically,
5445 and you will not need to concern yourself with them. However, you may
5446 need to consider this if you are using C++ and writing your own linker
5447 scripts.
5448
5449 @end table
5450
5451 @node Output Section Discarding
5452 @subsection Output Section Discarding
5453 @cindex discarding sections
5454 @cindex sections, discarding
5455 @cindex removing sections
5456 The linker will not normally create output sections with no contents.
5457 This is for convenience when referring to input sections that may or
5458 may not be present in any of the input files. For example:
5459 @smallexample
5460 .foo : @{ *(.foo) @}
5461 @end smallexample
5462 @noindent
5463 will only create a @samp{.foo} section in the output file if there is a
5464 @samp{.foo} section in at least one input file, and if the input
5465 sections are not all empty. Other link script directives that allocate
5466 space in an output section will also create the output section. So
5467 too will assignments to dot even if the assignment does not create
5468 space, except for @samp{. = 0}, @samp{. = . + 0}, @samp{. = sym},
5469 @samp{. = . + sym} and @samp{. = ALIGN (. != 0, expr, 1)} when
5470 @samp{sym} is an absolute symbol of value 0 defined in the script.
5471 This allows you to force output of an empty section with @samp{. = .}.
5472
5473 The linker will ignore address assignments (@pxref{Output Section Address})
5474 on discarded output sections, except when the linker script defines
5475 symbols in the output section. In that case the linker will obey
5476 the address assignments, possibly advancing dot even though the
5477 section is discarded.
5478
5479 @cindex /DISCARD/
5480 The special output section name @samp{/DISCARD/} may be used to discard
5481 input sections. Any input sections which are assigned to an output
5482 section named @samp{/DISCARD/} are not included in the output file.
5483
5484 This can be used to discard input sections marked with the ELF flag
5485 @code{SHF_GNU_RETAIN}, which would otherwise have been saved from linker
5486 garbage collection.
5487
5488 Note, sections that match the @samp{/DISCARD/} output section will be
5489 discarded even if they are in an ELF section group which has other
5490 members which are not being discarded. This is deliberate.
5491 Discarding takes precedence over grouping.
5492
5493 @node Output Section Attributes
5494 @subsection Output Section Attributes
5495 @cindex output section attributes
5496 We showed above that the full description of an output section looked
5497 like this:
5498
5499 @smallexample
5500 @group
5501 @var{section} [@var{address}] [(@var{type})] :
5502 [AT(@var{lma})]
5503 [ALIGN(@var{section_align}) | ALIGN_WITH_INPUT]
5504 [SUBALIGN(@var{subsection_align})]
5505 [@var{constraint}]
5506 @{
5507 @var{output-section-command}
5508 @var{output-section-command}
5509 @dots{}
5510 @} [>@var{region}] [AT>@var{lma_region}] [:@var{phdr} :@var{phdr} @dots{}] [=@var{fillexp}]
5511 @end group
5512 @end smallexample
5513
5514 We've already described @var{section}, @var{address}, and
5515 @var{output-section-command}. In this section we will describe the
5516 remaining section attributes.
5517
5518 @menu
5519 * Output Section Type:: Output section type
5520 * Output Section LMA:: Output section LMA
5521 * Forced Output Alignment:: Forced Output Alignment
5522 * Forced Input Alignment:: Forced Input Alignment
5523 * Output Section Constraint:: Output section constraint
5524 * Output Section Region:: Output section region
5525 * Output Section Phdr:: Output section phdr
5526 * Output Section Fill:: Output section fill
5527 @end menu
5528
5529 @node Output Section Type
5530 @subsubsection Output Section Type
5531 Each output section may have a type. The type is a keyword in
5532 parentheses. The following types are defined:
5533
5534 @table @code
5535 @item NOLOAD
5536 The section should be marked as not loadable, so that it will not be
5537 loaded into memory when the program is run.
5538 @item READONLY
5539 The section should be marked as read-only.
5540 @item DSECT
5541 @item COPY
5542 @item INFO
5543 @item OVERLAY
5544 These type names are supported for backward compatibility, and are
5545 rarely used. They all have the same effect: the section should be
5546 marked as not allocatable, so that no memory is allocated for the
5547 section when the program is run.
5548 @item TYPE = @var{type}
5549 Set the section type to the integer @var{type}. When generating an ELF
5550 output file, type names @code{SHT_PROGBITS}, @code{SHT_STRTAB},
5551 @code{SHT_NOTE}, @code{SHT_NOBITS}, @code{SHT_INIT_ARRAY},
5552 @code{SHT_FINI_ARRAY}, and @code{SHT_PREINIT_ARRAY} are also allowed
5553 for @var{type}. It is the user's responsibility to ensure that any
5554 special requirements of the section type are met.
5555 @item READONLY ( TYPE = @var{type} )
5556 This form of the syntax combines the @var{READONLY} type with the
5557 type specified by @var{type}.
5558 @end table
5559
5560 @kindex NOLOAD
5561 @cindex prevent unnecessary loading
5562 @cindex loading, preventing
5563 The linker normally sets the attributes of an output section based on
5564 the input sections which map into it. You can override this by using
5565 the section type. For example, in the script sample below, the
5566 @samp{ROM} section is addressed at memory location @samp{0} and does not
5567 need to be loaded when the program is run.
5568 @smallexample
5569 @group
5570 SECTIONS @{
5571 ROM 0 (NOLOAD) : @{ @dots{} @}
5572 @dots{}
5573 @}
5574 @end group
5575 @end smallexample
5576
5577 @node Output Section LMA
5578 @subsubsection Output Section LMA
5579 @kindex AT>@var{lma_region}
5580 @kindex AT(@var{lma})
5581 @cindex load address
5582 @cindex section load address
5583 Every section has a virtual address (VMA) and a load address (LMA); see
5584 @ref{Basic Script Concepts}. The virtual address is specified by the
5585 @pxref{Output Section Address} described earlier. The load address is
5586 specified by the @code{AT} or @code{AT>} keywords. Specifying a load
5587 address is optional.
5588
5589 The @code{AT} keyword takes an expression as an argument. This
5590 specifies the exact load address of the section. The @code{AT>} keyword
5591 takes the name of a memory region as an argument. @xref{MEMORY}. The
5592 load address of the section is set to the next free address in the
5593 region, aligned to the section's alignment requirements.
5594
5595 If neither @code{AT} nor @code{AT>} is specified for an allocatable
5596 section, the linker will use the following heuristic to determine the
5597 load address:
5598
5599 @itemize @bullet
5600 @item
5601 If the section has a specific VMA address, then this is used as
5602 the LMA address as well.
5603
5604 @item
5605 If the section is not allocatable then its LMA is set to its VMA.
5606
5607 @item
5608 Otherwise if a memory region can be found that is compatible
5609 with the current section, and this region contains at least one
5610 section, then the LMA is set so the difference between the
5611 VMA and LMA is the same as the difference between the VMA and LMA of
5612 the last section in the located region.
5613
5614 @item
5615 If no memory regions have been declared then a default region
5616 that covers the entire address space is used in the previous step.
5617
5618 @item
5619 If no suitable region could be found, or there was no previous
5620 section then the LMA is set equal to the VMA.
5621 @end itemize
5622
5623 @cindex ROM initialized data
5624 @cindex initialized data in ROM
5625 This feature is designed to make it easy to build a ROM image. For
5626 example, the following linker script creates three output sections: one
5627 called @samp{.text}, which starts at @code{0x1000}, one called
5628 @samp{.mdata}, which is loaded at the end of the @samp{.text} section
5629 even though its VMA is @code{0x2000}, and one called @samp{.bss} to hold
5630 uninitialized data at address @code{0x3000}. The symbol @code{_data} is
5631 defined with the value @code{0x2000}, which shows that the location
5632 counter holds the VMA value, not the LMA value.
5633
5634 @smallexample
5635 @group
5636 SECTIONS
5637 @{
5638 .text 0x1000 : @{ *(.text) _etext = . ; @}
5639 .mdata 0x2000 :
5640 AT ( ADDR (.text) + SIZEOF (.text) )
5641 @{ _data = . ; *(.data); _edata = . ; @}
5642 .bss 0x3000 :
5643 @{ _bstart = . ; *(.bss) *(COMMON) ; _bend = . ;@}
5644 @}
5645 @end group
5646 @end smallexample
5647
5648 The run-time initialization code for use with a program generated with
5649 this linker script would include something like the following, to copy
5650 the initialized data from the ROM image to its runtime address. Notice
5651 how this code takes advantage of the symbols defined by the linker
5652 script.
5653
5654 @smallexample
5655 @group
5656 extern char _etext, _data, _edata, _bstart, _bend;
5657 char *src = &_etext;
5658 char *dst = &_data;
5659
5660 /* ROM has data at end of text; copy it. */
5661 while (dst < &_edata)
5662 *dst++ = *src++;
5663
5664 /* Zero bss. */
5665 for (dst = &_bstart; dst< &_bend; dst++)
5666 *dst = 0;
5667 @end group
5668 @end smallexample
5669
5670 @node Forced Output Alignment
5671 @subsubsection Forced Output Alignment
5672 @kindex ALIGN(@var{section_align})
5673 @cindex forcing output section alignment
5674 @cindex output section alignment
5675 You can increase an output section's alignment by using ALIGN. As an
5676 alternative you can enforce that the difference between the VMA and LMA remains
5677 intact throughout this output section with the ALIGN_WITH_INPUT attribute.
5678
5679 @node Forced Input Alignment
5680 @subsubsection Forced Input Alignment
5681 @kindex SUBALIGN(@var{subsection_align})
5682 @cindex forcing input section alignment
5683 @cindex input section alignment
5684 You can force input section alignment within an output section by using
5685 SUBALIGN. The value specified overrides any alignment given by input
5686 sections, whether larger or smaller.
5687
5688 @node Output Section Constraint
5689 @subsubsection Output Section Constraint
5690 @kindex ONLY_IF_RO
5691 @kindex ONLY_IF_RW
5692 @cindex constraints on output sections
5693 You can specify that an output section should only be created if all
5694 of its input sections are read-only or all of its input sections are
5695 read-write by using the keyword @code{ONLY_IF_RO} and
5696 @code{ONLY_IF_RW} respectively.
5697
5698 @node Output Section Region
5699 @subsubsection Output Section Region
5700 @kindex >@var{region}
5701 @cindex section, assigning to memory region
5702 @cindex memory regions and sections
5703 You can assign a section to a previously defined region of memory by
5704 using @samp{>@var{region}}. @xref{MEMORY}.
5705
5706 Here is a simple example:
5707 @smallexample
5708 @group
5709 MEMORY @{ rom : ORIGIN = 0x1000, LENGTH = 0x1000 @}
5710 SECTIONS @{ ROM : @{ *(.text) @} >rom @}
5711 @end group
5712 @end smallexample
5713
5714 @node Output Section Phdr
5715 @subsubsection Output Section Phdr
5716 @kindex :@var{phdr}
5717 @cindex section, assigning to program header
5718 @cindex program headers and sections
5719 You can assign a section to a previously defined program segment by
5720 using @samp{:@var{phdr}}. @xref{PHDRS}. If a section is assigned to
5721 one or more segments, then all subsequent allocated sections will be
5722 assigned to those segments as well, unless they use an explicitly
5723 @code{:@var{phdr}} modifier. You can use @code{:NONE} to tell the
5724 linker to not put the section in any segment at all.
5725
5726 Here is a simple example:
5727 @smallexample
5728 @group
5729 PHDRS @{ text PT_LOAD ; @}
5730 SECTIONS @{ .text : @{ *(.text) @} :text @}
5731 @end group
5732 @end smallexample
5733
5734 @node Output Section Fill
5735 @subsubsection Output Section Fill
5736 @kindex =@var{fillexp}
5737 @cindex section fill pattern
5738 @cindex fill pattern, entire section
5739 You can set the fill pattern for an entire section by using
5740 @samp{=@var{fillexp}}. @var{fillexp} is an expression
5741 (@pxref{Expressions}). Any otherwise unspecified regions of memory
5742 within the output section (for example, gaps left due to the required
5743 alignment of input sections) will be filled with the value, repeated as
5744 necessary. If the fill expression is a simple hex number, ie. a string
5745 of hex digit starting with @samp{0x} and without a trailing @samp{k} or @samp{M}, then
5746 an arbitrarily long sequence of hex digits can be used to specify the
5747 fill pattern; Leading zeros become part of the pattern too. For all
5748 other cases, including extra parentheses or a unary @code{+}, the fill
5749 pattern is the four least significant bytes of the value of the
5750 expression. In all cases, the number is big-endian.
5751
5752 You can also change the fill value with a @code{FILL} command in the
5753 output section commands; (@pxref{Output Section Data}).
5754
5755 Here is a simple example:
5756 @smallexample
5757 @group
5758 SECTIONS @{ .text : @{ *(.text) @} =0x90909090 @}
5759 @end group
5760 @end smallexample
5761
5762 @node Overlay Description
5763 @subsection Overlay Description
5764 @kindex OVERLAY
5765 @cindex overlays
5766 An overlay description provides an easy way to describe sections which
5767 are to be loaded as part of a single memory image but are to be run at
5768 the same memory address. At run time, some sort of overlay manager will
5769 copy the overlaid sections in and out of the runtime memory address as
5770 required, perhaps by simply manipulating addressing bits. This approach
5771 can be useful, for example, when a certain region of memory is faster
5772 than another.
5773
5774 Overlays are described using the @code{OVERLAY} command. The
5775 @code{OVERLAY} command is used within a @code{SECTIONS} command, like an
5776 output section description. The full syntax of the @code{OVERLAY}
5777 command is as follows:
5778 @smallexample
5779 @group
5780 OVERLAY [@var{start}] : [NOCROSSREFS] [AT ( @var{ldaddr} )]
5781 @{
5782 @var{secname1}
5783 @{
5784 @var{output-section-command}
5785 @var{output-section-command}
5786 @dots{}
5787 @} [:@var{phdr}@dots{}] [=@var{fill}]
5788 @var{secname2}
5789 @{
5790 @var{output-section-command}
5791 @var{output-section-command}
5792 @dots{}
5793 @} [:@var{phdr}@dots{}] [=@var{fill}]
5794 @dots{}
5795 @} [>@var{region}] [:@var{phdr}@dots{}] [=@var{fill}] [,]
5796 @end group
5797 @end smallexample
5798
5799 Everything is optional except @code{OVERLAY} (a keyword), and each
5800 section must have a name (@var{secname1} and @var{secname2} above). The
5801 section definitions within the @code{OVERLAY} construct are identical to
5802 those within the general @code{SECTIONS} construct (@pxref{SECTIONS}),
5803 except that no addresses and no memory regions may be defined for
5804 sections within an @code{OVERLAY}.
5805
5806 The comma at the end may be required if a @var{fill} is used and
5807 the next @var{sections-command} looks like a continuation of the expression.
5808
5809 The sections are all defined with the same starting address. The load
5810 addresses of the sections are arranged such that they are consecutive in
5811 memory starting at the load address used for the @code{OVERLAY} as a
5812 whole (as with normal section definitions, the load address is optional,
5813 and defaults to the start address; the start address is also optional,
5814 and defaults to the current value of the location counter).
5815
5816 If the @code{NOCROSSREFS} keyword is used, and there are any
5817 references among the sections, the linker will report an error. Since
5818 the sections all run at the same address, it normally does not make
5819 sense for one section to refer directly to another.
5820 @xref{Miscellaneous Commands, NOCROSSREFS}.
5821
5822 For each section within the @code{OVERLAY}, the linker automatically
5823 provides two symbols. The symbol @code{__load_start_@var{secname}} is
5824 defined as the starting load address of the section. The symbol
5825 @code{__load_stop_@var{secname}} is defined as the final load address of
5826 the section. Any characters within @var{secname} which are not legal
5827 within C identifiers are removed. C (or assembler) code may use these
5828 symbols to move the overlaid sections around as necessary.
5829
5830 At the end of the overlay, the value of the location counter is set to
5831 the start address of the overlay plus the size of the largest section.
5832
5833 Here is an example. Remember that this would appear inside a
5834 @code{SECTIONS} construct.
5835 @smallexample
5836 @group
5837 OVERLAY 0x1000 : AT (0x4000)
5838 @{
5839 .text0 @{ o1/*.o(.text) @}
5840 .text1 @{ o2/*.o(.text) @}
5841 @}
5842 @end group
5843 @end smallexample
5844 @noindent
5845 This will define both @samp{.text0} and @samp{.text1} to start at
5846 address 0x1000. @samp{.text0} will be loaded at address 0x4000, and
5847 @samp{.text1} will be loaded immediately after @samp{.text0}. The
5848 following symbols will be defined if referenced: @code{__load_start_text0},
5849 @code{__load_stop_text0}, @code{__load_start_text1},
5850 @code{__load_stop_text1}.
5851
5852 C code to copy overlay @code{.text1} into the overlay area might look
5853 like the following.
5854
5855 @smallexample
5856 @group
5857 extern char __load_start_text1, __load_stop_text1;
5858 memcpy ((char *) 0x1000, &__load_start_text1,
5859 &__load_stop_text1 - &__load_start_text1);
5860 @end group
5861 @end smallexample
5862
5863 Note that the @code{OVERLAY} command is just syntactic sugar, since
5864 everything it does can be done using the more basic commands. The above
5865 example could have been written identically as follows.
5866
5867 @smallexample
5868 @group
5869 .text0 0x1000 : AT (0x4000) @{ o1/*.o(.text) @}
5870 PROVIDE (__load_start_text0 = LOADADDR (.text0));
5871 PROVIDE (__load_stop_text0 = LOADADDR (.text0) + SIZEOF (.text0));
5872 .text1 0x1000 : AT (0x4000 + SIZEOF (.text0)) @{ o2/*.o(.text) @}
5873 PROVIDE (__load_start_text1 = LOADADDR (.text1));
5874 PROVIDE (__load_stop_text1 = LOADADDR (.text1) + SIZEOF (.text1));
5875 . = 0x1000 + MAX (SIZEOF (.text0), SIZEOF (.text1));
5876 @end group
5877 @end smallexample
5878
5879 @node MEMORY
5880 @section MEMORY Command
5881 @kindex MEMORY
5882 @cindex memory regions
5883 @cindex regions of memory
5884 @cindex allocating memory
5885 @cindex discontinuous memory
5886 The linker's default configuration permits allocation of all available
5887 memory. You can override this by using the @code{MEMORY} command.
5888
5889 The @code{MEMORY} command describes the location and size of blocks of
5890 memory in the target. You can use it to describe which memory regions
5891 may be used by the linker, and which memory regions it must avoid. You
5892 can then assign sections to particular memory regions. The linker will
5893 set section addresses based on the memory regions, and will warn about
5894 regions that become too full. The linker will not shuffle sections
5895 around to fit into the available regions.
5896
5897 A linker script may contain many uses of the @code{MEMORY} command,
5898 however, all memory blocks defined are treated as if they were
5899 specified inside a single @code{MEMORY} command. The syntax for
5900 @code{MEMORY} is:
5901 @smallexample
5902 @group
5903 MEMORY
5904 @{
5905 @var{name} [(@var{attr})] : ORIGIN = @var{origin}, LENGTH = @var{len}
5906 @dots{}
5907 @}
5908 @end group
5909 @end smallexample
5910
5911 The @var{name} is a name used in the linker script to refer to the
5912 region. The region name has no meaning outside of the linker script.
5913 Region names are stored in a separate name space, and will not conflict
5914 with symbol names, file names, or section names. Each memory region
5915 must have a distinct name within the @code{MEMORY} command. However you can
5916 add later alias names to existing memory regions with the @ref{REGION_ALIAS}
5917 command.
5918
5919 @cindex memory region attributes
5920 The @var{attr} string is an optional list of attributes that specify
5921 whether to use a particular memory region for an input section which is
5922 not explicitly mapped in the linker script. As described in
5923 @ref{SECTIONS}, if you do not specify an output section for some input
5924 section, the linker will create an output section with the same name as
5925 the input section. If you define region attributes, the linker will use
5926 them to select the memory region for the output section that it creates.
5927
5928 The @var{attr} string must consist only of the following characters:
5929 @table @samp
5930 @item R
5931 Read-only section
5932 @item W
5933 Read/write section
5934 @item X
5935 Executable section
5936 @item A
5937 Allocatable section
5938 @item I
5939 Initialized section
5940 @item L
5941 Same as @samp{I}
5942 @item !
5943 Invert the sense of any of the attributes that follow
5944 @end table
5945
5946 If an unmapped section matches any of the listed attributes other than
5947 @samp{!}, it will be placed in the memory region. The @samp{!}
5948 attribute reverses the test for the characters that follow, so that an
5949 unmapped section will be placed in the memory region only if it does
5950 not match any of the attributes listed afterwards. Thus an attribute
5951 string of @samp{RW!X} will match any unmapped section that has either
5952 or both of the @samp{R} and @samp{W} attributes, but only as long as
5953 the section does not also have the @samp{X} attribute.
5954
5955 @kindex ORIGIN =
5956 @kindex o =
5957 @kindex org =
5958 The @var{origin} is an numerical expression for the start address of
5959 the memory region. The expression must evaluate to a constant and it
5960 cannot involve any symbols. The keyword @code{ORIGIN} may be
5961 abbreviated to @code{org} or @code{o} (but not, for example,
5962 @code{ORG}).
5963
5964 @kindex LENGTH =
5965 @kindex len =
5966 @kindex l =
5967 The @var{len} is an expression for the size in bytes of the memory
5968 region. As with the @var{origin} expression, the expression must
5969 be numerical only and must evaluate to a constant. The keyword
5970 @code{LENGTH} may be abbreviated to @code{len} or @code{l}.
5971
5972 In the following example, we specify that there are two memory regions
5973 available for allocation: one starting at @samp{0} for 256 kilobytes,
5974 and the other starting at @samp{0x40000000} for four megabytes. The
5975 linker will place into the @samp{rom} memory region every section which
5976 is not explicitly mapped into a memory region, and is either read-only
5977 or executable. The linker will place other sections which are not
5978 explicitly mapped into a memory region into the @samp{ram} memory
5979 region.
5980
5981 @smallexample
5982 @group
5983 MEMORY
5984 @{
5985 rom (rx) : ORIGIN = 0, LENGTH = 256K
5986 ram (!rx) : org = 0x40000000, l = 4M
5987 @}
5988 @end group
5989 @end smallexample
5990
5991 Once you define a memory region, you can direct the linker to place
5992 specific output sections into that memory region by using the
5993 @samp{>@var{region}} output section attribute. For example, if you have
5994 a memory region named @samp{mem}, you would use @samp{>mem} in the
5995 output section definition. @xref{Output Section Region}. If no address
5996 was specified for the output section, the linker will set the address to
5997 the next available address within the memory region. If the combined
5998 output sections directed to a memory region are too large for the
5999 region, the linker will issue an error message.
6000
6001 It is possible to access the origin and length of a memory in an
6002 expression via the @code{ORIGIN(@var{memory})} and
6003 @code{LENGTH(@var{memory})} functions:
6004
6005 @smallexample
6006 @group
6007 _fstack = ORIGIN(ram) + LENGTH(ram) - 4;
6008 @end group
6009 @end smallexample
6010
6011 @node PHDRS
6012 @section PHDRS Command
6013 @kindex PHDRS
6014 @cindex program headers
6015 @cindex ELF program headers
6016 @cindex program segments
6017 @cindex segments, ELF
6018 The ELF object file format uses @dfn{program headers}, also knows as
6019 @dfn{segments}. The program headers describe how the program should be
6020 loaded into memory. You can print them out by using the @code{objdump}
6021 program with the @samp{-p} option.
6022
6023 When you run an ELF program on a native ELF system, the system loader
6024 reads the program headers in order to figure out how to load the
6025 program. This will only work if the program headers are set correctly.
6026 This manual does not describe the details of how the system loader
6027 interprets program headers; for more information, see the ELF ABI.
6028
6029 The linker will create reasonable program headers by default. However,
6030 in some cases, you may need to specify the program headers more
6031 precisely. You may use the @code{PHDRS} command for this purpose. When
6032 the linker sees the @code{PHDRS} command in the linker script, it will
6033 not create any program headers other than the ones specified.
6034
6035 The linker only pays attention to the @code{PHDRS} command when
6036 generating an ELF output file. In other cases, the linker will simply
6037 ignore @code{PHDRS}.
6038
6039 This is the syntax of the @code{PHDRS} command. The words @code{PHDRS},
6040 @code{FILEHDR}, @code{AT}, and @code{FLAGS} are keywords.
6041
6042 @smallexample
6043 @group
6044 PHDRS
6045 @{
6046 @var{name} @var{type} [ FILEHDR ] [ PHDRS ] [ AT ( @var{address} ) ]
6047 [ FLAGS ( @var{flags} ) ] ;
6048 @}
6049 @end group
6050 @end smallexample
6051
6052 The @var{name} is used only for reference in the @code{SECTIONS} command
6053 of the linker script. It is not put into the output file. Program
6054 header names are stored in a separate name space, and will not conflict
6055 with symbol names, file names, or section names. Each program header
6056 must have a distinct name. The headers are processed in order and it
6057 is usual for them to map to sections in ascending load address order.
6058
6059 Certain program header types describe segments of memory which the
6060 system loader will load from the file. In the linker script, you
6061 specify the contents of these segments by placing allocatable output
6062 sections in the segments. You use the @samp{:@var{phdr}} output section
6063 attribute to place a section in a particular segment. @xref{Output
6064 Section Phdr}.
6065
6066 It is normal to put certain sections in more than one segment. This
6067 merely implies that one segment of memory contains another. You may
6068 repeat @samp{:@var{phdr}}, using it once for each segment which should
6069 contain the section.
6070
6071 If you place a section in one or more segments using @samp{:@var{phdr}},
6072 then the linker will place all subsequent allocatable sections which do
6073 not specify @samp{:@var{phdr}} in the same segments. This is for
6074 convenience, since generally a whole set of contiguous sections will be
6075 placed in a single segment. You can use @code{:NONE} to override the
6076 default segment and tell the linker to not put the section in any
6077 segment at all.
6078
6079 @kindex FILEHDR
6080 @kindex PHDRS
6081 You may use the @code{FILEHDR} and @code{PHDRS} keywords after
6082 the program header type to further describe the contents of the segment.
6083 The @code{FILEHDR} keyword means that the segment should include the ELF
6084 file header. The @code{PHDRS} keyword means that the segment should
6085 include the ELF program headers themselves. If applied to a loadable
6086 segment (@code{PT_LOAD}), all prior loadable segments must have one of
6087 these keywords.
6088
6089 The @var{type} may be one of the following. The numbers indicate the
6090 value of the keyword.
6091
6092 @table @asis
6093 @item @code{PT_NULL} (0)
6094 Indicates an unused program header.
6095
6096 @item @code{PT_LOAD} (1)
6097 Indicates that this program header describes a segment to be loaded from
6098 the file.
6099
6100 @item @code{PT_DYNAMIC} (2)
6101 Indicates a segment where dynamic linking information can be found.
6102
6103 @item @code{PT_INTERP} (3)
6104 Indicates a segment where the name of the program interpreter may be
6105 found.
6106
6107 @item @code{PT_NOTE} (4)
6108 Indicates a segment holding note information.
6109
6110 @item @code{PT_SHLIB} (5)
6111 A reserved program header type, defined but not specified by the ELF
6112 ABI.
6113
6114 @item @code{PT_PHDR} (6)
6115 Indicates a segment where the program headers may be found.
6116
6117 @item @code{PT_TLS} (7)
6118 Indicates a segment containing thread local storage.
6119
6120 @item @var{expression}
6121 An expression giving the numeric type of the program header. This may
6122 be used for types not defined above.
6123 @end table
6124
6125 You can specify that a segment should be loaded at a particular address
6126 in memory by using an @code{AT} expression. This is identical to the
6127 @code{AT} command used as an output section attribute (@pxref{Output
6128 Section LMA}). The @code{AT} command for a program header overrides the
6129 output section attribute.
6130
6131 The linker will normally set the segment flags based on the sections
6132 which comprise the segment. You may use the @code{FLAGS} keyword to
6133 explicitly specify the segment flags. The value of @var{flags} must be
6134 an integer. It is used to set the @code{p_flags} field of the program
6135 header.
6136
6137 Here is an example of @code{PHDRS}. This shows a typical set of program
6138 headers used on a native ELF system.
6139
6140 @example
6141 @group
6142 PHDRS
6143 @{
6144 headers PT_PHDR PHDRS ;
6145 interp PT_INTERP ;
6146 text PT_LOAD FILEHDR PHDRS ;
6147 data PT_LOAD ;
6148 dynamic PT_DYNAMIC ;
6149 @}
6150
6151 SECTIONS
6152 @{
6153 . = SIZEOF_HEADERS;
6154 .interp : @{ *(.interp) @} :text :interp
6155 .text : @{ *(.text) @} :text
6156 .rodata : @{ *(.rodata) @} /* defaults to :text */
6157 @dots{}
6158 . = . + 0x1000; /* move to a new page in memory */
6159 .data : @{ *(.data) @} :data
6160 .dynamic : @{ *(.dynamic) @} :data :dynamic
6161 @dots{}
6162 @}
6163 @end group
6164 @end example
6165
6166 @node VERSION
6167 @section VERSION Command
6168 @kindex VERSION @{script text@}
6169 @cindex symbol versions
6170 @cindex version script
6171 @cindex versions of symbols
6172 The linker supports symbol versions when using ELF. Symbol versions are
6173 only useful when using shared libraries. The dynamic linker can use
6174 symbol versions to select a specific version of a function when it runs
6175 a program that may have been linked against an earlier version of the
6176 shared library.
6177
6178 You can include a version script directly in the main linker script, or
6179 you can supply the version script as an implicit linker script. You can
6180 also use the @samp{--version-script} linker option.
6181
6182 The syntax of the @code{VERSION} command is simply
6183 @smallexample
6184 VERSION @{ version-script-commands @}
6185 @end smallexample
6186
6187 The format of the version script commands is identical to that used by
6188 Sun's linker in Solaris 2.5. The version script defines a tree of
6189 version nodes. You specify the node names and interdependencies in the
6190 version script. You can specify which symbols are bound to which
6191 version nodes, and you can reduce a specified set of symbols to local
6192 scope so that they are not globally visible outside of the shared
6193 library.
6194
6195 The easiest way to demonstrate the version script language is with a few
6196 examples.
6197
6198 @smallexample
6199 VERS_1.1 @{
6200 global:
6201 foo1;
6202 local:
6203 old*;
6204 original*;
6205 new*;
6206 @};
6207
6208 VERS_1.2 @{
6209 foo2;
6210 @} VERS_1.1;
6211
6212 VERS_2.0 @{
6213 bar1; bar2;
6214 extern "C++" @{
6215 ns::*;
6216 "f(int, double)";
6217 @};
6218 @} VERS_1.2;
6219 @end smallexample
6220
6221 This example version script defines three version nodes. The first
6222 version node defined is @samp{VERS_1.1}; it has no other dependencies.
6223 The script binds the symbol @samp{foo1} to @samp{VERS_1.1}. It reduces
6224 a number of symbols to local scope so that they are not visible outside
6225 of the shared library; this is done using wildcard patterns, so that any
6226 symbol whose name begins with @samp{old}, @samp{original}, or @samp{new}
6227 is matched. The wildcard patterns available are the same as those used
6228 in the shell when matching filenames (also known as ``globbing'').
6229 However, if you specify the symbol name inside double quotes, then the
6230 name is treated as literal, rather than as a glob pattern.
6231
6232 Next, the version script defines node @samp{VERS_1.2}. This node
6233 depends upon @samp{VERS_1.1}. The script binds the symbol @samp{foo2}
6234 to the version node @samp{VERS_1.2}.
6235
6236 Finally, the version script defines node @samp{VERS_2.0}. This node
6237 depends upon @samp{VERS_1.2}. The scripts binds the symbols @samp{bar1}
6238 and @samp{bar2} are bound to the version node @samp{VERS_2.0}.
6239
6240 When the linker finds a symbol defined in a library which is not
6241 specifically bound to a version node, it will effectively bind it to an
6242 unspecified base version of the library. You can bind all otherwise
6243 unspecified symbols to a given version node by using @samp{global: *;}
6244 somewhere in the version script. Note that it's slightly crazy to use
6245 wildcards in a global spec except on the last version node. Global
6246 wildcards elsewhere run the risk of accidentally adding symbols to the
6247 set exported for an old version. That's wrong since older versions
6248 ought to have a fixed set of symbols.
6249
6250 The names of the version nodes have no specific meaning other than what
6251 they might suggest to the person reading them. The @samp{2.0} version
6252 could just as well have appeared in between @samp{1.1} and @samp{1.2}.
6253 However, this would be a confusing way to write a version script.
6254
6255 Node name can be omitted, provided it is the only version node
6256 in the version script. Such version script doesn't assign any versions to
6257 symbols, only selects which symbols will be globally visible out and which
6258 won't.
6259
6260 @smallexample
6261 @{ global: foo; bar; local: *; @};
6262 @end smallexample
6263
6264 When you link an application against a shared library that has versioned
6265 symbols, the application itself knows which version of each symbol it
6266 requires, and it also knows which version nodes it needs from each
6267 shared library it is linked against. Thus at runtime, the dynamic
6268 loader can make a quick check to make sure that the libraries you have
6269 linked against do in fact supply all of the version nodes that the
6270 application will need to resolve all of the dynamic symbols. In this
6271 way it is possible for the dynamic linker to know with certainty that
6272 all external symbols that it needs will be resolvable without having to
6273 search for each symbol reference.
6274
6275 The symbol versioning is in effect a much more sophisticated way of
6276 doing minor version checking that SunOS does. The fundamental problem
6277 that is being addressed here is that typically references to external
6278 functions are bound on an as-needed basis, and are not all bound when
6279 the application starts up. If a shared library is out of date, a
6280 required interface may be missing; when the application tries to use
6281 that interface, it may suddenly and unexpectedly fail. With symbol
6282 versioning, the user will get a warning when they start their program if
6283 the libraries being used with the application are too old.
6284
6285 There are several GNU extensions to Sun's versioning approach. The
6286 first of these is the ability to bind a symbol to a version node in the
6287 source file where the symbol is defined instead of in the versioning
6288 script. This was done mainly to reduce the burden on the library
6289 maintainer. You can do this by putting something like:
6290 @smallexample
6291 __asm__(".symver original_foo,foo@@VERS_1.1");
6292 @end smallexample
6293 @noindent
6294 in the C source file. This renames the function @samp{original_foo} to
6295 be an alias for @samp{foo} bound to the version node @samp{VERS_1.1}.
6296 The @samp{local:} directive can be used to prevent the symbol
6297 @samp{original_foo} from being exported. A @samp{.symver} directive
6298 takes precedence over a version script.
6299
6300 The second GNU extension is to allow multiple versions of the same
6301 function to appear in a given shared library. In this way you can make
6302 an incompatible change to an interface without increasing the major
6303 version number of the shared library, while still allowing applications
6304 linked against the old interface to continue to function.
6305
6306 To do this, you must use multiple @samp{.symver} directives in the
6307 source file. Here is an example:
6308
6309 @smallexample
6310 __asm__(".symver original_foo,foo@@");
6311 __asm__(".symver old_foo,foo@@VERS_1.1");
6312 __asm__(".symver old_foo1,foo@@VERS_1.2");
6313 __asm__(".symver new_foo,foo@@@@VERS_2.0");
6314 @end smallexample
6315
6316 In this example, @samp{foo@@} represents the symbol @samp{foo} bound to the
6317 unspecified base version of the symbol. The source file that contains this
6318 example would define 4 C functions: @samp{original_foo}, @samp{old_foo},
6319 @samp{old_foo1}, and @samp{new_foo}.
6320
6321 When you have multiple definitions of a given symbol, there needs to be
6322 some way to specify a default version to which external references to
6323 this symbol will be bound. You can do this with the
6324 @samp{foo@@@@VERS_2.0} type of @samp{.symver} directive. You can only
6325 declare one version of a symbol as the default in this manner; otherwise
6326 you would effectively have multiple definitions of the same symbol.
6327
6328 If you wish to bind a reference to a specific version of the symbol
6329 within the shared library, you can use the aliases of convenience
6330 (i.e., @samp{old_foo}), or you can use the @samp{.symver} directive to
6331 specifically bind to an external version of the function in question.
6332
6333 You can also specify the language in the version script:
6334
6335 @smallexample
6336 VERSION extern "lang" @{ version-script-commands @}
6337 @end smallexample
6338
6339 The supported @samp{lang}s are @samp{C}, @samp{C++}, and @samp{Java}.
6340 The linker will iterate over the list of symbols at the link time and
6341 demangle them according to @samp{lang} before matching them to the
6342 patterns specified in @samp{version-script-commands}. The default
6343 @samp{lang} is @samp{C}.
6344
6345 Demangled names may contains spaces and other special characters. As
6346 described above, you can use a glob pattern to match demangled names,
6347 or you can use a double-quoted string to match the string exactly. In
6348 the latter case, be aware that minor differences (such as differing
6349 whitespace) between the version script and the demangler output will
6350 cause a mismatch. As the exact string generated by the demangler
6351 might change in the future, even if the mangled name does not, you
6352 should check that all of your version directives are behaving as you
6353 expect when you upgrade.
6354
6355 @node Expressions
6356 @section Expressions in Linker Scripts
6357 @cindex expressions
6358 @cindex arithmetic
6359 The syntax for expressions in the linker script language is identical to
6360 that of C expressions, except that whitespace is required in some
6361 places to resolve syntactic ambiguities. All expressions are
6362 evaluated as integers. All expressions are evaluated in the same
6363 size, which is 32 bits if both the host and target are 32 bits, and is
6364 otherwise 64 bits.
6365
6366 You can use and set symbol values in expressions.
6367
6368 The linker defines several special purpose builtin functions for use in
6369 expressions.
6370
6371 @menu
6372 * Constants:: Constants
6373 * Symbolic Constants:: Symbolic constants
6374 * Symbols:: Symbol Names
6375 * Orphan Sections:: Orphan Sections
6376 * Location Counter:: The Location Counter
6377 * Operators:: Operators
6378 * Evaluation:: Evaluation
6379 * Expression Section:: The Section of an Expression
6380 * Builtin Functions:: Builtin Functions
6381 @end menu
6382
6383 @node Constants
6384 @subsection Constants
6385 @cindex integer notation
6386 @cindex constants in linker scripts
6387 All constants are integers.
6388
6389 As in C, the linker considers an integer beginning with @samp{0} to be
6390 octal, and an integer beginning with @samp{0x} or @samp{0X} to be
6391 hexadecimal. Alternatively the linker accepts suffixes of @samp{h} or
6392 @samp{H} for hexadecimal, @samp{o} or @samp{O} for octal, @samp{b} or
6393 @samp{B} for binary and @samp{d} or @samp{D} for decimal. Any integer
6394 value without a prefix or a suffix is considered to be decimal.
6395
6396 @cindex scaled integers
6397 @cindex K and M integer suffixes
6398 @cindex M and K integer suffixes
6399 @cindex suffixes for integers
6400 @cindex integer suffixes
6401 In addition, you can use the suffixes @code{K} and @code{M} to scale a
6402 constant by
6403 @c TEXI2ROFF-KILL
6404 @ifnottex
6405 @c END TEXI2ROFF-KILL
6406 @code{1024} or @code{1024*1024}
6407 @c TEXI2ROFF-KILL
6408 @end ifnottex
6409 @tex
6410 ${\rm 1024}$ or ${\rm 1024}^2$
6411 @end tex
6412 @c END TEXI2ROFF-KILL
6413 respectively. For example, the following
6414 all refer to the same quantity:
6415
6416 @smallexample
6417 _fourk_1 = 4K;
6418 _fourk_2 = 4096;
6419 _fourk_3 = 0x1000;
6420 _fourk_4 = 10000o;
6421 @end smallexample
6422
6423 Note - the @code{K} and @code{M} suffixes cannot be used in
6424 conjunction with the base suffixes mentioned above.
6425
6426 @node Symbolic Constants
6427 @subsection Symbolic Constants
6428 @cindex symbolic constants
6429 @kindex CONSTANT
6430 It is possible to refer to target-specific constants via the use of
6431 the @code{CONSTANT(@var{name})} operator, where @var{name} is one of:
6432
6433 @table @code
6434 @item MAXPAGESIZE
6435 @kindex MAXPAGESIZE
6436 The target's maximum page size.
6437
6438 @item COMMONPAGESIZE
6439 @kindex COMMONPAGESIZE
6440 The target's default page size.
6441 @end table
6442
6443 So for example:
6444
6445 @smallexample
6446 .text ALIGN (CONSTANT (MAXPAGESIZE)) : @{ *(.text) @}
6447 @end smallexample
6448
6449 will create a text section aligned to the largest page boundary
6450 supported by the target.
6451
6452 @node Symbols
6453 @subsection Symbol Names
6454 @cindex symbol names
6455 @cindex names
6456 @cindex quoted symbol names
6457 @kindex "
6458 Unless quoted, symbol names start with a letter, underscore, or period
6459 and may include letters, digits, underscores, periods, and hyphens.
6460 Unquoted symbol names must not conflict with any keywords. You can
6461 specify a symbol which contains odd characters or has the same name as a
6462 keyword by surrounding the symbol name in double quotes:
6463 @smallexample
6464 "SECTION" = 9;
6465 "with a space" = "also with a space" + 10;
6466 @end smallexample
6467
6468 Since symbols can contain many non-alphabetic characters, it is safest
6469 to delimit symbols with spaces. For example, @samp{A-B} is one symbol,
6470 whereas @samp{A - B} is an expression involving subtraction.
6471
6472 @node Orphan Sections
6473 @subsection Orphan Sections
6474 @cindex orphan
6475 Orphan sections are sections present in the input files which
6476 are not explicitly placed into the output file by the linker
6477 script. The linker will still copy these sections into the
6478 output file by either finding, or creating a suitable output section
6479 in which to place the orphaned input section.
6480
6481 If the name of an orphaned input section exactly matches the name of
6482 an existing output section, then the orphaned input section will be
6483 placed at the end of that output section.
6484
6485 If there is no output section with a matching name then new output
6486 sections will be created. Each new output section will have the same
6487 name as the orphan section placed within it. If there are multiple
6488 orphan sections with the same name, these will all be combined into
6489 one new output section.
6490
6491 If new output sections are created to hold orphaned input sections,
6492 then the linker must decide where to place these new output sections
6493 in relation to existing output sections. On most modern targets, the
6494 linker attempts to place orphan sections after sections of the same
6495 attribute, such as code vs data, loadable vs non-loadable, etc. If no
6496 sections with matching attributes are found, or your target lacks this
6497 support, the orphan section is placed at the end of the file.
6498
6499 The command-line options @samp{--orphan-handling} and @samp{--unique}
6500 (@pxref{Options,,Command-line Options}) can be used to control which
6501 output sections an orphan is placed in.
6502
6503 @node Location Counter
6504 @subsection The Location Counter
6505 @kindex .
6506 @cindex dot
6507 @cindex location counter
6508 @cindex current output location
6509 The special linker variable @dfn{dot} @samp{.} always contains the
6510 current output location counter. Since the @code{.} always refers to a
6511 location in an output section, it may only appear in an expression
6512 within a @code{SECTIONS} command. The @code{.} symbol may appear
6513 anywhere that an ordinary symbol is allowed in an expression.
6514
6515 @cindex holes
6516 Assigning a value to @code{.} will cause the location counter to be
6517 moved. This may be used to create holes in the output section. The
6518 location counter may not be moved backwards inside an output section,
6519 and may not be moved backwards outside of an output section if so
6520 doing creates areas with overlapping LMAs.
6521
6522 @smallexample
6523 SECTIONS
6524 @{
6525 output :
6526 @{
6527 file1(.text)
6528 . = . + 1000;
6529 file2(.text)
6530 . += 1000;
6531 file3(.text)
6532 @} = 0x12345678;
6533 @}
6534 @end smallexample
6535 @noindent
6536 In the previous example, the @samp{.text} section from @file{file1} is
6537 located at the beginning of the output section @samp{output}. It is
6538 followed by a 1000 byte gap. Then the @samp{.text} section from
6539 @file{file2} appears, also with a 1000 byte gap following before the
6540 @samp{.text} section from @file{file3}. The notation @samp{= 0x12345678}
6541 specifies what data to write in the gaps (@pxref{Output Section Fill}).
6542
6543 @cindex dot inside sections
6544 Note: @code{.} actually refers to the byte offset from the start of the
6545 current containing object. Normally this is the @code{SECTIONS}
6546 statement, whose start address is 0, hence @code{.} can be used as an
6547 absolute address. If @code{.} is used inside a section description
6548 however, it refers to the byte offset from the start of that section,
6549 not an absolute address. Thus in a script like this:
6550
6551 @smallexample
6552 SECTIONS
6553 @{
6554 . = 0x100
6555 .text: @{
6556 *(.text)
6557 . = 0x200
6558 @}
6559 . = 0x500
6560 .data: @{
6561 *(.data)
6562 . += 0x600
6563 @}
6564 @}
6565 @end smallexample
6566
6567 The @samp{.text} section will be assigned a starting address of 0x100
6568 and a size of exactly 0x200 bytes, even if there is not enough data in
6569 the @samp{.text} input sections to fill this area. (If there is too
6570 much data, an error will be produced because this would be an attempt to
6571 move @code{.} backwards). The @samp{.data} section will start at 0x500
6572 and it will have an extra 0x600 bytes worth of space after the end of
6573 the values from the @samp{.data} input sections and before the end of
6574 the @samp{.data} output section itself.
6575
6576 @cindex dot outside sections
6577 Setting symbols to the value of the location counter outside of an
6578 output section statement can result in unexpected values if the linker
6579 needs to place orphan sections. For example, given the following:
6580
6581 @smallexample
6582 SECTIONS
6583 @{
6584 start_of_text = . ;
6585 .text: @{ *(.text) @}
6586 end_of_text = . ;
6587
6588 start_of_data = . ;
6589 .data: @{ *(.data) @}
6590 end_of_data = . ;
6591 @}
6592 @end smallexample
6593
6594 If the linker needs to place some input section, e.g. @code{.rodata},
6595 not mentioned in the script, it might choose to place that section
6596 between @code{.text} and @code{.data}. You might think the linker
6597 should place @code{.rodata} on the blank line in the above script, but
6598 blank lines are of no particular significance to the linker. As well,
6599 the linker doesn't associate the above symbol names with their
6600 sections. Instead, it assumes that all assignments or other
6601 statements belong to the previous output section, except for the
6602 special case of an assignment to @code{.}. I.e., the linker will
6603 place the orphan @code{.rodata} section as if the script was written
6604 as follows:
6605
6606 @smallexample
6607 SECTIONS
6608 @{
6609 start_of_text = . ;
6610 .text: @{ *(.text) @}
6611 end_of_text = . ;
6612
6613 start_of_data = . ;
6614 .rodata: @{ *(.rodata) @}
6615 .data: @{ *(.data) @}
6616 end_of_data = . ;
6617 @}
6618 @end smallexample
6619
6620 This may or may not be the script author's intention for the value of
6621 @code{start_of_data}. One way to influence the orphan section
6622 placement is to assign the location counter to itself, as the linker
6623 assumes that an assignment to @code{.} is setting the start address of
6624 a following output section and thus should be grouped with that
6625 section. So you could write:
6626
6627 @smallexample
6628 SECTIONS
6629 @{
6630 start_of_text = . ;
6631 .text: @{ *(.text) @}
6632 end_of_text = . ;
6633
6634 . = . ;
6635 start_of_data = . ;
6636 .data: @{ *(.data) @}
6637 end_of_data = . ;
6638 @}
6639 @end smallexample
6640
6641 Now, the orphan @code{.rodata} section will be placed between
6642 @code{end_of_text} and @code{start_of_data}.
6643
6644 @need 2000
6645 @node Operators
6646 @subsection Operators
6647 @cindex operators for arithmetic
6648 @cindex arithmetic operators
6649 @cindex precedence in expressions
6650 The linker recognizes the standard C set of arithmetic operators, with
6651 the standard bindings and precedence levels:
6652 @c TEXI2ROFF-KILL
6653 @ifnottex
6654 @c END TEXI2ROFF-KILL
6655 @smallexample
6656 precedence associativity Operators Notes
6657 (highest)
6658 1 left ! - ~ (1)
6659 2 left * / %
6660 3 left + -
6661 4 left >> <<
6662 5 left == != > < <= >=
6663 6 left &
6664 7 left |
6665 8 left &&
6666 9 left ||
6667 10 right ? :
6668 11 right &= += -= *= /= (2)
6669 (lowest)
6670 @end smallexample
6671 Notes:
6672 (1) Prefix operators
6673 (2) @xref{Assignments}.
6674 @c TEXI2ROFF-KILL
6675 @end ifnottex
6676 @tex
6677 \vskip \baselineskip
6678 %"lispnarrowing" is the extra indent used generally for smallexample
6679 \hskip\lispnarrowing\vbox{\offinterlineskip
6680 \hrule
6681 \halign
6682 {\vrule#&\strut\hfil\ #\ \hfil&\vrule#&\strut\hfil\ #\ \hfil&\vrule#&\strut\hfil\ {\tt #}\ \hfil&\vrule#\cr
6683 height2pt&\omit&&\omit&&\omit&\cr
6684 &Precedence&& Associativity &&{\rm Operators}&\cr
6685 height2pt&\omit&&\omit&&\omit&\cr
6686 \noalign{\hrule}
6687 height2pt&\omit&&\omit&&\omit&\cr
6688 &highest&&&&&\cr
6689 % '176 is tilde, '~' in tt font
6690 &1&&left&&\qquad- \char'176\ !\qquad\dag&\cr
6691 &2&&left&&* / \%&\cr
6692 &3&&left&&+ -&\cr
6693 &4&&left&&>> <<&\cr
6694 &5&&left&&== != > < <= >=&\cr
6695 &6&&left&&\&&\cr
6696 &7&&left&&|&\cr
6697 &8&&left&&{\&\&}&\cr
6698 &9&&left&&||&\cr
6699 &10&&right&&? :&\cr
6700 &11&&right&&\qquad\&= += -= *= /=\qquad\ddag&\cr
6701 &lowest&&&&&\cr
6702 height2pt&\omit&&\omit&&\omit&\cr}
6703 \hrule}
6704 @end tex
6705 @iftex
6706 {
6707 @obeylines@parskip=0pt@parindent=0pt
6708 @dag@quad Prefix operators.
6709 @ddag@quad @xref{Assignments}.
6710 }
6711 @end iftex
6712 @c END TEXI2ROFF-KILL
6713
6714 @node Evaluation
6715 @subsection Evaluation
6716 @cindex lazy evaluation
6717 @cindex expression evaluation order
6718 The linker evaluates expressions lazily. It only computes the value of
6719 an expression when absolutely necessary.
6720
6721 The linker needs some information, such as the value of the start
6722 address of the first section, and the origins and lengths of memory
6723 regions, in order to do any linking at all. These values are computed
6724 as soon as possible when the linker reads in the linker script.
6725
6726 However, other values (such as symbol values) are not known or needed
6727 until after storage allocation. Such values are evaluated later, when
6728 other information (such as the sizes of output sections) is available
6729 for use in the symbol assignment expression.
6730
6731 The sizes of sections cannot be known until after allocation, so
6732 assignments dependent upon these are not performed until after
6733 allocation.
6734
6735 Some expressions, such as those depending upon the location counter
6736 @samp{.}, must be evaluated during section allocation.
6737
6738 If the result of an expression is required, but the value is not
6739 available, then an error results. For example, a script like the
6740 following
6741 @smallexample
6742 @group
6743 SECTIONS
6744 @{
6745 .text 9+this_isnt_constant :
6746 @{ *(.text) @}
6747 @}
6748 @end group
6749 @end smallexample
6750 @noindent
6751 will cause the error message @samp{non constant expression for initial
6752 address}.
6753
6754 @node Expression Section
6755 @subsection The Section of an Expression
6756 @cindex expression sections
6757 @cindex absolute expressions
6758 @cindex relative expressions
6759 @cindex absolute and relocatable symbols
6760 @cindex relocatable and absolute symbols
6761 @cindex symbols, relocatable and absolute
6762 Addresses and symbols may be section relative, or absolute. A section
6763 relative symbol is relocatable. If you request relocatable output
6764 using the @samp{-r} option, a further link operation may change the
6765 value of a section relative symbol. On the other hand, an absolute
6766 symbol will retain the same value throughout any further link
6767 operations.
6768
6769 Some terms in linker expressions are addresses. This is true of
6770 section relative symbols and for builtin functions that return an
6771 address, such as @code{ADDR}, @code{LOADADDR}, @code{ORIGIN} and
6772 @code{SEGMENT_START}. Other terms are simply numbers, or are builtin
6773 functions that return a non-address value, such as @code{LENGTH}.
6774 One complication is that unless you set @code{LD_FEATURE ("SANE_EXPR")}
6775 (@pxref{Miscellaneous Commands}), numbers and absolute symbols are treated
6776 differently depending on their location, for compatibility with older
6777 versions of @code{ld}. Expressions appearing outside an output
6778 section definition treat all numbers as absolute addresses.
6779 Expressions appearing inside an output section definition treat
6780 absolute symbols as numbers. If @code{LD_FEATURE ("SANE_EXPR")} is
6781 given, then absolute symbols and numbers are simply treated as numbers
6782 everywhere.
6783
6784 In the following simple example,
6785
6786 @smallexample
6787 @group
6788 SECTIONS
6789 @{
6790 . = 0x100;
6791 __executable_start = 0x100;
6792 .data :
6793 @{
6794 . = 0x10;
6795 __data_start = 0x10;
6796 *(.data)
6797 @}
6798 @dots{}
6799 @}
6800 @end group
6801 @end smallexample
6802
6803 both @code{.} and @code{__executable_start} are set to the absolute
6804 address 0x100 in the first two assignments, then both @code{.} and
6805 @code{__data_start} are set to 0x10 relative to the @code{.data}
6806 section in the second two assignments.
6807
6808 For expressions involving numbers, relative addresses and absolute
6809 addresses, ld follows these rules to evaluate terms:
6810
6811 @itemize @bullet
6812 @item
6813 Unary operations on an absolute address or number, and binary
6814 operations on two absolute addresses or two numbers, or between one
6815 absolute address and a number, apply the operator to the value(s).
6816 @item
6817 Unary operations on a relative address, and binary operations on two
6818 relative addresses in the same section or between one relative address
6819 and a number, apply the operator to the offset part of the address(es).
6820 @item
6821 Other binary operations, that is, between two relative addresses not
6822 in the same section, or between a relative address and an absolute
6823 address, first convert any non-absolute term to an absolute address
6824 before applying the operator.
6825 @end itemize
6826
6827 The result section of each sub-expression is as follows:
6828
6829 @itemize @bullet
6830 @item
6831 An operation involving only numbers results in a number.
6832 @item
6833 The result of comparisons, @samp{&&} and @samp{||} is also a number.
6834 @item
6835 The result of other binary arithmetic and logical operations on two
6836 relative addresses in the same section or two absolute addresses
6837 (after above conversions) is also a number when
6838 @code{LD_FEATURE ("SANE_EXPR")} or inside an output section definition
6839 but an absolute address otherwise.
6840 @item
6841 The result of other operations on relative addresses or one
6842 relative address and a number, is a relative address in the same
6843 section as the relative operand(s).
6844 @item
6845 The result of other operations on absolute addresses (after above
6846 conversions) is an absolute address.
6847 @end itemize
6848
6849 You can use the builtin function @code{ABSOLUTE} to force an expression
6850 to be absolute when it would otherwise be relative. For example, to
6851 create an absolute symbol set to the address of the end of the output
6852 section @samp{.data}:
6853 @smallexample
6854 SECTIONS
6855 @{
6856 .data : @{ *(.data) _edata = ABSOLUTE(.); @}
6857 @}
6858 @end smallexample
6859 @noindent
6860 If @samp{ABSOLUTE} were not used, @samp{_edata} would be relative to the
6861 @samp{.data} section.
6862
6863 Using @code{LOADADDR} also forces an expression absolute, since this
6864 particular builtin function returns an absolute address.
6865
6866 @node Builtin Functions
6867 @subsection Builtin Functions
6868 @cindex functions in expressions
6869 The linker script language includes a number of builtin functions for
6870 use in linker script expressions.
6871
6872 @table @code
6873 @item ABSOLUTE(@var{exp})
6874 @kindex ABSOLUTE(@var{exp})
6875 @cindex expression, absolute
6876 Return the absolute (non-relocatable, as opposed to non-negative) value
6877 of the expression @var{exp}. Primarily useful to assign an absolute
6878 value to a symbol within a section definition, where symbol values are
6879 normally section relative. @xref{Expression Section}.
6880
6881 @item ADDR(@var{section})
6882 @kindex ADDR(@var{section})
6883 @cindex section address in expression
6884 Return the address (VMA) of the named @var{section}. Your
6885 script must previously have defined the location of that section. In
6886 the following example, @code{start_of_output_1}, @code{symbol_1} and
6887 @code{symbol_2} are assigned equivalent values, except that
6888 @code{symbol_1} will be relative to the @code{.output1} section while
6889 the other two will be absolute:
6890 @smallexample
6891 @group
6892 SECTIONS @{ @dots{}
6893 .output1 :
6894 @{
6895 start_of_output_1 = ABSOLUTE(.);
6896 @dots{}
6897 @}
6898 .output :
6899 @{
6900 symbol_1 = ADDR(.output1);
6901 symbol_2 = start_of_output_1;
6902 @}
6903 @dots{} @}
6904 @end group
6905 @end smallexample
6906
6907 @item ALIGN(@var{align})
6908 @itemx ALIGN(@var{exp},@var{align})
6909 @kindex ALIGN(@var{align})
6910 @kindex ALIGN(@var{exp},@var{align})
6911 @cindex round up location counter
6912 @cindex align location counter
6913 @cindex round up expression
6914 @cindex align expression
6915 Return the location counter (@code{.}) or arbitrary expression aligned
6916 to the next @var{align} boundary. The single operand @code{ALIGN}
6917 doesn't change the value of the location counter---it just does
6918 arithmetic on it. The two operand @code{ALIGN} allows an arbitrary
6919 expression to be aligned upwards (@code{ALIGN(@var{align})} is
6920 equivalent to @code{ALIGN(ABSOLUTE(.), @var{align})}).
6921
6922 Here is an example which aligns the output @code{.data} section to the
6923 next @code{0x2000} byte boundary after the preceding section and sets a
6924 variable within the section to the next @code{0x8000} boundary after the
6925 input sections:
6926 @smallexample
6927 @group
6928 SECTIONS @{ @dots{}
6929 .data ALIGN(0x2000): @{
6930 *(.data)
6931 variable = ALIGN(0x8000);
6932 @}
6933 @dots{} @}
6934 @end group
6935 @end smallexample
6936 @noindent
6937 The first use of @code{ALIGN} in this example specifies the location of
6938 a section because it is used as the optional @var{address} attribute of
6939 a section definition (@pxref{Output Section Address}). The second use
6940 of @code{ALIGN} is used to defines the value of a symbol.
6941
6942 The builtin function @code{NEXT} is closely related to @code{ALIGN}.
6943
6944 @item ALIGNOF(@var{section})
6945 @kindex ALIGNOF(@var{section})
6946 @cindex section alignment
6947 Return the alignment in bytes of the named @var{section}, if that section has
6948 been allocated. If the section has not been allocated when this is
6949 evaluated, the linker will report an error. In the following example,
6950 the alignment of the @code{.output} section is stored as the first
6951 value in that section.
6952 @smallexample
6953 @group
6954 SECTIONS@{ @dots{}
6955 .output @{
6956 LONG (ALIGNOF (.output))
6957 @dots{}
6958 @}
6959 @dots{} @}
6960 @end group
6961 @end smallexample
6962
6963 @item BLOCK(@var{exp})
6964 @kindex BLOCK(@var{exp})
6965 This is a synonym for @code{ALIGN}, for compatibility with older linker
6966 scripts. It is most often seen when setting the address of an output
6967 section.
6968
6969 @item DATA_SEGMENT_ALIGN(@var{maxpagesize}, @var{commonpagesize})
6970 @kindex DATA_SEGMENT_ALIGN(@var{maxpagesize}, @var{commonpagesize})
6971 This is equivalent to either
6972 @smallexample
6973 (ALIGN(@var{maxpagesize}) + (. & (@var{maxpagesize} - 1)))
6974 @end smallexample
6975 or
6976 @smallexample
6977 (ALIGN(@var{maxpagesize})
6978 + ((. + @var{commonpagesize} - 1) & (@var{maxpagesize} - @var{commonpagesize})))
6979 @end smallexample
6980 @noindent
6981 depending on whether the latter uses fewer @var{commonpagesize} sized pages
6982 for the data segment (area between the result of this expression and
6983 @code{DATA_SEGMENT_END}) than the former or not.
6984 If the latter form is used, it means @var{commonpagesize} bytes of runtime
6985 memory will be saved at the expense of up to @var{commonpagesize} wasted
6986 bytes in the on-disk file.
6987
6988 This expression can only be used directly in @code{SECTIONS} commands, not in
6989 any output section descriptions and only once in the linker script.
6990 @var{commonpagesize} should be less or equal to @var{maxpagesize} and should
6991 be the system page size the object wants to be optimized for while still
6992 running on system page sizes up to @var{maxpagesize}. Note however
6993 that @samp{-z relro} protection will not be effective if the system
6994 page size is larger than @var{commonpagesize}.
6995
6996 @noindent
6997 Example:
6998 @smallexample
6999 . = DATA_SEGMENT_ALIGN(0x10000, 0x2000);
7000 @end smallexample
7001
7002 @item DATA_SEGMENT_END(@var{exp})
7003 @kindex DATA_SEGMENT_END(@var{exp})
7004 This defines the end of data segment for @code{DATA_SEGMENT_ALIGN}
7005 evaluation purposes.
7006
7007 @smallexample
7008 . = DATA_SEGMENT_END(.);
7009 @end smallexample
7010
7011 @item DATA_SEGMENT_RELRO_END(@var{offset}, @var{exp})
7012 @kindex DATA_SEGMENT_RELRO_END(@var{offset}, @var{exp})
7013 This defines the end of the @code{PT_GNU_RELRO} segment when
7014 @samp{-z relro} option is used.
7015 When @samp{-z relro} option is not present, @code{DATA_SEGMENT_RELRO_END}
7016 does nothing, otherwise @code{DATA_SEGMENT_ALIGN} is padded so that
7017 @var{exp} + @var{offset} is aligned to the @var{commonpagesize}
7018 argument given to @code{DATA_SEGMENT_ALIGN}. If present in the linker
7019 script, it must be placed between @code{DATA_SEGMENT_ALIGN} and
7020 @code{DATA_SEGMENT_END}. Evaluates to the second argument plus any
7021 padding needed at the end of the @code{PT_GNU_RELRO} segment due to
7022 section alignment.
7023
7024 @smallexample
7025 . = DATA_SEGMENT_RELRO_END(24, .);
7026 @end smallexample
7027
7028 @item DEFINED(@var{symbol})
7029 @kindex DEFINED(@var{symbol})
7030 @cindex symbol defaults
7031 Return 1 if @var{symbol} is in the linker global symbol table and is
7032 defined before the statement using DEFINED in the script, otherwise
7033 return 0. You can use this function to provide
7034 default values for symbols. For example, the following script fragment
7035 shows how to set a global symbol @samp{begin} to the first location in
7036 the @samp{.text} section---but if a symbol called @samp{begin} already
7037 existed, its value is preserved:
7038
7039 @smallexample
7040 @group
7041 SECTIONS @{ @dots{}
7042 .text : @{
7043 begin = DEFINED(begin) ? begin : . ;
7044 @dots{}
7045 @}
7046 @dots{}
7047 @}
7048 @end group
7049 @end smallexample
7050
7051 @item LENGTH(@var{memory})
7052 @kindex LENGTH(@var{memory})
7053 Return the length of the memory region named @var{memory}.
7054
7055 @item LOADADDR(@var{section})
7056 @kindex LOADADDR(@var{section})
7057 @cindex section load address in expression
7058 Return the absolute LMA of the named @var{section}. (@pxref{Output
7059 Section LMA}).
7060
7061 @item LOG2CEIL(@var{exp})
7062 @kindex LOG2CEIL(@var{exp})
7063 Return the binary logarithm of @var{exp} rounded towards infinity.
7064 @code{LOG2CEIL(0)} returns 0.
7065
7066 @kindex MAX
7067 @item MAX(@var{exp1}, @var{exp2})
7068 Returns the maximum of @var{exp1} and @var{exp2}.
7069
7070 @kindex MIN
7071 @item MIN(@var{exp1}, @var{exp2})
7072 Returns the minimum of @var{exp1} and @var{exp2}.
7073
7074 @item NEXT(@var{exp})
7075 @kindex NEXT(@var{exp})
7076 @cindex unallocated address, next
7077 Return the next unallocated address that is a multiple of @var{exp}.
7078 This function is closely related to @code{ALIGN(@var{exp})}; unless you
7079 use the @code{MEMORY} command to define discontinuous memory for the
7080 output file, the two functions are equivalent.
7081
7082 @item ORIGIN(@var{memory})
7083 @kindex ORIGIN(@var{memory})
7084 Return the origin of the memory region named @var{memory}.
7085
7086 @item SEGMENT_START(@var{segment}, @var{default})
7087 @kindex SEGMENT_START(@var{segment}, @var{default})
7088 Return the base address of the named @var{segment}. If an explicit
7089 value has already been given for this segment (with a command-line
7090 @samp{-T} option) then that value will be returned otherwise the value
7091 will be @var{default}. At present, the @samp{-T} command-line option
7092 can only be used to set the base address for the ``text'', ``data'', and
7093 ``bss'' sections, but you can use @code{SEGMENT_START} with any segment
7094 name.
7095
7096 @item SIZEOF(@var{section})
7097 @kindex SIZEOF(@var{section})
7098 @cindex section size
7099 Return the size in bytes of the named @var{section}, if that section has
7100 been allocated. If the section has not been allocated when this is
7101 evaluated, the linker will report an error. In the following example,
7102 @code{symbol_1} and @code{symbol_2} are assigned identical values:
7103 @smallexample
7104 @group
7105 SECTIONS@{ @dots{}
7106 .output @{
7107 .start = . ;
7108 @dots{}
7109 .end = . ;
7110 @}
7111 symbol_1 = .end - .start ;
7112 symbol_2 = SIZEOF(.output);
7113 @dots{} @}
7114 @end group
7115 @end smallexample
7116
7117 @item SIZEOF_HEADERS
7118 @kindex SIZEOF_HEADERS
7119 @cindex header size
7120 Return the size in bytes of the output file's headers. This is
7121 information which appears at the start of the output file. You can use
7122 this number when setting the start address of the first section, if you
7123 choose, to facilitate paging.
7124
7125 @cindex not enough room for program headers
7126 @cindex program headers, not enough room
7127 When producing an ELF output file, if the linker script uses the
7128 @code{SIZEOF_HEADERS} builtin function, the linker must compute the
7129 number of program headers before it has determined all the section
7130 addresses and sizes. If the linker later discovers that it needs
7131 additional program headers, it will report an error @samp{not enough
7132 room for program headers}. To avoid this error, you must avoid using
7133 the @code{SIZEOF_HEADERS} function, or you must rework your linker
7134 script to avoid forcing the linker to use additional program headers, or
7135 you must define the program headers yourself using the @code{PHDRS}
7136 command (@pxref{PHDRS}).
7137 @end table
7138
7139 @node Implicit Linker Scripts
7140 @section Implicit Linker Scripts
7141 @cindex implicit linker scripts
7142 If you specify a linker input file which the linker can not recognize as
7143 an object file or an archive file, it will try to read the file as a
7144 linker script. If the file can not be parsed as a linker script, the
7145 linker will report an error.
7146
7147 An implicit linker script will not replace the default linker script.
7148
7149 Typically an implicit linker script would contain only symbol
7150 assignments, or the @code{INPUT}, @code{GROUP}, or @code{VERSION}
7151 commands.
7152
7153 Any input files read because of an implicit linker script will be read
7154 at the position in the command line where the implicit linker script was
7155 read. This can affect archive searching.
7156
7157 @node Plugins
7158 @chapter Linker Plugins
7159
7160 @cindex plugins
7161 @cindex linker plugins
7162 The linker can use dynamically loaded plugins to modify its behavior.
7163 For example, the link-time optimization feature that some compilers
7164 support is implemented with a linker plugin.
7165
7166 Currently there is only one plugin shipped by default, but more may
7167 be added here later.
7168
7169 @menu
7170 * libdep Plugin:: Static Library Dependencies Plugin
7171 @end menu
7172
7173 @node libdep Plugin
7174 @section Static Library Dependencies Plugin
7175 @cindex static library dependencies
7176 Originally, static libraries were contained in an archive file consisting
7177 just of a collection of relocatable object files. Later they evolved to
7178 optionally include a symbol table, to assist in finding the needed objects
7179 within a library. There their evolution ended, and dynamic libraries
7180 rose to ascendance.
7181
7182 One useful feature of dynamic libraries was that, more than just collecting
7183 multiple objects into a single file, they also included a list of their
7184 dependencies, such that one could specify just the name of a single dynamic
7185 library at link time, and all of its dependencies would be implicitly
7186 referenced as well. But static libraries lacked this feature, so if a
7187 link invocation was switched from using dynamic libraries to static
7188 libraries, the link command would usually fail unless it was rewritten to
7189 explicitly list the dependencies of the static library.
7190
7191 The GNU @command{ar} utility now supports a @option{--record-libdeps} option
7192 to embed dependency lists into static libraries as well, and the @file{libdep}
7193 plugin may be used to read this dependency information at link time. The
7194 dependency information is stored as a single string, carrying @option{-l}
7195 and @option{-L} arguments as they would normally appear in a linker
7196 command line. As such, the information can be written with any text
7197 utility and stored into any archive, even if GNU @command{ar} is not
7198 being used to create the archive. The information is stored in an
7199 archive member named @samp{__.LIBDEP}.
7200
7201 For example, given a library @file{libssl.a} that depends on another
7202 library @file{libcrypto.a} which may be found in @file{/usr/local/lib},
7203 the @samp{__.LIBDEP} member of @file{libssl.a} would contain
7204
7205 @smallexample
7206 -L/usr/local/lib -lcrypto
7207 @end smallexample
7208
7209 @ifset GENERIC
7210 @node Machine Dependent
7211 @chapter Machine Dependent Features
7212
7213 @cindex machine dependencies
7214 @command{ld} has additional features on some platforms; the following
7215 sections describe them. Machines where @command{ld} has no additional
7216 functionality are not listed.
7217
7218 @menu
7219 @ifset H8300
7220 * H8/300:: @command{ld} and the H8/300
7221 @end ifset
7222 @ifset M68HC11
7223 * M68HC11/68HC12:: @code{ld} and the Motorola 68HC11 and 68HC12 families
7224 @end ifset
7225 @ifset ARM
7226 * ARM:: @command{ld} and the ARM family
7227 @end ifset
7228 @ifset HPPA
7229 * HPPA ELF32:: @command{ld} and HPPA 32-bit ELF
7230 @end ifset
7231 @ifset M68K
7232 * M68K:: @command{ld} and the Motorola 68K family
7233 @end ifset
7234 @ifset MIPS
7235 * MIPS:: @command{ld} and the MIPS family
7236 @end ifset
7237 @ifset MMIX
7238 * MMIX:: @command{ld} and MMIX
7239 @end ifset
7240 @ifset MSP430
7241 * MSP430:: @command{ld} and MSP430
7242 @end ifset
7243 @ifset NDS32
7244 * NDS32:: @command{ld} and NDS32
7245 @end ifset
7246 @ifset NIOSII
7247 * Nios II:: @command{ld} and the Altera Nios II
7248 @end ifset
7249 @ifset POWERPC
7250 * PowerPC ELF32:: @command{ld} and PowerPC 32-bit ELF Support
7251 @end ifset
7252 @ifset POWERPC64
7253 * PowerPC64 ELF64:: @command{ld} and PowerPC64 64-bit ELF Support
7254 @end ifset
7255 @ifset S/390
7256 * S/390 ELF:: @command{ld} and S/390 ELF Support
7257 @end ifset
7258 @ifset SPU
7259 * SPU ELF:: @command{ld} and SPU ELF Support
7260 @end ifset
7261 @ifset TICOFF
7262 * TI COFF:: @command{ld} and TI COFF
7263 @end ifset
7264 @ifset WIN32
7265 * WIN32:: @command{ld} and WIN32 (cygwin/mingw)
7266 @end ifset
7267 @ifset XTENSA
7268 * Xtensa:: @command{ld} and Xtensa Processors
7269 @end ifset
7270 @end menu
7271 @end ifset
7272
7273 @ifset H8300
7274 @ifclear GENERIC
7275 @raisesections
7276 @end ifclear
7277
7278 @node H8/300
7279 @section @command{ld} and the H8/300
7280
7281 @cindex H8/300 support
7282 For the H8/300, @command{ld} can perform these global optimizations when
7283 you specify the @samp{--relax} command-line option.
7284
7285 @table @emph
7286 @cindex relaxing on H8/300
7287 @item relaxing address modes
7288 @command{ld} finds all @code{jsr} and @code{jmp} instructions whose
7289 targets are within eight bits, and turns them into eight-bit
7290 program-counter relative @code{bsr} and @code{bra} instructions,
7291 respectively.
7292
7293 @cindex synthesizing on H8/300
7294 @item synthesizing instructions
7295 @c FIXME: specifically mov.b, or any mov instructions really? -> mov.b only, at least on H8, H8H, H8S
7296 @command{ld} finds all @code{mov.b} instructions which use the
7297 sixteen-bit absolute address form, but refer to the top
7298 page of memory, and changes them to use the eight-bit address form.
7299 (That is: the linker turns @samp{mov.b @code{@@}@var{aa}:16} into
7300 @samp{mov.b @code{@@}@var{aa}:8} whenever the address @var{aa} is in the
7301 top page of memory).
7302
7303 @command{ld} finds all @code{mov} instructions which use the register
7304 indirect with 32-bit displacement addressing mode, but use a small
7305 displacement inside 16-bit displacement range, and changes them to use
7306 the 16-bit displacement form. (That is: the linker turns @samp{mov.b
7307 @code{@@}@var{d}:32,ERx} into @samp{mov.b @code{@@}@var{d}:16,ERx}
7308 whenever the displacement @var{d} is in the 16 bit signed integer
7309 range. Only implemented in ELF-format ld).
7310
7311 @item bit manipulation instructions
7312 @command{ld} finds all bit manipulation instructions like @code{band, bclr,
7313 biand, bild, bior, bist, bixor, bld, bnot, bor, bset, bst, btst, bxor}
7314 which use 32 bit and 16 bit absolute address form, but refer to the top
7315 page of memory, and changes them to use the 8 bit address form.
7316 (That is: the linker turns @samp{bset #xx:3,@code{@@}@var{aa}:32} into
7317 @samp{bset #xx:3,@code{@@}@var{aa}:8} whenever the address @var{aa} is in
7318 the top page of memory).
7319
7320 @item system control instructions
7321 @command{ld} finds all @code{ldc.w, stc.w} instructions which use the
7322 32 bit absolute address form, but refer to the top page of memory, and
7323 changes them to use 16 bit address form.
7324 (That is: the linker turns @samp{ldc.w @code{@@}@var{aa}:32,ccr} into
7325 @samp{ldc.w @code{@@}@var{aa}:16,ccr} whenever the address @var{aa} is in
7326 the top page of memory).
7327 @end table
7328
7329 @ifclear GENERIC
7330 @lowersections
7331 @end ifclear
7332 @end ifset
7333
7334 @ifclear GENERIC
7335 @ifset Renesas
7336 @c This stuff is pointless to say unless you're especially concerned
7337 @c with Renesas chips; don't enable it for generic case, please.
7338 @node Renesas
7339 @chapter @command{ld} and Other Renesas Chips
7340
7341 @command{ld} also supports the Renesas (formerly Hitachi) H8/300H,
7342 H8/500, and SH chips. No special features, commands, or command-line
7343 options are required for these chips.
7344 @end ifset
7345 @end ifclear
7346
7347 @ifset ARM
7348 @ifclear GENERIC
7349 @raisesections
7350 @end ifclear
7351
7352 @ifset M68HC11
7353 @ifclear GENERIC
7354 @raisesections
7355 @end ifclear
7356
7357 @node M68HC11/68HC12
7358 @section @command{ld} and the Motorola 68HC11 and 68HC12 families
7359
7360 @cindex M68HC11 and 68HC12 support
7361
7362 @subsection Linker Relaxation
7363
7364 For the Motorola 68HC11, @command{ld} can perform these global
7365 optimizations when you specify the @samp{--relax} command-line option.
7366
7367 @table @emph
7368 @cindex relaxing on M68HC11
7369 @item relaxing address modes
7370 @command{ld} finds all @code{jsr} and @code{jmp} instructions whose
7371 targets are within eight bits, and turns them into eight-bit
7372 program-counter relative @code{bsr} and @code{bra} instructions,
7373 respectively.
7374
7375 @command{ld} also looks at all 16-bit extended addressing modes and
7376 transforms them in a direct addressing mode when the address is in
7377 page 0 (between 0 and 0x0ff).
7378
7379 @item relaxing gcc instruction group
7380 When @command{gcc} is called with @option{-mrelax}, it can emit group
7381 of instructions that the linker can optimize to use a 68HC11 direct
7382 addressing mode. These instructions consists of @code{bclr} or
7383 @code{bset} instructions.
7384
7385 @end table
7386
7387 @subsection Trampoline Generation
7388
7389 @cindex trampoline generation on M68HC11
7390 @cindex trampoline generation on M68HC12
7391 For 68HC11 and 68HC12, @command{ld} can generate trampoline code to
7392 call a far function using a normal @code{jsr} instruction. The linker
7393 will also change the relocation to some far function to use the
7394 trampoline address instead of the function address. This is typically the
7395 case when a pointer to a function is taken. The pointer will in fact
7396 point to the function trampoline.
7397
7398 @ifclear GENERIC
7399 @lowersections
7400 @end ifclear
7401 @end ifset
7402
7403 @node ARM
7404 @section @command{ld} and the ARM family
7405
7406 @cindex ARM interworking support
7407 @kindex --support-old-code
7408 For the ARM, @command{ld} will generate code stubs to allow functions calls
7409 between ARM and Thumb code. These stubs only work with code that has
7410 been compiled and assembled with the @samp{-mthumb-interwork} command
7411 line option. If it is necessary to link with old ARM object files or
7412 libraries, which have not been compiled with the -mthumb-interwork
7413 option then the @samp{--support-old-code} command-line switch should be
7414 given to the linker. This will make it generate larger stub functions
7415 which will work with non-interworking aware ARM code. Note, however,
7416 the linker does not support generating stubs for function calls to
7417 non-interworking aware Thumb code.
7418
7419 @cindex thumb entry point
7420 @cindex entry point, thumb
7421 @kindex --thumb-entry=@var{entry}
7422 The @samp{--thumb-entry} switch is a duplicate of the generic
7423 @samp{--entry} switch, in that it sets the program's starting address.
7424 But it also sets the bottom bit of the address, so that it can be
7425 branched to using a BX instruction, and the program will start
7426 executing in Thumb mode straight away.
7427
7428 @cindex PE import table prefixing
7429 @kindex --use-nul-prefixed-import-tables
7430 The @samp{--use-nul-prefixed-import-tables} switch is specifying, that
7431 the import tables idata4 and idata5 have to be generated with a zero
7432 element prefix for import libraries. This is the old style to generate
7433 import tables. By default this option is turned off.
7434
7435 @cindex BE8
7436 @kindex --be8
7437 The @samp{--be8} switch instructs @command{ld} to generate BE8 format
7438 executables. This option is only valid when linking big-endian
7439 objects - ie ones which have been assembled with the @option{-EB}
7440 option. The resulting image will contain big-endian data and
7441 little-endian code.
7442
7443 @cindex TARGET1
7444 @kindex --target1-rel
7445 @kindex --target1-abs
7446 The @samp{R_ARM_TARGET1} relocation is typically used for entries in the
7447 @samp{.init_array} section. It is interpreted as either @samp{R_ARM_REL32}
7448 or @samp{R_ARM_ABS32}, depending on the target. The @samp{--target1-rel}
7449 and @samp{--target1-abs} switches override the default.
7450
7451 @cindex TARGET2
7452 @kindex --target2=@var{type}
7453 The @samp{--target2=type} switch overrides the default definition of the
7454 @samp{R_ARM_TARGET2} relocation. Valid values for @samp{type}, their
7455 meanings, and target defaults are as follows:
7456 @table @samp
7457 @item rel
7458 @samp{R_ARM_REL32} (arm*-*-elf, arm*-*-eabi)
7459 @item abs
7460 @samp{R_ARM_ABS32}
7461 @item got-rel
7462 @samp{R_ARM_GOT_PREL} (arm*-*-linux, arm*-*-*bsd)
7463 @end table
7464
7465 @cindex FIX_V4BX
7466 @kindex --fix-v4bx
7467 The @samp{R_ARM_V4BX} relocation (defined by the ARM AAELF
7468 specification) enables objects compiled for the ARMv4 architecture to be
7469 interworking-safe when linked with other objects compiled for ARMv4t, but
7470 also allows pure ARMv4 binaries to be built from the same ARMv4 objects.
7471
7472 In the latter case, the switch @option{--fix-v4bx} must be passed to the
7473 linker, which causes v4t @code{BX rM} instructions to be rewritten as
7474 @code{MOV PC,rM}, since v4 processors do not have a @code{BX} instruction.
7475
7476 In the former case, the switch should not be used, and @samp{R_ARM_V4BX}
7477 relocations are ignored.
7478
7479 @cindex FIX_V4BX_INTERWORKING
7480 @kindex --fix-v4bx-interworking
7481 Replace @code{BX rM} instructions identified by @samp{R_ARM_V4BX}
7482 relocations with a branch to the following veneer:
7483
7484 @smallexample
7485 TST rM, #1
7486 MOVEQ PC, rM
7487 BX Rn
7488 @end smallexample
7489
7490 This allows generation of libraries/applications that work on ARMv4 cores
7491 and are still interworking safe. Note that the above veneer clobbers the
7492 condition flags, so may cause incorrect program behavior in rare cases.
7493
7494 @cindex USE_BLX
7495 @kindex --use-blx
7496 The @samp{--use-blx} switch enables the linker to use ARM/Thumb
7497 BLX instructions (available on ARMv5t and above) in various
7498 situations. Currently it is used to perform calls via the PLT from Thumb
7499 code using BLX rather than using BX and a mode-switching stub before
7500 each PLT entry. This should lead to such calls executing slightly faster.
7501
7502 @cindex VFP11_DENORM_FIX
7503 @kindex --vfp11-denorm-fix
7504 The @samp{--vfp11-denorm-fix} switch enables a link-time workaround for a
7505 bug in certain VFP11 coprocessor hardware, which sometimes allows
7506 instructions with denorm operands (which must be handled by support code)
7507 to have those operands overwritten by subsequent instructions before
7508 the support code can read the intended values.
7509
7510 The bug may be avoided in scalar mode if you allow at least one
7511 intervening instruction between a VFP11 instruction which uses a register
7512 and another instruction which writes to the same register, or at least two
7513 intervening instructions if vector mode is in use. The bug only affects
7514 full-compliance floating-point mode: you do not need this workaround if
7515 you are using "runfast" mode. Please contact ARM for further details.
7516
7517 If you know you are using buggy VFP11 hardware, you can
7518 enable this workaround by specifying the linker option
7519 @samp{--vfp-denorm-fix=scalar} if you are using the VFP11 scalar
7520 mode only, or @samp{--vfp-denorm-fix=vector} if you are using
7521 vector mode (the latter also works for scalar code). The default is
7522 @samp{--vfp-denorm-fix=none}.
7523
7524 If the workaround is enabled, instructions are scanned for
7525 potentially-troublesome sequences, and a veneer is created for each
7526 such sequence which may trigger the erratum. The veneer consists of the
7527 first instruction of the sequence and a branch back to the subsequent
7528 instruction. The original instruction is then replaced with a branch to
7529 the veneer. The extra cycles required to call and return from the veneer
7530 are sufficient to avoid the erratum in both the scalar and vector cases.
7531
7532 @cindex ARM1176 erratum workaround
7533 @kindex --fix-arm1176
7534 @kindex --no-fix-arm1176
7535 The @samp{--fix-arm1176} switch enables a link-time workaround for an erratum
7536 in certain ARM1176 processors. The workaround is enabled by default if you
7537 are targeting ARM v6 (excluding ARM v6T2) or earlier. It can be disabled
7538 unconditionally by specifying @samp{--no-fix-arm1176}.
7539
7540 Further information is available in the ``ARM1176JZ-S and ARM1176JZF-S
7541 Programmer Advice Notice'' available on the ARM documentation website at:
7542 http://infocenter.arm.com/.
7543
7544 @cindex STM32L4xx erratum workaround
7545 @kindex --fix-stm32l4xx-629360
7546
7547 The @samp{--fix-stm32l4xx-629360} switch enables a link-time
7548 workaround for a bug in the bus matrix / memory controller for some of
7549 the STM32 Cortex-M4 based products (STM32L4xx). When accessing
7550 off-chip memory via the affected bus for bus reads of 9 words or more,
7551 the bus can generate corrupt data and/or abort. These are only
7552 core-initiated accesses (not DMA), and might affect any access:
7553 integer loads such as LDM, POP and floating-point loads such as VLDM,
7554 VPOP. Stores are not affected.
7555
7556 The bug can be avoided by splitting memory accesses into the
7557 necessary chunks to keep bus reads below 8 words.
7558
7559 The workaround is not enabled by default, this is equivalent to use
7560 @samp{--fix-stm32l4xx-629360=none}. If you know you are using buggy
7561 STM32L4xx hardware, you can enable the workaround by specifying the
7562 linker option @samp{--fix-stm32l4xx-629360}, or the equivalent
7563 @samp{--fix-stm32l4xx-629360=default}.
7564
7565 If the workaround is enabled, instructions are scanned for
7566 potentially-troublesome sequences, and a veneer is created for each
7567 such sequence which may trigger the erratum. The veneer consists in a
7568 replacement sequence emulating the behaviour of the original one and a
7569 branch back to the subsequent instruction. The original instruction is
7570 then replaced with a branch to the veneer.
7571
7572 The workaround does not always preserve the memory access order for
7573 the LDMDB instruction, when the instruction loads the PC.
7574
7575 The workaround is not able to handle problematic instructions when
7576 they are in the middle of an IT block, since a branch is not allowed
7577 there. In that case, the linker reports a warning and no replacement
7578 occurs.
7579
7580 The workaround is not able to replace problematic instructions with a
7581 PC-relative branch instruction if the @samp{.text} section is too
7582 large. In that case, when the branch that replaces the original code
7583 cannot be encoded, the linker reports a warning and no replacement
7584 occurs.
7585
7586 @cindex NO_ENUM_SIZE_WARNING
7587 @kindex --no-enum-size-warning
7588 The @option{--no-enum-size-warning} switch prevents the linker from
7589 warning when linking object files that specify incompatible EABI
7590 enumeration size attributes. For example, with this switch enabled,
7591 linking of an object file using 32-bit enumeration values with another
7592 using enumeration values fitted into the smallest possible space will
7593 not be diagnosed.
7594
7595 @cindex NO_WCHAR_SIZE_WARNING
7596 @kindex --no-wchar-size-warning
7597 The @option{--no-wchar-size-warning} switch prevents the linker from
7598 warning when linking object files that specify incompatible EABI
7599 @code{wchar_t} size attributes. For example, with this switch enabled,
7600 linking of an object file using 32-bit @code{wchar_t} values with another
7601 using 16-bit @code{wchar_t} values will not be diagnosed.
7602
7603 @cindex PIC_VENEER
7604 @kindex --pic-veneer
7605 The @samp{--pic-veneer} switch makes the linker use PIC sequences for
7606 ARM/Thumb interworking veneers, even if the rest of the binary
7607 is not PIC. This avoids problems on uClinux targets where
7608 @samp{--emit-relocs} is used to generate relocatable binaries.
7609
7610 @cindex STUB_GROUP_SIZE
7611 @kindex --stub-group-size=@var{N}
7612 The linker will automatically generate and insert small sequences of
7613 code into a linked ARM ELF executable whenever an attempt is made to
7614 perform a function call to a symbol that is too far away. The
7615 placement of these sequences of instructions - called stubs - is
7616 controlled by the command-line option @option{--stub-group-size=N}.
7617 The placement is important because a poor choice can create a need for
7618 duplicate stubs, increasing the code size. The linker will try to
7619 group stubs together in order to reduce interruptions to the flow of
7620 code, but it needs guidance as to how big these groups should be and
7621 where they should be placed.
7622
7623 The value of @samp{N}, the parameter to the
7624 @option{--stub-group-size=} option controls where the stub groups are
7625 placed. If it is negative then all stubs are placed after the first
7626 branch that needs them. If it is positive then the stubs can be
7627 placed either before or after the branches that need them. If the
7628 value of @samp{N} is 1 (either +1 or -1) then the linker will choose
7629 exactly where to place groups of stubs, using its built in heuristics.
7630 A value of @samp{N} greater than 1 (or smaller than -1) tells the
7631 linker that a single group of stubs can service at most @samp{N} bytes
7632 from the input sections.
7633
7634 The default, if @option{--stub-group-size=} is not specified, is
7635 @samp{N = +1}.
7636
7637 Farcalls stubs insertion is fully supported for the ARM-EABI target
7638 only, because it relies on object files properties not present
7639 otherwise.
7640
7641 @cindex Cortex-A8 erratum workaround
7642 @kindex --fix-cortex-a8
7643 @kindex --no-fix-cortex-a8
7644 The @samp{--fix-cortex-a8} switch enables a link-time workaround for an erratum in certain Cortex-A8 processors. The workaround is enabled by default if you are targeting the ARM v7-A architecture profile. It can be enabled otherwise by specifying @samp{--fix-cortex-a8}, or disabled unconditionally by specifying @samp{--no-fix-cortex-a8}.
7645
7646 The erratum only affects Thumb-2 code. Please contact ARM for further details.
7647
7648 @cindex Cortex-A53 erratum 835769 workaround
7649 @kindex --fix-cortex-a53-835769
7650 @kindex --no-fix-cortex-a53-835769
7651 The @samp{--fix-cortex-a53-835769} switch enables a link-time workaround for erratum 835769 present on certain early revisions of Cortex-A53 processors. The workaround is disabled by default. It can be enabled by specifying @samp{--fix-cortex-a53-835769}, or disabled unconditionally by specifying @samp{--no-fix-cortex-a53-835769}.
7652
7653 Please contact ARM for further details.
7654
7655 @kindex --merge-exidx-entries
7656 @kindex --no-merge-exidx-entries
7657 @cindex Merging exidx entries
7658 The @samp{--no-merge-exidx-entries} switch disables the merging of adjacent exidx entries in debuginfo.
7659
7660 @kindex --long-plt
7661 @cindex 32-bit PLT entries
7662 The @samp{--long-plt} option enables the use of 16 byte PLT entries
7663 which support up to 4Gb of code. The default is to use 12 byte PLT
7664 entries which only support 512Mb of code.
7665
7666 @kindex --no-apply-dynamic-relocs
7667 @cindex AArch64 rela addend
7668 The @samp{--no-apply-dynamic-relocs} option makes AArch64 linker do not apply
7669 link-time values for dynamic relocations.
7670
7671 @cindex Placement of SG veneers
7672 All SG veneers are placed in the special output section @code{.gnu.sgstubs}.
7673 Its start address must be set, either with the command-line option
7674 @samp{--section-start} or in a linker script, to indicate where to place these
7675 veneers in memory.
7676
7677 @kindex --cmse-implib
7678 @cindex Secure gateway import library
7679 The @samp{--cmse-implib} option requests that the import libraries
7680 specified by the @samp{--out-implib} and @samp{--in-implib} options are
7681 secure gateway import libraries, suitable for linking a non-secure
7682 executable against secure code as per ARMv8-M Security Extensions.
7683
7684 @kindex --in-implib=@var{file}
7685 @cindex Input import library
7686 The @samp{--in-implib=file} specifies an input import library whose symbols
7687 must keep the same address in the executable being produced. A warning is
7688 given if no @samp{--out-implib} is given but new symbols have been introduced
7689 in the executable that should be listed in its import library. Otherwise, if
7690 @samp{--out-implib} is specified, the symbols are added to the output import
7691 library. A warning is also given if some symbols present in the input import
7692 library have disappeared from the executable. This option is only effective
7693 for Secure Gateway import libraries, ie. when @samp{--cmse-implib} is
7694 specified.
7695
7696 @ifclear GENERIC
7697 @lowersections
7698 @end ifclear
7699 @end ifset
7700
7701 @ifset HPPA
7702 @ifclear GENERIC
7703 @raisesections
7704 @end ifclear
7705
7706 @node HPPA ELF32
7707 @section @command{ld} and HPPA 32-bit ELF Support
7708 @cindex HPPA multiple sub-space stubs
7709 @kindex --multi-subspace
7710 When generating a shared library, @command{ld} will by default generate
7711 import stubs suitable for use with a single sub-space application.
7712 The @samp{--multi-subspace} switch causes @command{ld} to generate export
7713 stubs, and different (larger) import stubs suitable for use with
7714 multiple sub-spaces.
7715
7716 @cindex HPPA stub grouping
7717 @kindex --stub-group-size=@var{N}
7718 Long branch stubs and import/export stubs are placed by @command{ld} in
7719 stub sections located between groups of input sections.
7720 @samp{--stub-group-size} specifies the maximum size of a group of input
7721 sections handled by one stub section. Since branch offsets are signed,
7722 a stub section may serve two groups of input sections, one group before
7723 the stub section, and one group after it. However, when using
7724 conditional branches that require stubs, it may be better (for branch
7725 prediction) that stub sections only serve one group of input sections.
7726 A negative value for @samp{N} chooses this scheme, ensuring that
7727 branches to stubs always use a negative offset. Two special values of
7728 @samp{N} are recognized, @samp{1} and @samp{-1}. These both instruct
7729 @command{ld} to automatically size input section groups for the branch types
7730 detected, with the same behaviour regarding stub placement as other
7731 positive or negative values of @samp{N} respectively.
7732
7733 Note that @samp{--stub-group-size} does not split input sections. A
7734 single input section larger than the group size specified will of course
7735 create a larger group (of one section). If input sections are too
7736 large, it may not be possible for a branch to reach its stub.
7737
7738 @ifclear GENERIC
7739 @lowersections
7740 @end ifclear
7741 @end ifset
7742
7743 @ifset M68K
7744 @ifclear GENERIC
7745 @raisesections
7746 @end ifclear
7747
7748 @node M68K
7749 @section @command{ld} and the Motorola 68K family
7750
7751 @cindex Motorola 68K GOT generation
7752 @kindex --got=@var{type}
7753 The @samp{--got=@var{type}} option lets you choose the GOT generation scheme.
7754 The choices are @samp{single}, @samp{negative}, @samp{multigot} and
7755 @samp{target}. When @samp{target} is selected the linker chooses
7756 the default GOT generation scheme for the current target.
7757 @samp{single} tells the linker to generate a single GOT with
7758 entries only at non-negative offsets.
7759 @samp{negative} instructs the linker to generate a single GOT with
7760 entries at both negative and positive offsets. Not all environments
7761 support such GOTs.
7762 @samp{multigot} allows the linker to generate several GOTs in the
7763 output file. All GOT references from a single input object
7764 file access the same GOT, but references from different input object
7765 files might access different GOTs. Not all environments support such GOTs.
7766
7767 @ifclear GENERIC
7768 @lowersections
7769 @end ifclear
7770 @end ifset
7771
7772 @ifset MIPS
7773 @ifclear GENERIC
7774 @raisesections
7775 @end ifclear
7776
7777 @node MIPS
7778 @section @command{ld} and the MIPS family
7779
7780 @cindex MIPS microMIPS instruction choice selection
7781 @kindex --insn32
7782 @kindex --no-insn32
7783 The @samp{--insn32} and @samp{--no-insn32} options control the choice of
7784 microMIPS instructions used in code generated by the linker, such as that
7785 in the PLT or lazy binding stubs, or in relaxation. If @samp{--insn32} is
7786 used, then the linker only uses 32-bit instruction encodings. By default
7787 or if @samp{--no-insn32} is used, all instruction encodings are used,
7788 including 16-bit ones where possible.
7789
7790 @cindex MIPS branch relocation check control
7791 @kindex --ignore-branch-isa
7792 @kindex --no-ignore-branch-isa
7793 The @samp{--ignore-branch-isa} and @samp{--no-ignore-branch-isa} options
7794 control branch relocation checks for invalid ISA mode transitions. If
7795 @samp{--ignore-branch-isa} is used, then the linker accepts any branch
7796 relocations and any ISA mode transition required is lost in relocation
7797 calculation, except for some cases of @code{BAL} instructions which meet
7798 relaxation conditions and are converted to equivalent @code{JALX}
7799 instructions as the associated relocation is calculated. By default
7800 or if @samp{--no-ignore-branch-isa} is used a check is made causing
7801 the loss of an ISA mode transition to produce an error.
7802
7803 @ifclear GENERIC
7804 @lowersections
7805 @end ifclear
7806 @end ifset
7807
7808 @ifset MMIX
7809 @ifclear GENERIC
7810 @raisesections
7811 @end ifclear
7812
7813 @node MMIX
7814 @section @code{ld} and MMIX
7815 For MMIX, there is a choice of generating @code{ELF} object files or
7816 @code{mmo} object files when linking. The simulator @code{mmix}
7817 understands the @code{mmo} format. The binutils @code{objcopy} utility
7818 can translate between the two formats.
7819
7820 There is one special section, the @samp{.MMIX.reg_contents} section.
7821 Contents in this section is assumed to correspond to that of global
7822 registers, and symbols referring to it are translated to special symbols,
7823 equal to registers. In a final link, the start address of the
7824 @samp{.MMIX.reg_contents} section corresponds to the first allocated
7825 global register multiplied by 8. Register @code{$255} is not included in
7826 this section; it is always set to the program entry, which is at the
7827 symbol @code{Main} for @code{mmo} files.
7828
7829 Global symbols with the prefix @code{__.MMIX.start.}, for example
7830 @code{__.MMIX.start..text} and @code{__.MMIX.start..data} are special.
7831 The default linker script uses these to set the default start address
7832 of a section.
7833
7834 Initial and trailing multiples of zero-valued 32-bit words in a section,
7835 are left out from an mmo file.
7836
7837 @ifclear GENERIC
7838 @lowersections
7839 @end ifclear
7840 @end ifset
7841
7842 @ifset MSP430
7843 @ifclear GENERIC
7844 @raisesections
7845 @end ifclear
7846
7847 @node MSP430
7848 @section @code{ld} and MSP430
7849 For the MSP430 it is possible to select the MPU architecture. The flag @samp{-m [mpu type]}
7850 will select an appropriate linker script for selected MPU type. (To get a list of known MPUs
7851 just pass @samp{-m help} option to the linker).
7852
7853 @cindex MSP430 extra sections
7854 The linker will recognize some extra sections which are MSP430 specific:
7855
7856 @table @code
7857 @item @samp{.vectors}
7858 Defines a portion of ROM where interrupt vectors located.
7859
7860 @item @samp{.bootloader}
7861 Defines the bootloader portion of the ROM (if applicable). Any code
7862 in this section will be uploaded to the MPU.
7863
7864 @item @samp{.infomem}
7865 Defines an information memory section (if applicable). Any code in
7866 this section will be uploaded to the MPU.
7867
7868 @item @samp{.infomemnobits}
7869 This is the same as the @samp{.infomem} section except that any code
7870 in this section will not be uploaded to the MPU.
7871
7872 @item @samp{.noinit}
7873 Denotes a portion of RAM located above @samp{.bss} section.
7874
7875 The last two sections are used by gcc.
7876 @end table
7877
7878 @table @option
7879 @cindex MSP430 Options
7880 @kindex --code-region
7881 @item --code-region=[either,lower,upper,none]
7882 This will transform .text* sections to [either,lower,upper].text* sections. The
7883 argument passed to GCC for -mcode-region is propagated to the linker
7884 using this option.
7885
7886 @kindex --data-region
7887 @item --data-region=[either,lower,upper,none]
7888 This will transform .data*, .bss* and .rodata* sections to
7889 [either,lower,upper].[data,bss,rodata]* sections. The argument passed to GCC
7890 for -mdata-region is propagated to the linker using this option.
7891
7892 @kindex --disable-sec-transformation
7893 @item --disable-sec-transformation
7894 Prevent the transformation of sections as specified by the @code{--code-region}
7895 and @code{--data-region} options.
7896 This is useful if you are compiling and linking using a single call to the GCC
7897 wrapper, and want to compile the source files using -m[code,data]-region but
7898 not transform the sections for prebuilt libraries and objects.
7899 @end table
7900
7901 @ifclear GENERIC
7902 @lowersections
7903 @end ifclear
7904 @end ifset
7905
7906 @ifset NDS32
7907 @ifclear GENERIC
7908 @raisesections
7909 @end ifclear
7910
7911 @node NDS32
7912 @section @code{ld} and NDS32
7913 @kindex relaxing on NDS32
7914 For NDS32, there are some options to select relaxation behavior. The linker
7915 relaxes objects according to these options.
7916
7917 @table @code
7918 @item @samp{--m[no-]fp-as-gp}
7919 Disable/enable fp-as-gp relaxation.
7920
7921 @item @samp{--mexport-symbols=FILE}
7922 Exporting symbols and their address into FILE as linker script.
7923
7924 @item @samp{--m[no-]ex9}
7925 Disable/enable link-time EX9 relaxation.
7926
7927 @item @samp{--mexport-ex9=FILE}
7928 Export the EX9 table after linking.
7929
7930 @item @samp{--mimport-ex9=FILE}
7931 Import the Ex9 table for EX9 relaxation.
7932
7933 @item @samp{--mupdate-ex9}
7934 Update the existing EX9 table.
7935
7936 @item @samp{--mex9-limit=NUM}
7937 Maximum number of entries in the ex9 table.
7938
7939 @item @samp{--mex9-loop-aware}
7940 Avoid generating the EX9 instruction inside the loop.
7941
7942 @item @samp{--m[no-]ifc}
7943 Disable/enable the link-time IFC optimization.
7944
7945 @item @samp{--mifc-loop-aware}
7946 Avoid generating the IFC instruction inside the loop.
7947 @end table
7948
7949 @ifclear GENERIC
7950 @lowersections
7951 @end ifclear
7952 @end ifset
7953
7954 @ifset NIOSII
7955 @ifclear GENERIC
7956 @raisesections
7957 @end ifclear
7958
7959 @node Nios II
7960 @section @command{ld} and the Altera Nios II
7961 @cindex Nios II call relaxation
7962 @kindex --relax on Nios II
7963
7964 Call and immediate jump instructions on Nios II processors are limited to
7965 transferring control to addresses in the same 256MB memory segment,
7966 which may result in @command{ld} giving
7967 @samp{relocation truncated to fit} errors with very large programs.
7968 The command-line option @option{--relax} enables the generation of
7969 trampolines that can access the entire 32-bit address space for calls
7970 outside the normal @code{call} and @code{jmpi} address range. These
7971 trampolines are inserted at section boundaries, so may not themselves
7972 be reachable if an input section and its associated call trampolines are
7973 larger than 256MB.
7974
7975 The @option{--relax} option is enabled by default unless @option{-r}
7976 is also specified. You can disable trampoline generation by using the
7977 @option{--no-relax} linker option. You can also disable this optimization
7978 locally by using the @samp{set .noat} directive in assembly-language
7979 source files, as the linker-inserted trampolines use the @code{at}
7980 register as a temporary.
7981
7982 Note that the linker @option{--relax} option is independent of assembler
7983 relaxation options, and that using the GNU assembler's @option{-relax-all}
7984 option interferes with the linker's more selective call instruction relaxation.
7985
7986 @ifclear GENERIC
7987 @lowersections
7988 @end ifclear
7989 @end ifset
7990
7991 @ifset POWERPC
7992 @ifclear GENERIC
7993 @raisesections
7994 @end ifclear
7995
7996 @node PowerPC ELF32
7997 @section @command{ld} and PowerPC 32-bit ELF Support
7998 @cindex PowerPC long branches
7999 @kindex --relax on PowerPC
8000 Branches on PowerPC processors are limited to a signed 26-bit
8001 displacement, which may result in @command{ld} giving
8002 @samp{relocation truncated to fit} errors with very large programs.
8003 @samp{--relax} enables the generation of trampolines that can access
8004 the entire 32-bit address space. These trampolines are inserted at
8005 section boundaries, so may not themselves be reachable if an input
8006 section exceeds 33M in size. You may combine @samp{-r} and
8007 @samp{--relax} to add trampolines in a partial link. In that case
8008 both branches to undefined symbols and inter-section branches are also
8009 considered potentially out of range, and trampolines inserted.
8010
8011 @cindex PowerPC ELF32 options
8012 @table @option
8013 @cindex PowerPC PLT
8014 @kindex --bss-plt
8015 @item --bss-plt
8016 Current PowerPC GCC accepts a @samp{-msecure-plt} option that
8017 generates code capable of using a newer PLT and GOT layout that has
8018 the security advantage of no executable section ever needing to be
8019 writable and no writable section ever being executable. PowerPC
8020 @command{ld} will generate this layout, including stubs to access the
8021 PLT, if all input files (including startup and static libraries) were
8022 compiled with @samp{-msecure-plt}. @samp{--bss-plt} forces the old
8023 BSS PLT (and GOT layout) which can give slightly better performance.
8024
8025 @kindex --secure-plt
8026 @item --secure-plt
8027 @command{ld} will use the new PLT and GOT layout if it is linking new
8028 @samp{-fpic} or @samp{-fPIC} code, but does not do so automatically
8029 when linking non-PIC code. This option requests the new PLT and GOT
8030 layout. A warning will be given if some object file requires the old
8031 style BSS PLT.
8032
8033 @cindex PowerPC GOT
8034 @kindex --sdata-got
8035 @item --sdata-got
8036 The new secure PLT and GOT are placed differently relative to other
8037 sections compared to older BSS PLT and GOT placement. The location of
8038 @code{.plt} must change because the new secure PLT is an initialized
8039 section while the old PLT is uninitialized. The reason for the
8040 @code{.got} change is more subtle: The new placement allows
8041 @code{.got} to be read-only in applications linked with
8042 @samp{-z relro -z now}. However, this placement means that
8043 @code{.sdata} cannot always be used in shared libraries, because the
8044 PowerPC ABI accesses @code{.sdata} in shared libraries from the GOT
8045 pointer. @samp{--sdata-got} forces the old GOT placement. PowerPC
8046 GCC doesn't use @code{.sdata} in shared libraries, so this option is
8047 really only useful for other compilers that may do so.
8048
8049 @cindex PowerPC stub symbols
8050 @kindex --emit-stub-syms
8051 @item --emit-stub-syms
8052 This option causes @command{ld} to label linker stubs with a local
8053 symbol that encodes the stub type and destination.
8054
8055 @cindex PowerPC TLS optimization
8056 @kindex --no-tls-optimize
8057 @item --no-tls-optimize
8058 PowerPC @command{ld} normally performs some optimization of code
8059 sequences used to access Thread-Local Storage. Use this option to
8060 disable the optimization.
8061 @end table
8062
8063 @ifclear GENERIC
8064 @lowersections
8065 @end ifclear
8066 @end ifset
8067
8068 @ifset POWERPC64
8069 @ifclear GENERIC
8070 @raisesections
8071 @end ifclear
8072
8073 @node PowerPC64 ELF64
8074 @section @command{ld} and PowerPC64 64-bit ELF Support
8075
8076 @cindex PowerPC64 ELF64 options
8077 @table @option
8078 @cindex PowerPC64 stub grouping
8079 @kindex --stub-group-size
8080 @item --stub-group-size
8081 Long branch stubs, PLT call stubs and TOC adjusting stubs are placed
8082 by @command{ld} in stub sections located between groups of input sections.
8083 @samp{--stub-group-size} specifies the maximum size of a group of input
8084 sections handled by one stub section. Since branch offsets are signed,
8085 a stub section may serve two groups of input sections, one group before
8086 the stub section, and one group after it. However, when using
8087 conditional branches that require stubs, it may be better (for branch
8088 prediction) that stub sections only serve one group of input sections.
8089 A negative value for @samp{N} chooses this scheme, ensuring that
8090 branches to stubs always use a negative offset. Two special values of
8091 @samp{N} are recognized, @samp{1} and @samp{-1}. These both instruct
8092 @command{ld} to automatically size input section groups for the branch types
8093 detected, with the same behaviour regarding stub placement as other
8094 positive or negative values of @samp{N} respectively.
8095
8096 Note that @samp{--stub-group-size} does not split input sections. A
8097 single input section larger than the group size specified will of course
8098 create a larger group (of one section). If input sections are too
8099 large, it may not be possible for a branch to reach its stub.
8100
8101 @cindex PowerPC64 stub symbols
8102 @kindex --emit-stub-syms
8103 @item --emit-stub-syms
8104 This option causes @command{ld} to label linker stubs with a local
8105 symbol that encodes the stub type and destination.
8106
8107 @cindex PowerPC64 dot symbols
8108 @kindex --dotsyms
8109 @kindex --no-dotsyms
8110 @item --dotsyms
8111 @itemx --no-dotsyms
8112 These two options control how @command{ld} interprets version patterns
8113 in a version script. Older PowerPC64 compilers emitted both a
8114 function descriptor symbol with the same name as the function, and a
8115 code entry symbol with the name prefixed by a dot (@samp{.}). To
8116 properly version a function @samp{foo}, the version script thus needs
8117 to control both @samp{foo} and @samp{.foo}. The option
8118 @samp{--dotsyms}, on by default, automatically adds the required
8119 dot-prefixed patterns. Use @samp{--no-dotsyms} to disable this
8120 feature.
8121
8122 @cindex PowerPC64 register save/restore functions
8123 @kindex --save-restore-funcs
8124 @kindex --no-save-restore-funcs
8125 @item --save-restore-funcs
8126 @itemx --no-save-restore-funcs
8127 These two options control whether PowerPC64 @command{ld} automatically
8128 provides out-of-line register save and restore functions used by
8129 @samp{-Os} code. The default is to provide any such referenced
8130 function for a normal final link, and to not do so for a relocatable
8131 link.
8132
8133 @cindex PowerPC64 TLS optimization
8134 @kindex --no-tls-optimize
8135 @item --no-tls-optimize
8136 PowerPC64 @command{ld} normally performs some optimization of code
8137 sequences used to access Thread-Local Storage. Use this option to
8138 disable the optimization.
8139
8140 @cindex PowerPC64 __tls_get_addr optimization
8141 @kindex --tls-get-addr-optimize
8142 @kindex --no-tls-get-addr-optimize
8143 @kindex --tls-get-addr-regsave
8144 @kindex --no-tls-get-addr-regsave
8145 @item --tls-get-addr-optimize
8146 @itemx --no-tls-get-addr-optimize
8147 These options control how PowerPC64 @command{ld} uses a special
8148 stub to call __tls_get_addr. PowerPC64 glibc 2.22 and later support
8149 an optimization that allows the second and subsequent calls to
8150 @code{__tls_get_addr} for a given symbol to be resolved by the special
8151 stub without calling in to glibc. By default the linker enables
8152 generation of the stub when glibc advertises the availability of
8153 __tls_get_addr_opt.
8154 Using @option{--tls-get-addr-optimize} with an older glibc won't do
8155 much besides slow down your applications, but may be useful if linking
8156 an application against an older glibc with the expectation that it
8157 will normally be used on systems having a newer glibc.
8158 @option{--tls-get-addr-regsave} forces generation of a stub that saves
8159 and restores volatile registers around the call into glibc. Normally,
8160 this is done when the linker detects a call to __tls_get_addr_desc.
8161 Such calls then go via the register saving stub to __tls_get_addr_opt.
8162 @option{--no-tls-get-addr-regsave} disables generation of the
8163 register saves.
8164
8165 @cindex PowerPC64 OPD optimization
8166 @kindex --no-opd-optimize
8167 @item --no-opd-optimize
8168 PowerPC64 @command{ld} normally removes @code{.opd} section entries
8169 corresponding to deleted link-once functions, or functions removed by
8170 the action of @samp{--gc-sections} or linker script @code{/DISCARD/}.
8171 Use this option to disable @code{.opd} optimization.
8172
8173 @cindex PowerPC64 OPD spacing
8174 @kindex --non-overlapping-opd
8175 @item --non-overlapping-opd
8176 Some PowerPC64 compilers have an option to generate compressed
8177 @code{.opd} entries spaced 16 bytes apart, overlapping the third word,
8178 the static chain pointer (unused in C) with the first word of the next
8179 entry. This option expands such entries to the full 24 bytes.
8180
8181 @cindex PowerPC64 TOC optimization
8182 @kindex --no-toc-optimize
8183 @item --no-toc-optimize
8184 PowerPC64 @command{ld} normally removes unused @code{.toc} section
8185 entries. Such entries are detected by examining relocations that
8186 reference the TOC in code sections. A reloc in a deleted code section
8187 marks a TOC word as unneeded, while a reloc in a kept code section
8188 marks a TOC word as needed. Since the TOC may reference itself, TOC
8189 relocs are also examined. TOC words marked as both needed and
8190 unneeded will of course be kept. TOC words without any referencing
8191 reloc are assumed to be part of a multi-word entry, and are kept or
8192 discarded as per the nearest marked preceding word. This works
8193 reliably for compiler generated code, but may be incorrect if assembly
8194 code is used to insert TOC entries. Use this option to disable the
8195 optimization.
8196
8197 @cindex PowerPC64 inline PLT call optimization
8198 @kindex --no-inline-optimize
8199 @item --no-inline-optimize
8200 PowerPC64 @command{ld} normally replaces inline PLT call sequences
8201 marked with @code{R_PPC64_PLTSEQ}, @code{R_PPC64_PLTCALL},
8202 @code{R_PPC64_PLT16_HA} and @code{R_PPC64_PLT16_LO_DS} relocations by
8203 a number of @code{nop}s and a direct call when the function is defined
8204 locally and can't be overridden by some other definition. This option
8205 disables that optimization.
8206
8207 @cindex PowerPC64 multi-TOC
8208 @kindex --no-multi-toc
8209 @item --no-multi-toc
8210 If given any toc option besides @code{-mcmodel=medium} or
8211 @code{-mcmodel=large}, PowerPC64 GCC generates code for a TOC model
8212 where TOC
8213 entries are accessed with a 16-bit offset from r2. This limits the
8214 total TOC size to 64K. PowerPC64 @command{ld} extends this limit by
8215 grouping code sections such that each group uses less than 64K for its
8216 TOC entries, then inserts r2 adjusting stubs between inter-group
8217 calls. @command{ld} does not split apart input sections, so cannot
8218 help if a single input file has a @code{.toc} section that exceeds
8219 64K, most likely from linking multiple files with @command{ld -r}.
8220 Use this option to turn off this feature.
8221
8222 @cindex PowerPC64 TOC sorting
8223 @kindex --no-toc-sort
8224 @item --no-toc-sort
8225 By default, @command{ld} sorts TOC sections so that those whose file
8226 happens to have a section called @code{.init} or @code{.fini} are
8227 placed first, followed by TOC sections referenced by code generated
8228 with PowerPC64 gcc's @code{-mcmodel=small}, and lastly TOC sections
8229 referenced only by code generated with PowerPC64 gcc's
8230 @code{-mcmodel=medium} or @code{-mcmodel=large} options. Doing this
8231 results in better TOC grouping for multi-TOC. Use this option to turn
8232 off this feature.
8233
8234 @cindex PowerPC64 PLT stub alignment
8235 @kindex --plt-align
8236 @kindex --no-plt-align
8237 @item --plt-align
8238 @itemx --no-plt-align
8239 Use these options to control whether individual PLT call stubs are
8240 aligned to a 32-byte boundary, or to the specified power of two
8241 boundary when using @code{--plt-align=}. A negative value may be
8242 specified to pad PLT call stubs so that they do not cross the
8243 specified power of two boundary (or the minimum number of boundaries
8244 if a PLT stub is so large that it must cross a boundary). By default
8245 PLT call stubs are aligned to 32-byte boundaries.
8246
8247 @cindex PowerPC64 PLT call stub static chain
8248 @kindex --plt-static-chain
8249 @kindex --no-plt-static-chain
8250 @item --plt-static-chain
8251 @itemx --no-plt-static-chain
8252 Use these options to control whether PLT call stubs load the static
8253 chain pointer (r11). @code{ld} defaults to not loading the static
8254 chain since there is never any need to do so on a PLT call.
8255
8256 @cindex PowerPC64 PLT call stub thread safety
8257 @kindex --plt-thread-safe
8258 @kindex --no-plt-thread-safe
8259 @item --plt-thread-safe
8260 @itemx --no-plt-thread-safe
8261 With power7's weakly ordered memory model, it is possible when using
8262 lazy binding for ld.so to update a plt entry in one thread and have
8263 another thread see the individual plt entry words update in the wrong
8264 order, despite ld.so carefully writing in the correct order and using
8265 memory write barriers. To avoid this we need some sort of read
8266 barrier in the call stub, or use LD_BIND_NOW=1. By default, @code{ld}
8267 looks for calls to commonly used functions that create threads, and if
8268 seen, adds the necessary barriers. Use these options to change the
8269 default behaviour.
8270
8271 @cindex PowerPC64 ELFv2 PLT localentry optimization
8272 @kindex --plt-localentry
8273 @kindex --no-plt-localentry
8274 @item --plt-localentry
8275 @itemx --no-localentry
8276 ELFv2 functions with localentry:0 are those with a single entry point,
8277 ie. global entry == local entry, and that have no requirement on r2
8278 (the TOC/GOT pointer) or r12, and guarantee r2 is unchanged on return.
8279 Such an external function can be called via the PLT without saving r2
8280 or restoring it on return, avoiding a common load-hit-store for small
8281 functions. The optimization is attractive, with up to 40% reduction
8282 in execution time for a small function, but can result in symbol
8283 interposition failures. Also, minor changes in a shared library,
8284 including system libraries, can cause a function that was localentry:0
8285 to become localentry:8. This will result in a dynamic loader
8286 complaint and failure to run. The option is experimental, use with
8287 care. @option{--no-plt-localentry} is the default.
8288
8289 @cindex PowerPC64 Power10 stubs
8290 @kindex --power10-stubs
8291 @kindex --no-power10-stubs
8292 @item --power10-stubs
8293 @itemx --no-power10-stubs
8294 When PowerPC64 @command{ld} links input object files containing
8295 relocations used on power10 prefixed instructions it normally creates
8296 linkage stubs (PLT call and long branch) using power10 instructions
8297 for @code{@@notoc} PLT calls where @code{r2} is not known. The
8298 power10 notoc stubs are smaller and faster, so are preferred for
8299 power10. @option{--power10-stubs} and @option{--no-power10-stubs}
8300 allow you to override the linker's selection of stub instructions.
8301 @option{--power10-stubs=auto} allows the user to select the default
8302 auto mode.
8303 @end table
8304
8305 @ifclear GENERIC
8306 @lowersections
8307 @end ifclear
8308 @end ifset
8309
8310 @ifset S/390
8311 @ifclear GENERIC
8312 @raisesections
8313 @end ifclear
8314
8315 @node S/390 ELF
8316 @section @command{ld} and S/390 ELF Support
8317
8318 @cindex S/390 ELF options
8319 @table @option
8320
8321 @cindex S/390
8322 @kindex --s390-pgste
8323 @item --s390-pgste
8324 This option marks the result file with a @code{PT_S390_PGSTE}
8325 segment. The Linux kernel is supposed to allocate 4k page tables for
8326 binaries marked that way.
8327 @end table
8328
8329 @ifclear GENERIC
8330 @lowersections
8331 @end ifclear
8332 @end ifset
8333
8334 @ifset SPU
8335 @ifclear GENERIC
8336 @raisesections
8337 @end ifclear
8338
8339 @node SPU ELF
8340 @section @command{ld} and SPU ELF Support
8341
8342 @cindex SPU ELF options
8343 @table @option
8344
8345 @cindex SPU plugins
8346 @kindex --plugin
8347 @item --plugin
8348 This option marks an executable as a PIC plugin module.
8349
8350 @cindex SPU overlays
8351 @kindex --no-overlays
8352 @item --no-overlays
8353 Normally, @command{ld} recognizes calls to functions within overlay
8354 regions, and redirects such calls to an overlay manager via a stub.
8355 @command{ld} also provides a built-in overlay manager. This option
8356 turns off all this special overlay handling.
8357
8358 @cindex SPU overlay stub symbols
8359 @kindex --emit-stub-syms
8360 @item --emit-stub-syms
8361 This option causes @command{ld} to label overlay stubs with a local
8362 symbol that encodes the stub type and destination.
8363
8364 @cindex SPU extra overlay stubs
8365 @kindex --extra-overlay-stubs
8366 @item --extra-overlay-stubs
8367 This option causes @command{ld} to add overlay call stubs on all
8368 function calls out of overlay regions. Normally stubs are not added
8369 on calls to non-overlay regions.
8370
8371 @cindex SPU local store size
8372 @kindex --local-store=lo:hi
8373 @item --local-store=lo:hi
8374 @command{ld} usually checks that a final executable for SPU fits in
8375 the address range 0 to 256k. This option may be used to change the
8376 range. Disable the check entirely with @option{--local-store=0:0}.
8377
8378 @cindex SPU
8379 @kindex --stack-analysis
8380 @item --stack-analysis
8381 SPU local store space is limited. Over-allocation of stack space
8382 unnecessarily limits space available for code and data, while
8383 under-allocation results in runtime failures. If given this option,
8384 @command{ld} will provide an estimate of maximum stack usage.
8385 @command{ld} does this by examining symbols in code sections to
8386 determine the extents of functions, and looking at function prologues
8387 for stack adjusting instructions. A call-graph is created by looking
8388 for relocations on branch instructions. The graph is then searched
8389 for the maximum stack usage path. Note that this analysis does not
8390 find calls made via function pointers, and does not handle recursion
8391 and other cycles in the call graph. Stack usage may be
8392 under-estimated if your code makes such calls. Also, stack usage for
8393 dynamic allocation, e.g. alloca, will not be detected. If a link map
8394 is requested, detailed information about each function's stack usage
8395 and calls will be given.
8396
8397 @cindex SPU
8398 @kindex --emit-stack-syms
8399 @item --emit-stack-syms
8400 This option, if given along with @option{--stack-analysis} will result
8401 in @command{ld} emitting stack sizing symbols for each function.
8402 These take the form @code{__stack_<function_name>} for global
8403 functions, and @code{__stack_<number>_<function_name>} for static
8404 functions. @code{<number>} is the section id in hex. The value of
8405 such symbols is the stack requirement for the corresponding function.
8406 The symbol size will be zero, type @code{STT_NOTYPE}, binding
8407 @code{STB_LOCAL}, and section @code{SHN_ABS}.
8408 @end table
8409
8410 @ifclear GENERIC
8411 @lowersections
8412 @end ifclear
8413 @end ifset
8414
8415 @ifset TICOFF
8416 @ifclear GENERIC
8417 @raisesections
8418 @end ifclear
8419
8420 @node TI COFF
8421 @section @command{ld}'s Support for Various TI COFF Versions
8422 @cindex TI COFF versions
8423 @kindex --format=@var{version}
8424 The @samp{--format} switch allows selection of one of the various
8425 TI COFF versions. The latest of this writing is 2; versions 0 and 1 are
8426 also supported. The TI COFF versions also vary in header byte-order
8427 format; @command{ld} will read any version or byte order, but the output
8428 header format depends on the default specified by the specific target.
8429
8430 @ifclear GENERIC
8431 @lowersections
8432 @end ifclear
8433 @end ifset
8434
8435 @ifset WIN32
8436 @ifclear GENERIC
8437 @raisesections
8438 @end ifclear
8439
8440 @node WIN32
8441 @section @command{ld} and WIN32 (cygwin/mingw)
8442
8443 This section describes some of the win32 specific @command{ld} issues.
8444 See @ref{Options,,Command-line Options} for detailed description of the
8445 command-line options mentioned here.
8446
8447 @table @emph
8448 @cindex import libraries
8449 @item import libraries
8450 The standard Windows linker creates and uses so-called import
8451 libraries, which contains information for linking to dll's. They are
8452 regular static archives and are handled as any other static
8453 archive. The cygwin and mingw ports of @command{ld} have specific
8454 support for creating such libraries provided with the
8455 @samp{--out-implib} command-line option.
8456
8457 @item exporting DLL symbols
8458 @cindex exporting DLL symbols
8459 The cygwin/mingw @command{ld} has several ways to export symbols for dll's.
8460
8461 @table @emph
8462 @item using auto-export functionality
8463 @cindex using auto-export functionality
8464 By default @command{ld} exports symbols with the auto-export functionality,
8465 which is controlled by the following command-line options:
8466
8467 @itemize
8468 @item --export-all-symbols [This is the default]
8469 @item --exclude-symbols
8470 @item --exclude-libs
8471 @item --exclude-modules-for-implib
8472 @item --version-script
8473 @end itemize
8474
8475 When auto-export is in operation, @command{ld} will export all the non-local
8476 (global and common) symbols it finds in a DLL, with the exception of a few
8477 symbols known to belong to the system's runtime and libraries. As it will
8478 often not be desirable to export all of a DLL's symbols, which may include
8479 private functions that are not part of any public interface, the command-line
8480 options listed above may be used to filter symbols out from the list for
8481 exporting. The @samp{--output-def} option can be used in order to see the
8482 final list of exported symbols with all exclusions taken into effect.
8483
8484 If @samp{--export-all-symbols} is not given explicitly on the
8485 command line, then the default auto-export behavior will be @emph{disabled}
8486 if either of the following are true:
8487
8488 @itemize
8489 @item A DEF file is used.
8490 @item Any symbol in any object file was marked with the __declspec(dllexport) attribute.
8491 @end itemize
8492
8493 @item using a DEF file
8494 @cindex using a DEF file
8495 Another way of exporting symbols is using a DEF file. A DEF file is
8496 an ASCII file containing definitions of symbols which should be
8497 exported when a dll is created. Usually it is named @samp{<dll
8498 name>.def} and is added as any other object file to the linker's
8499 command line. The file's name must end in @samp{.def} or @samp{.DEF}.
8500
8501 @example
8502 gcc -o <output> <objectfiles> <dll name>.def
8503 @end example
8504
8505 Using a DEF file turns off the normal auto-export behavior, unless the
8506 @samp{--export-all-symbols} option is also used.
8507
8508 Here is an example of a DEF file for a shared library called @samp{xyz.dll}:
8509
8510 @example
8511 LIBRARY "xyz.dll" BASE=0x20000000
8512
8513 EXPORTS
8514 foo
8515 bar
8516 _bar = bar
8517 another_foo = abc.dll.afoo
8518 var1 DATA
8519 doo = foo == foo2
8520 eoo DATA == var1
8521 @end example
8522
8523 This example defines a DLL with a non-default base address and seven
8524 symbols in the export table. The third exported symbol @code{_bar} is an
8525 alias for the second. The fourth symbol, @code{another_foo} is resolved
8526 by "forwarding" to another module and treating it as an alias for
8527 @code{afoo} exported from the DLL @samp{abc.dll}. The final symbol
8528 @code{var1} is declared to be a data object. The @samp{doo} symbol in
8529 export library is an alias of @samp{foo}, which gets the string name
8530 in export table @samp{foo2}. The @samp{eoo} symbol is an data export
8531 symbol, which gets in export table the name @samp{var1}.
8532
8533 The optional @code{LIBRARY <name>} command indicates the @emph{internal}
8534 name of the output DLL. If @samp{<name>} does not include a suffix,
8535 the default library suffix, @samp{.DLL} is appended.
8536
8537 When the .DEF file is used to build an application, rather than a
8538 library, the @code{NAME <name>} command should be used instead of
8539 @code{LIBRARY}. If @samp{<name>} does not include a suffix, the default
8540 executable suffix, @samp{.EXE} is appended.
8541
8542 With either @code{LIBRARY <name>} or @code{NAME <name>} the optional
8543 specification @code{BASE = <number>} may be used to specify a
8544 non-default base address for the image.
8545
8546 If neither @code{LIBRARY <name>} nor @code{NAME <name>} is specified,
8547 or they specify an empty string, the internal name is the same as the
8548 filename specified on the command line.
8549
8550 The complete specification of an export symbol is:
8551
8552 @example
8553 EXPORTS
8554 ( ( ( <name1> [ = <name2> ] )
8555 | ( <name1> = <module-name> . <external-name>))
8556 [ @@ <integer> ] [NONAME] [DATA] [CONSTANT] [PRIVATE] [== <name3>] ) *
8557 @end example
8558
8559 Declares @samp{<name1>} as an exported symbol from the DLL, or declares
8560 @samp{<name1>} as an exported alias for @samp{<name2>}; or declares
8561 @samp{<name1>} as a "forward" alias for the symbol
8562 @samp{<external-name>} in the DLL @samp{<module-name>}.
8563 Optionally, the symbol may be exported by the specified ordinal
8564 @samp{<integer>} alias. The optional @samp{<name3>} is the to be used
8565 string in import/export table for the symbol.
8566
8567 The optional keywords that follow the declaration indicate:
8568
8569 @code{NONAME}: Do not put the symbol name in the DLL's export table. It
8570 will still be exported by its ordinal alias (either the value specified
8571 by the .def specification or, otherwise, the value assigned by the
8572 linker). The symbol name, however, does remain visible in the import
8573 library (if any), unless @code{PRIVATE} is also specified.
8574
8575 @code{DATA}: The symbol is a variable or object, rather than a function.
8576 The import lib will export only an indirect reference to @code{foo} as
8577 the symbol @code{_imp__foo} (ie, @code{foo} must be resolved as
8578 @code{*_imp__foo}).
8579
8580 @code{CONSTANT}: Like @code{DATA}, but put the undecorated @code{foo} as
8581 well as @code{_imp__foo} into the import library. Both refer to the
8582 read-only import address table's pointer to the variable, not to the
8583 variable itself. This can be dangerous. If the user code fails to add
8584 the @code{dllimport} attribute and also fails to explicitly add the
8585 extra indirection that the use of the attribute enforces, the
8586 application will behave unexpectedly.
8587
8588 @code{PRIVATE}: Put the symbol in the DLL's export table, but do not put
8589 it into the static import library used to resolve imports at link time. The
8590 symbol can still be imported using the @code{LoadLibrary/GetProcAddress}
8591 API at runtime or by using the GNU ld extension of linking directly to
8592 the DLL without an import library.
8593
8594 See ld/deffilep.y in the binutils sources for the full specification of
8595 other DEF file statements
8596
8597 @cindex creating a DEF file
8598 While linking a shared dll, @command{ld} is able to create a DEF file
8599 with the @samp{--output-def <file>} command-line option.
8600
8601 @item Using decorations
8602 @cindex Using decorations
8603 Another way of marking symbols for export is to modify the source code
8604 itself, so that when building the DLL each symbol to be exported is
8605 declared as:
8606
8607 @example
8608 __declspec(dllexport) int a_variable
8609 __declspec(dllexport) void a_function(int with_args)
8610 @end example
8611
8612 All such symbols will be exported from the DLL. If, however,
8613 any of the object files in the DLL contain symbols decorated in
8614 this way, then the normal auto-export behavior is disabled, unless
8615 the @samp{--export-all-symbols} option is also used.
8616
8617 Note that object files that wish to access these symbols must @emph{not}
8618 decorate them with dllexport. Instead, they should use dllimport,
8619 instead:
8620
8621 @example
8622 __declspec(dllimport) int a_variable
8623 __declspec(dllimport) void a_function(int with_args)
8624 @end example
8625
8626 This complicates the structure of library header files, because
8627 when included by the library itself the header must declare the
8628 variables and functions as dllexport, but when included by client
8629 code the header must declare them as dllimport. There are a number
8630 of idioms that are typically used to do this; often client code can
8631 omit the __declspec() declaration completely. See
8632 @samp{--enable-auto-import} and @samp{automatic data imports} for more
8633 information.
8634 @end table
8635
8636 @cindex automatic data imports
8637 @item automatic data imports
8638 The standard Windows dll format supports data imports from dlls only
8639 by adding special decorations (dllimport/dllexport), which let the
8640 compiler produce specific assembler instructions to deal with this
8641 issue. This increases the effort necessary to port existing Un*x
8642 code to these platforms, especially for large
8643 c++ libraries and applications. The auto-import feature, which was
8644 initially provided by Paul Sokolovsky, allows one to omit the
8645 decorations to achieve a behavior that conforms to that on POSIX/Un*x
8646 platforms. This feature is enabled with the @samp{--enable-auto-import}
8647 command-line option, although it is enabled by default on cygwin/mingw.
8648 The @samp{--enable-auto-import} option itself now serves mainly to
8649 suppress any warnings that are ordinarily emitted when linked objects
8650 trigger the feature's use.
8651
8652 auto-import of variables does not always work flawlessly without
8653 additional assistance. Sometimes, you will see this message
8654
8655 "variable '<var>' can't be auto-imported. Please read the
8656 documentation for ld's @code{--enable-auto-import} for details."
8657
8658 The @samp{--enable-auto-import} documentation explains why this error
8659 occurs, and several methods that can be used to overcome this difficulty.
8660 One of these methods is the @emph{runtime pseudo-relocs} feature, described
8661 below.
8662
8663 @cindex runtime pseudo-relocation
8664 For complex variables imported from DLLs (such as structs or classes),
8665 object files typically contain a base address for the variable and an
8666 offset (@emph{addend}) within the variable--to specify a particular
8667 field or public member, for instance. Unfortunately, the runtime loader used
8668 in win32 environments is incapable of fixing these references at runtime
8669 without the additional information supplied by dllimport/dllexport decorations.
8670 The standard auto-import feature described above is unable to resolve these
8671 references.
8672
8673 The @samp{--enable-runtime-pseudo-relocs} switch allows these references to
8674 be resolved without error, while leaving the task of adjusting the references
8675 themselves (with their non-zero addends) to specialized code provided by the
8676 runtime environment. Recent versions of the cygwin and mingw environments and
8677 compilers provide this runtime support; older versions do not. However, the
8678 support is only necessary on the developer's platform; the compiled result will
8679 run without error on an older system.
8680
8681 @samp{--enable-runtime-pseudo-relocs} is not the default; it must be explicitly
8682 enabled as needed.
8683
8684 @cindex direct linking to a dll
8685 @item direct linking to a dll
8686 The cygwin/mingw ports of @command{ld} support the direct linking,
8687 including data symbols, to a dll without the usage of any import
8688 libraries. This is much faster and uses much less memory than does the
8689 traditional import library method, especially when linking large
8690 libraries or applications. When @command{ld} creates an import lib, each
8691 function or variable exported from the dll is stored in its own bfd, even
8692 though a single bfd could contain many exports. The overhead involved in
8693 storing, loading, and processing so many bfd's is quite large, and explains the
8694 tremendous time, memory, and storage needed to link against particularly
8695 large or complex libraries when using import libs.
8696
8697 Linking directly to a dll uses no extra command-line switches other than
8698 @samp{-L} and @samp{-l}, because @command{ld} already searches for a number
8699 of names to match each library. All that is needed from the developer's
8700 perspective is an understanding of this search, in order to force ld to
8701 select the dll instead of an import library.
8702
8703
8704 For instance, when ld is called with the argument @samp{-lxxx} it will attempt
8705 to find, in the first directory of its search path,
8706
8707 @example
8708 libxxx.dll.a
8709 xxx.dll.a
8710 libxxx.a
8711 xxx.lib
8712 libxxx.lib
8713 cygxxx.dll (*)
8714 libxxx.dll
8715 xxx.dll
8716 @end example
8717
8718 before moving on to the next directory in the search path.
8719
8720 (*) Actually, this is not @samp{cygxxx.dll} but in fact is @samp{<prefix>xxx.dll},
8721 where @samp{<prefix>} is set by the @command{ld} option
8722 @samp{--dll-search-prefix=<prefix>}. In the case of cygwin, the standard gcc spec
8723 file includes @samp{--dll-search-prefix=cyg}, so in effect we actually search for
8724 @samp{cygxxx.dll}.
8725
8726 Other win32-based unix environments, such as mingw or pw32, may use other
8727 @samp{<prefix>}es, although at present only cygwin makes use of this feature. It
8728 was originally intended to help avoid name conflicts among dll's built for the
8729 various win32/un*x environments, so that (for example) two versions of a zlib dll
8730 could coexist on the same machine.
8731
8732 The generic cygwin/mingw path layout uses a @samp{bin} directory for
8733 applications and dll's and a @samp{lib} directory for the import
8734 libraries (using cygwin nomenclature):
8735
8736 @example
8737 bin/
8738 cygxxx.dll
8739 lib/
8740 libxxx.dll.a (in case of dll's)
8741 libxxx.a (in case of static archive)
8742 @end example
8743
8744 Linking directly to a dll without using the import library can be
8745 done two ways:
8746
8747 1. Use the dll directly by adding the @samp{bin} path to the link line
8748 @example
8749 gcc -Wl,-verbose -o a.exe -L../bin/ -lxxx
8750 @end example
8751
8752 However, as the dll's often have version numbers appended to their names
8753 (@samp{cygncurses-5.dll}) this will often fail, unless one specifies
8754 @samp{-L../bin -lncurses-5} to include the version. Import libs are generally
8755 not versioned, and do not have this difficulty.
8756
8757 2. Create a symbolic link from the dll to a file in the @samp{lib}
8758 directory according to the above mentioned search pattern. This
8759 should be used to avoid unwanted changes in the tools needed for
8760 making the app/dll.
8761
8762 @example
8763 ln -s bin/cygxxx.dll lib/[cyg|lib|]xxx.dll[.a]
8764 @end example
8765
8766 Then you can link without any make environment changes.
8767
8768 @example
8769 gcc -Wl,-verbose -o a.exe -L../lib/ -lxxx
8770 @end example
8771
8772 This technique also avoids the version number problems, because the following is
8773 perfectly legal
8774
8775 @example
8776 bin/
8777 cygxxx-5.dll
8778 lib/
8779 libxxx.dll.a -> ../bin/cygxxx-5.dll
8780 @end example
8781
8782 Linking directly to a dll without using an import lib will work
8783 even when auto-import features are exercised, and even when
8784 @samp{--enable-runtime-pseudo-relocs} is used.
8785
8786 Given the improvements in speed and memory usage, one might justifiably
8787 wonder why import libraries are used at all. There are three reasons:
8788
8789 1. Until recently, the link-directly-to-dll functionality did @emph{not}
8790 work with auto-imported data.
8791
8792 2. Sometimes it is necessary to include pure static objects within the
8793 import library (which otherwise contains only bfd's for indirection
8794 symbols that point to the exports of a dll). Again, the import lib
8795 for the cygwin kernel makes use of this ability, and it is not
8796 possible to do this without an import lib.
8797
8798 3. Symbol aliases can only be resolved using an import lib. This is
8799 critical when linking against OS-supplied dll's (eg, the win32 API)
8800 in which symbols are usually exported as undecorated aliases of their
8801 stdcall-decorated assembly names.
8802
8803 So, import libs are not going away. But the ability to replace
8804 true import libs with a simple symbolic link to (or a copy of)
8805 a dll, in many cases, is a useful addition to the suite of tools
8806 binutils makes available to the win32 developer. Given the
8807 massive improvements in memory requirements during linking, storage
8808 requirements, and linking speed, we expect that many developers
8809 will soon begin to use this feature whenever possible.
8810
8811 @item symbol aliasing
8812 @table @emph
8813 @item adding additional names
8814 Sometimes, it is useful to export symbols with additional names.
8815 A symbol @samp{foo} will be exported as @samp{foo}, but it can also be
8816 exported as @samp{_foo} by using special directives in the DEF file
8817 when creating the dll. This will affect also the optional created
8818 import library. Consider the following DEF file:
8819
8820 @example
8821 LIBRARY "xyz.dll" BASE=0x61000000
8822
8823 EXPORTS
8824 foo
8825 _foo = foo
8826 @end example
8827
8828 The line @samp{_foo = foo} maps the symbol @samp{foo} to @samp{_foo}.
8829
8830 Another method for creating a symbol alias is to create it in the
8831 source code using the "weak" attribute:
8832
8833 @example
8834 void foo () @{ /* Do something. */; @}
8835 void _foo () __attribute__ ((weak, alias ("foo")));
8836 @end example
8837
8838 See the gcc manual for more information about attributes and weak
8839 symbols.
8840
8841 @item renaming symbols
8842 Sometimes it is useful to rename exports. For instance, the cygwin
8843 kernel does this regularly. A symbol @samp{_foo} can be exported as
8844 @samp{foo} but not as @samp{_foo} by using special directives in the
8845 DEF file. (This will also affect the import library, if it is
8846 created). In the following example:
8847
8848 @example
8849 LIBRARY "xyz.dll" BASE=0x61000000
8850
8851 EXPORTS
8852 _foo = foo
8853 @end example
8854
8855 The line @samp{_foo = foo} maps the exported symbol @samp{foo} to
8856 @samp{_foo}.
8857 @end table
8858
8859 Note: using a DEF file disables the default auto-export behavior,
8860 unless the @samp{--export-all-symbols} command-line option is used.
8861 If, however, you are trying to rename symbols, then you should list
8862 @emph{all} desired exports in the DEF file, including the symbols
8863 that are not being renamed, and do @emph{not} use the
8864 @samp{--export-all-symbols} option. If you list only the
8865 renamed symbols in the DEF file, and use @samp{--export-all-symbols}
8866 to handle the other symbols, then the both the new names @emph{and}
8867 the original names for the renamed symbols will be exported.
8868 In effect, you'd be aliasing those symbols, not renaming them,
8869 which is probably not what you wanted.
8870
8871 @cindex weak externals
8872 @item weak externals
8873 The Windows object format, PE, specifies a form of weak symbols called
8874 weak externals. When a weak symbol is linked and the symbol is not
8875 defined, the weak symbol becomes an alias for some other symbol. There
8876 are three variants of weak externals:
8877 @itemize
8878 @item Definition is searched for in objects and libraries, historically
8879 called lazy externals.
8880 @item Definition is searched for only in other objects, not in libraries.
8881 This form is not presently implemented.
8882 @item No search; the symbol is an alias. This form is not presently
8883 implemented.
8884 @end itemize
8885 As a GNU extension, weak symbols that do not specify an alternate symbol
8886 are supported. If the symbol is undefined when linking, the symbol
8887 uses a default value.
8888
8889 @cindex aligned common symbols
8890 @item aligned common symbols
8891 As a GNU extension to the PE file format, it is possible to specify the
8892 desired alignment for a common symbol. This information is conveyed from
8893 the assembler or compiler to the linker by means of GNU-specific commands
8894 carried in the object file's @samp{.drectve} section, which are recognized
8895 by @command{ld} and respected when laying out the common symbols. Native
8896 tools will be able to process object files employing this GNU extension,
8897 but will fail to respect the alignment instructions, and may issue noisy
8898 warnings about unknown linker directives.
8899
8900 @end table
8901
8902 @ifclear GENERIC
8903 @lowersections
8904 @end ifclear
8905 @end ifset
8906
8907 @ifset XTENSA
8908 @ifclear GENERIC
8909 @raisesections
8910 @end ifclear
8911
8912 @node Xtensa
8913 @section @code{ld} and Xtensa Processors
8914
8915 @cindex Xtensa processors
8916 The default @command{ld} behavior for Xtensa processors is to interpret
8917 @code{SECTIONS} commands so that lists of explicitly named sections in a
8918 specification with a wildcard file will be interleaved when necessary to
8919 keep literal pools within the range of PC-relative load offsets. For
8920 example, with the command:
8921
8922 @smallexample
8923 SECTIONS
8924 @{
8925 .text : @{
8926 *(.literal .text)
8927 @}
8928 @}
8929 @end smallexample
8930
8931 @noindent
8932 @command{ld} may interleave some of the @code{.literal}
8933 and @code{.text} sections from different object files to ensure that the
8934 literal pools are within the range of PC-relative load offsets. A valid
8935 interleaving might place the @code{.literal} sections from an initial
8936 group of files followed by the @code{.text} sections of that group of
8937 files. Then, the @code{.literal} sections from the rest of the files
8938 and the @code{.text} sections from the rest of the files would follow.
8939
8940 @cindex @option{--relax} on Xtensa
8941 @cindex relaxing on Xtensa
8942 Relaxation is enabled by default for the Xtensa version of @command{ld} and
8943 provides two important link-time optimizations. The first optimization
8944 is to combine identical literal values to reduce code size. A redundant
8945 literal will be removed and all the @code{L32R} instructions that use it
8946 will be changed to reference an identical literal, as long as the
8947 location of the replacement literal is within the offset range of all
8948 the @code{L32R} instructions. The second optimization is to remove
8949 unnecessary overhead from assembler-generated ``longcall'' sequences of
8950 @code{L32R}/@code{CALLX@var{n}} when the target functions are within
8951 range of direct @code{CALL@var{n}} instructions.
8952
8953 For each of these cases where an indirect call sequence can be optimized
8954 to a direct call, the linker will change the @code{CALLX@var{n}}
8955 instruction to a @code{CALL@var{n}} instruction, remove the @code{L32R}
8956 instruction, and remove the literal referenced by the @code{L32R}
8957 instruction if it is not used for anything else. Removing the
8958 @code{L32R} instruction always reduces code size but can potentially
8959 hurt performance by changing the alignment of subsequent branch targets.
8960 By default, the linker will always preserve alignments, either by
8961 switching some instructions between 24-bit encodings and the equivalent
8962 density instructions or by inserting a no-op in place of the @code{L32R}
8963 instruction that was removed. If code size is more important than
8964 performance, the @option{--size-opt} option can be used to prevent the
8965 linker from widening density instructions or inserting no-ops, except in
8966 a few cases where no-ops are required for correctness.
8967
8968 The following Xtensa-specific command-line options can be used to
8969 control the linker:
8970
8971 @cindex Xtensa options
8972 @table @option
8973 @item --size-opt
8974 When optimizing indirect calls to direct calls, optimize for code size
8975 more than performance. With this option, the linker will not insert
8976 no-ops or widen density instructions to preserve branch target
8977 alignment. There may still be some cases where no-ops are required to
8978 preserve the correctness of the code.
8979
8980 @item --abi-windowed
8981 @itemx --abi-call0
8982 Choose ABI for the output object and for the generated PLT code.
8983 PLT code inserted by the linker must match ABI of the output object
8984 because windowed and call0 ABI use incompatible function call
8985 conventions.
8986 Default ABI is chosen by the ABI tag in the @code{.xtensa.info} section
8987 of the first input object.
8988 A warning is issued if ABI tags of input objects do not match each other
8989 or the chosen output object ABI.
8990 @end table
8991
8992 @ifclear GENERIC
8993 @lowersections
8994 @end ifclear
8995 @end ifset
8996
8997 @ifclear SingleFormat
8998 @node BFD
8999 @chapter BFD
9000
9001 @cindex back end
9002 @cindex object file management
9003 @cindex object formats available
9004 @kindex objdump -i
9005 The linker accesses object and archive files using the BFD libraries.
9006 These libraries allow the linker to use the same routines to operate on
9007 object files whatever the object file format. A different object file
9008 format can be supported simply by creating a new BFD back end and adding
9009 it to the library. To conserve runtime memory, however, the linker and
9010 associated tools are usually configured to support only a subset of the
9011 object file formats available. You can use @code{objdump -i}
9012 (@pxref{objdump,,objdump,binutils.info,The GNU Binary Utilities}) to
9013 list all the formats available for your configuration.
9014
9015 @cindex BFD requirements
9016 @cindex requirements for BFD
9017 As with most implementations, BFD is a compromise between
9018 several conflicting requirements. The major factor influencing
9019 BFD design was efficiency: any time used converting between
9020 formats is time which would not have been spent had BFD not
9021 been involved. This is partly offset by abstraction payback; since
9022 BFD simplifies applications and back ends, more time and care
9023 may be spent optimizing algorithms for a greater speed.
9024
9025 One minor artifact of the BFD solution which you should bear in
9026 mind is the potential for information loss. There are two places where
9027 useful information can be lost using the BFD mechanism: during
9028 conversion and during output. @xref{BFD information loss}.
9029
9030 @menu
9031 * BFD outline:: How it works: an outline of BFD
9032 @end menu
9033
9034 @node BFD outline
9035 @section How It Works: An Outline of BFD
9036 @cindex opening object files
9037 @include bfdsumm.texi
9038 @end ifclear
9039
9040 @node Reporting Bugs
9041 @chapter Reporting Bugs
9042 @cindex bugs in @command{ld}
9043 @cindex reporting bugs in @command{ld}
9044
9045 Your bug reports play an essential role in making @command{ld} reliable.
9046
9047 Reporting a bug may help you by bringing a solution to your problem, or
9048 it may not. But in any case the principal function of a bug report is
9049 to help the entire community by making the next version of @command{ld}
9050 work better. Bug reports are your contribution to the maintenance of
9051 @command{ld}.
9052
9053 In order for a bug report to serve its purpose, you must include the
9054 information that enables us to fix the bug.
9055
9056 @menu
9057 * Bug Criteria:: Have you found a bug?
9058 * Bug Reporting:: How to report bugs
9059 @end menu
9060
9061 @node Bug Criteria
9062 @section Have You Found a Bug?
9063 @cindex bug criteria
9064
9065 If you are not sure whether you have found a bug, here are some guidelines:
9066
9067 @itemize @bullet
9068 @cindex fatal signal
9069 @cindex linker crash
9070 @cindex crash of linker
9071 @item
9072 If the linker gets a fatal signal, for any input whatever, that is a
9073 @command{ld} bug. Reliable linkers never crash.
9074
9075 @cindex error on valid input
9076 @item
9077 If @command{ld} produces an error message for valid input, that is a bug.
9078
9079 @cindex invalid input
9080 @item
9081 If @command{ld} does not produce an error message for invalid input, that
9082 may be a bug. In the general case, the linker can not verify that
9083 object files are correct.
9084
9085 @item
9086 If you are an experienced user of linkers, your suggestions for
9087 improvement of @command{ld} are welcome in any case.
9088 @end itemize
9089
9090 @node Bug Reporting
9091 @section How to Report Bugs
9092 @cindex bug reports
9093 @cindex @command{ld} bugs, reporting
9094
9095 A number of companies and individuals offer support for @sc{gnu}
9096 products. If you obtained @command{ld} from a support organization, we
9097 recommend you contact that organization first.
9098
9099 You can find contact information for many support companies and
9100 individuals in the file @file{etc/SERVICE} in the @sc{gnu} Emacs
9101 distribution.
9102
9103 @ifset BUGURL
9104 Otherwise, send bug reports for @command{ld} to
9105 @value{BUGURL}.
9106 @end ifset
9107
9108 The fundamental principle of reporting bugs usefully is this:
9109 @strong{report all the facts}. If you are not sure whether to state a
9110 fact or leave it out, state it!
9111
9112 Often people omit facts because they think they know what causes the
9113 problem and assume that some details do not matter. Thus, you might
9114 assume that the name of a symbol you use in an example does not
9115 matter. Well, probably it does not, but one cannot be sure. Perhaps
9116 the bug is a stray memory reference which happens to fetch from the
9117 location where that name is stored in memory; perhaps, if the name
9118 were different, the contents of that location would fool the linker
9119 into doing the right thing despite the bug. Play it safe and give a
9120 specific, complete example. That is the easiest thing for you to do,
9121 and the most helpful.
9122
9123 Keep in mind that the purpose of a bug report is to enable us to fix
9124 the bug if it is new to us. Therefore, always write your bug reports
9125 on the assumption that the bug has not been reported previously.
9126
9127 Sometimes people give a few sketchy facts and ask, ``Does this ring a
9128 bell?'' This cannot help us fix a bug, so it is basically useless. We
9129 respond by asking for enough details to enable us to investigate.
9130 You might as well expedite matters by sending them to begin with.
9131
9132 To enable us to fix the bug, you should include all these things:
9133
9134 @itemize @bullet
9135 @item
9136 The version of @command{ld}. @command{ld} announces it if you start it with
9137 the @samp{--version} argument.
9138
9139 Without this, we will not know whether there is any point in looking for
9140 the bug in the current version of @command{ld}.
9141
9142 @item
9143 Any patches you may have applied to the @command{ld} source, including any
9144 patches made to the @code{BFD} library.
9145
9146 @item
9147 The type of machine you are using, and the operating system name and
9148 version number.
9149
9150 @item
9151 What compiler (and its version) was used to compile @command{ld}---e.g.
9152 ``@code{gcc-2.7}''.
9153
9154 @item
9155 The command arguments you gave the linker to link your example and
9156 observe the bug. To guarantee you will not omit something important,
9157 list them all. A copy of the Makefile (or the output from make) is
9158 sufficient.
9159
9160 If we were to try to guess the arguments, we would probably guess wrong
9161 and then we might not encounter the bug.
9162
9163 @item
9164 A complete input file, or set of input files, that will reproduce the
9165 bug. It is generally most helpful to send the actual object files
9166 provided that they are reasonably small. Say no more than 10K. For
9167 bigger files you can either make them available by FTP or HTTP or else
9168 state that you are willing to send the object file(s) to whomever
9169 requests them. (Note - your email will be going to a mailing list, so
9170 we do not want to clog it up with large attachments). But small
9171 attachments are best.
9172
9173 If the source files were assembled using @code{gas} or compiled using
9174 @code{gcc}, then it may be OK to send the source files rather than the
9175 object files. In this case, be sure to say exactly what version of
9176 @code{gas} or @code{gcc} was used to produce the object files. Also say
9177 how @code{gas} or @code{gcc} were configured.
9178
9179 @item
9180 A description of what behavior you observe that you believe is
9181 incorrect. For example, ``It gets a fatal signal.''
9182
9183 Of course, if the bug is that @command{ld} gets a fatal signal, then we
9184 will certainly notice it. But if the bug is incorrect output, we might
9185 not notice unless it is glaringly wrong. You might as well not give us
9186 a chance to make a mistake.
9187
9188 Even if the problem you experience is a fatal signal, you should still
9189 say so explicitly. Suppose something strange is going on, such as, your
9190 copy of @command{ld} is out of sync, or you have encountered a bug in the
9191 C library on your system. (This has happened!) Your copy might crash
9192 and ours would not. If you told us to expect a crash, then when ours
9193 fails to crash, we would know that the bug was not happening for us. If
9194 you had not told us to expect a crash, then we would not be able to draw
9195 any conclusion from our observations.
9196
9197 @item
9198 If you wish to suggest changes to the @command{ld} source, send us context
9199 diffs, as generated by @code{diff} with the @samp{-u}, @samp{-c}, or
9200 @samp{-p} option. Always send diffs from the old file to the new file.
9201 If you even discuss something in the @command{ld} source, refer to it by
9202 context, not by line number.
9203
9204 The line numbers in our development sources will not match those in your
9205 sources. Your line numbers would convey no useful information to us.
9206 @end itemize
9207
9208 Here are some things that are not necessary:
9209
9210 @itemize @bullet
9211 @item
9212 A description of the envelope of the bug.
9213
9214 Often people who encounter a bug spend a lot of time investigating
9215 which changes to the input file will make the bug go away and which
9216 changes will not affect it.
9217
9218 This is often time consuming and not very useful, because the way we
9219 will find the bug is by running a single example under the debugger
9220 with breakpoints, not by pure deduction from a series of examples.
9221 We recommend that you save your time for something else.
9222
9223 Of course, if you can find a simpler example to report @emph{instead}
9224 of the original one, that is a convenience for us. Errors in the
9225 output will be easier to spot, running under the debugger will take
9226 less time, and so on.
9227
9228 However, simplification is not vital; if you do not want to do this,
9229 report the bug anyway and send us the entire test case you used.
9230
9231 @item
9232 A patch for the bug.
9233
9234 A patch for the bug does help us if it is a good one. But do not omit
9235 the necessary information, such as the test case, on the assumption that
9236 a patch is all we need. We might see problems with your patch and decide
9237 to fix the problem another way, or we might not understand it at all.
9238
9239 Sometimes with a program as complicated as @command{ld} it is very hard to
9240 construct an example that will make the program follow a certain path
9241 through the code. If you do not send us the example, we will not be
9242 able to construct one, so we will not be able to verify that the bug is
9243 fixed.
9244
9245 And if we cannot understand what bug you are trying to fix, or why your
9246 patch should be an improvement, we will not install it. A test case will
9247 help us to understand.
9248
9249 @item
9250 A guess about what the bug is or what it depends on.
9251
9252 Such guesses are usually wrong. Even we cannot guess right about such
9253 things without first using the debugger to find the facts.
9254 @end itemize
9255
9256 @node MRI
9257 @appendix MRI Compatible Script Files
9258 @cindex MRI compatibility
9259 To aid users making the transition to @sc{gnu} @command{ld} from the MRI
9260 linker, @command{ld} can use MRI compatible linker scripts as an
9261 alternative to the more general-purpose linker scripting language
9262 described in @ref{Scripts}. MRI compatible linker scripts have a much
9263 simpler command set than the scripting language otherwise used with
9264 @command{ld}. @sc{gnu} @command{ld} supports the most commonly used MRI
9265 linker commands; these commands are described here.
9266
9267 In general, MRI scripts aren't of much use with the @code{a.out} object
9268 file format, since it only has three sections and MRI scripts lack some
9269 features to make use of them.
9270
9271 You can specify a file containing an MRI-compatible script using the
9272 @samp{-c} command-line option.
9273
9274 Each command in an MRI-compatible script occupies its own line; each
9275 command line starts with the keyword that identifies the command (though
9276 blank lines are also allowed for punctuation). If a line of an
9277 MRI-compatible script begins with an unrecognized keyword, @command{ld}
9278 issues a warning message, but continues processing the script.
9279
9280 Lines beginning with @samp{*} are comments.
9281
9282 You can write these commands using all upper-case letters, or all
9283 lower case; for example, @samp{chip} is the same as @samp{CHIP}.
9284 The following list shows only the upper-case form of each command.
9285
9286 @table @code
9287 @cindex @code{ABSOLUTE} (MRI)
9288 @item ABSOLUTE @var{secname}
9289 @itemx ABSOLUTE @var{secname}, @var{secname}, @dots{} @var{secname}
9290 Normally, @command{ld} includes in the output file all sections from all
9291 the input files. However, in an MRI-compatible script, you can use the
9292 @code{ABSOLUTE} command to restrict the sections that will be present in
9293 your output program. If the @code{ABSOLUTE} command is used at all in a
9294 script, then only the sections named explicitly in @code{ABSOLUTE}
9295 commands will appear in the linker output. You can still use other
9296 input sections (whatever you select on the command line, or using
9297 @code{LOAD}) to resolve addresses in the output file.
9298
9299 @cindex @code{ALIAS} (MRI)
9300 @item ALIAS @var{out-secname}, @var{in-secname}
9301 Use this command to place the data from input section @var{in-secname}
9302 in a section called @var{out-secname} in the linker output file.
9303
9304 @var{in-secname} may be an integer.
9305
9306 @cindex @code{ALIGN} (MRI)
9307 @item ALIGN @var{secname} = @var{expression}
9308 Align the section called @var{secname} to @var{expression}. The
9309 @var{expression} should be a power of two.
9310
9311 @cindex @code{BASE} (MRI)
9312 @item BASE @var{expression}
9313 Use the value of @var{expression} as the lowest address (other than
9314 absolute addresses) in the output file.
9315
9316 @cindex @code{CHIP} (MRI)
9317 @item CHIP @var{expression}
9318 @itemx CHIP @var{expression}, @var{expression}
9319 This command does nothing; it is accepted only for compatibility.
9320
9321 @cindex @code{END} (MRI)
9322 @item END
9323 This command does nothing whatever; it's only accepted for compatibility.
9324
9325 @cindex @code{FORMAT} (MRI)
9326 @item FORMAT @var{output-format}
9327 Similar to the @code{OUTPUT_FORMAT} command in the more general linker
9328 language, but restricted to S-records, if @var{output-format} is @samp{S}
9329
9330 @cindex @code{LIST} (MRI)
9331 @item LIST @var{anything}@dots{}
9332 Print (to the standard output file) a link map, as produced by the
9333 @command{ld} command-line option @samp{-M}.
9334
9335 The keyword @code{LIST} may be followed by anything on the
9336 same line, with no change in its effect.
9337
9338 @cindex @code{LOAD} (MRI)
9339 @item LOAD @var{filename}
9340 @itemx LOAD @var{filename}, @var{filename}, @dots{} @var{filename}
9341 Include one or more object file @var{filename} in the link; this has the
9342 same effect as specifying @var{filename} directly on the @command{ld}
9343 command line.
9344
9345 @cindex @code{NAME} (MRI)
9346 @item NAME @var{output-name}
9347 @var{output-name} is the name for the program produced by @command{ld}; the
9348 MRI-compatible command @code{NAME} is equivalent to the command-line
9349 option @samp{-o} or the general script language command @code{OUTPUT}.
9350
9351 @cindex @code{ORDER} (MRI)
9352 @item ORDER @var{secname}, @var{secname}, @dots{} @var{secname}
9353 @itemx ORDER @var{secname} @var{secname} @var{secname}
9354 Normally, @command{ld} orders the sections in its output file in the
9355 order in which they first appear in the input files. In an MRI-compatible
9356 script, you can override this ordering with the @code{ORDER} command. The
9357 sections you list with @code{ORDER} will appear first in your output
9358 file, in the order specified.
9359
9360 @cindex @code{PUBLIC} (MRI)
9361 @item PUBLIC @var{name}=@var{expression}
9362 @itemx PUBLIC @var{name},@var{expression}
9363 @itemx PUBLIC @var{name} @var{expression}
9364 Supply a value (@var{expression}) for external symbol
9365 @var{name} used in the linker input files.
9366
9367 @cindex @code{SECT} (MRI)
9368 @item SECT @var{secname}, @var{expression}
9369 @itemx SECT @var{secname}=@var{expression}
9370 @itemx SECT @var{secname} @var{expression}
9371 You can use any of these three forms of the @code{SECT} command to
9372 specify the start address (@var{expression}) for section @var{secname}.
9373 If you have more than one @code{SECT} statement for the same
9374 @var{secname}, only the @emph{first} sets the start address.
9375 @end table
9376
9377 @node GNU Free Documentation License
9378 @appendix GNU Free Documentation License
9379 @include fdl.texi
9380
9381 @node LD Index
9382 @unnumbered LD Index
9383
9384 @printindex cp
9385
9386 @tex
9387 % I think something like @@colophon should be in texinfo. In the
9388 % meantime:
9389 \long\def\colophon{\hbox to0pt{}\vfill
9390 \centerline{The body of this manual is set in}
9391 \centerline{\fontname\tenrm,}
9392 \centerline{with headings in {\bf\fontname\tenbf}}
9393 \centerline{and examples in {\tt\fontname\tentt}.}
9394 \centerline{{\it\fontname\tenit\/} and}
9395 \centerline{{\sl\fontname\tensl\/}}
9396 \centerline{are used for emphasis.}\vfill}
9397 \page\colophon
9398 % Blame: doc@@cygnus.com, 28mar91.
9399 @end tex
9400
9401 @bye